[AArch64] Add support for Neoverse E1
[gcc.git] / gcc / doc / tm.texi
1 @c Copyright (C) 1988-2019 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
2 @c This is part of the GCC manual.
3 @c For copying conditions, see the file gcc.texi.
4
5 @node Target Macros
6 @chapter Target Description Macros and Functions
7 @cindex machine description macros
8 @cindex target description macros
9 @cindex macros, target description
10 @cindex @file{tm.h} macros
11
12 In addition to the file @file{@var{machine}.md}, a machine description
13 includes a C header file conventionally given the name
14 @file{@var{machine}.h} and a C source file named @file{@var{machine}.c}.
15 The header file defines numerous macros that convey the information
16 about the target machine that does not fit into the scheme of the
17 @file{.md} file. The file @file{tm.h} should be a link to
18 @file{@var{machine}.h}. The header file @file{config.h} includes
19 @file{tm.h} and most compiler source files include @file{config.h}. The
20 source file defines a variable @code{targetm}, which is a structure
21 containing pointers to functions and data relating to the target
22 machine. @file{@var{machine}.c} should also contain their definitions,
23 if they are not defined elsewhere in GCC, and other functions called
24 through the macros defined in the @file{.h} file.
25
26 @menu
27 * Target Structure:: The @code{targetm} variable.
28 * Driver:: Controlling how the driver runs the compilation passes.
29 * Run-time Target:: Defining @samp{-m} options like @option{-m68000} and @option{-m68020}.
30 * Per-Function Data:: Defining data structures for per-function information.
31 * Storage Layout:: Defining sizes and alignments of data.
32 * Type Layout:: Defining sizes and properties of basic user data types.
33 * Registers:: Naming and describing the hardware registers.
34 * Register Classes:: Defining the classes of hardware registers.
35 * Stack and Calling:: Defining which way the stack grows and by how much.
36 * Varargs:: Defining the varargs macros.
37 * Trampolines:: Code set up at run time to enter a nested function.
38 * Library Calls:: Controlling how library routines are implicitly called.
39 * Addressing Modes:: Defining addressing modes valid for memory operands.
40 * Anchored Addresses:: Defining how @option{-fsection-anchors} should work.
41 * Condition Code:: Defining how insns update the condition code.
42 * Costs:: Defining relative costs of different operations.
43 * Scheduling:: Adjusting the behavior of the instruction scheduler.
44 * Sections:: Dividing storage into text, data, and other sections.
45 * PIC:: Macros for position independent code.
46 * Assembler Format:: Defining how to write insns and pseudo-ops to output.
47 * Debugging Info:: Defining the format of debugging output.
48 * Floating Point:: Handling floating point for cross-compilers.
49 * Mode Switching:: Insertion of mode-switching instructions.
50 * Target Attributes:: Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}.
51 * Emulated TLS:: Emulated TLS support.
52 * MIPS Coprocessors:: MIPS coprocessor support and how to customize it.
53 * PCH Target:: Validity checking for precompiled headers.
54 * C++ ABI:: Controlling C++ ABI changes.
55 * D Language and ABI:: Controlling D ABI changes.
56 * Named Address Spaces:: Adding support for named address spaces
57 * Misc:: Everything else.
58 @end menu
59
60 @node Target Structure
61 @section The Global @code{targetm} Variable
62 @cindex target hooks
63 @cindex target functions
64
65 @deftypevar {struct gcc_target} targetm
66 The target @file{.c} file must define the global @code{targetm} variable
67 which contains pointers to functions and data relating to the target
68 machine. The variable is declared in @file{target.h};
69 @file{target-def.h} defines the macro @code{TARGET_INITIALIZER} which is
70 used to initialize the variable, and macros for the default initializers
71 for elements of the structure. The @file{.c} file should override those
72 macros for which the default definition is inappropriate. For example:
73 @smallexample
74 #include "target.h"
75 #include "target-def.h"
76
77 /* @r{Initialize the GCC target structure.} */
78
79 #undef TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES
80 #define TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES @var{machine}_comp_type_attributes
81
82 struct gcc_target targetm = TARGET_INITIALIZER;
83 @end smallexample
84 @end deftypevar
85
86 Where a macro should be defined in the @file{.c} file in this manner to
87 form part of the @code{targetm} structure, it is documented below as a
88 ``Target Hook'' with a prototype. Many macros will change in future
89 from being defined in the @file{.h} file to being part of the
90 @code{targetm} structure.
91
92 Similarly, there is a @code{targetcm} variable for hooks that are
93 specific to front ends for C-family languages, documented as ``C
94 Target Hook''. This is declared in @file{c-family/c-target.h}, the
95 initializer @code{TARGETCM_INITIALIZER} in
96 @file{c-family/c-target-def.h}. If targets initialize @code{targetcm}
97 themselves, they should set @code{target_has_targetcm=yes} in
98 @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a default definition is used.
99
100 Similarly, there is a @code{targetm_common} variable for hooks that
101 are shared between the compiler driver and the compilers proper,
102 documented as ``Common Target Hook''. This is declared in
103 @file{common/common-target.h}, the initializer
104 @code{TARGETM_COMMON_INITIALIZER} in
105 @file{common/common-target-def.h}. If targets initialize
106 @code{targetm_common} themselves, they should set
107 @code{target_has_targetm_common=yes} in @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a
108 default definition is used.
109
110 Similarly, there is a @code{targetdm} variable for hooks that are
111 specific to the D language front end, documented as ``D Target Hook''.
112 This is declared in @file{d/d-target.h}, the initializer
113 @code{TARGETDM_INITIALIZER} in @file{d/d-target-def.h}. If targets
114 initialize @code{targetdm} themselves, they should set
115 @code{target_has_targetdm=yes} in @file{config.gcc}; otherwise a default
116 definition is used.
117
118 @node Driver
119 @section Controlling the Compilation Driver, @file{gcc}
120 @cindex driver
121 @cindex controlling the compilation driver
122
123 @c prevent bad page break with this line
124 You can control the compilation driver.
125
126 @defmac DRIVER_SELF_SPECS
127 A list of specs for the driver itself. It should be a suitable
128 initializer for an array of strings, with no surrounding braces.
129
130 The driver applies these specs to its own command line between loading
131 default @file{specs} files (but not command-line specified ones) and
132 choosing the multilib directory or running any subcommands. It
133 applies them in the order given, so each spec can depend on the
134 options added by earlier ones. It is also possible to remove options
135 using @samp{%<@var{option}} in the usual way.
136
137 This macro can be useful when a port has several interdependent target
138 options. It provides a way of standardizing the command line so
139 that the other specs are easier to write.
140
141 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
142 @end defmac
143
144 @defmac OPTION_DEFAULT_SPECS
145 A list of specs used to support configure-time default options (i.e.@:
146 @option{--with} options) in the driver. It should be a suitable initializer
147 for an array of structures, each containing two strings, without the
148 outermost pair of surrounding braces.
149
150 The first item in the pair is the name of the default. This must match
151 the code in @file{config.gcc} for the target. The second item is a spec
152 to apply if a default with this name was specified. The string
153 @samp{%(VALUE)} in the spec will be replaced by the value of the default
154 everywhere it occurs.
155
156 The driver will apply these specs to its own command line between loading
157 default @file{specs} files and processing @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}, using
158 the same mechanism as @code{DRIVER_SELF_SPECS}.
159
160 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
161 @end defmac
162
163 @defmac CPP_SPEC
164 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
165 pass to CPP@. It can also specify how to translate options you
166 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the CPP@.
167
168 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
169 @end defmac
170
171 @defmac CPLUSPLUS_CPP_SPEC
172 This macro is just like @code{CPP_SPEC}, but is used for C++, rather
173 than C@. If you do not define this macro, then the value of
174 @code{CPP_SPEC} (if any) will be used instead.
175 @end defmac
176
177 @defmac CC1_SPEC
178 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
179 pass to @code{cc1}, @code{cc1plus}, @code{f771}, and the other language
180 front ends.
181 It can also specify how to translate options you give to GCC into options
182 for GCC to pass to front ends.
183
184 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
185 @end defmac
186
187 @defmac CC1PLUS_SPEC
188 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
189 pass to @code{cc1plus}. It can also specify how to translate options you
190 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the @code{cc1plus}.
191
192 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
193 Note that everything defined in CC1_SPEC is already passed to
194 @code{cc1plus} so there is no need to duplicate the contents of
195 CC1_SPEC in CC1PLUS_SPEC@.
196 @end defmac
197
198 @defmac ASM_SPEC
199 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
200 pass to the assembler. It can also specify how to translate options
201 you give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the assembler.
202 See the file @file{sun3.h} for an example of this.
203
204 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
205 @end defmac
206
207 @defmac ASM_FINAL_SPEC
208 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program how to
209 run any programs which cleanup after the normal assembler.
210 Normally, this is not needed. See the file @file{mips.h} for
211 an example of this.
212
213 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
214 @end defmac
215
216 @defmac AS_NEEDS_DASH_FOR_PIPED_INPUT
217 Define this macro, with no value, if the driver should give the assembler
218 an argument consisting of a single dash, @option{-}, to instruct it to
219 read from its standard input (which will be a pipe connected to the
220 output of the compiler proper). This argument is given after any
221 @option{-o} option specifying the name of the output file.
222
223 If you do not define this macro, the assembler is assumed to read its
224 standard input if given no non-option arguments. If your assembler
225 cannot read standard input at all, use a @samp{%@{pipe:%e@}} construct;
226 see @file{mips.h} for instance.
227 @end defmac
228
229 @defmac LINK_SPEC
230 A C string constant that tells the GCC driver program options to
231 pass to the linker. It can also specify how to translate options you
232 give to GCC into options for GCC to pass to the linker.
233
234 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
235 @end defmac
236
237 @defmac LIB_SPEC
238 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The difference
239 between the two is that @code{LIB_SPEC} is used at the end of the
240 command given to the linker.
241
242 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that
243 loads the standard C library from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
244 @end defmac
245
246 @defmac LIBGCC_SPEC
247 Another C string constant that tells the GCC driver program
248 how and when to place a reference to @file{libgcc.a} into the
249 linker command line. This constant is placed both before and after
250 the value of @code{LIB_SPEC}.
251
252 If this macro is not defined, the GCC driver provides a default that
253 passes the string @option{-lgcc} to the linker.
254 @end defmac
255
256 @defmac REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC
257 By default, if @code{ENABLE_SHARED_LIBGCC} is defined, the
258 @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} is not directly used by the driver program but is
259 instead modified to refer to different versions of @file{libgcc.a}
260 depending on the values of the command line flags @option{-static},
261 @option{-shared}, @option{-static-libgcc}, and @option{-shared-libgcc}. On
262 targets where these modifications are inappropriate, define
263 @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} instead. @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC} tells the
264 driver how to place a reference to @file{libgcc} on the link command
265 line, but, unlike @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}, it is used unmodified.
266 @end defmac
267
268 @defmac USE_LD_AS_NEEDED
269 A macro that controls the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC}
270 mentioned in @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}. If nonzero, a spec will be
271 generated that uses @option{--as-needed} or equivalent options and the
272 shared @file{libgcc} in place of the
273 static exception handler library, when linking without any of
274 @code{-static}, @code{-static-libgcc}, or @code{-shared-libgcc}.
275 @end defmac
276
277 @defmac LINK_EH_SPEC
278 If defined, this C string constant is added to @code{LINK_SPEC}.
279 When @code{USE_LD_AS_NEEDED} is zero or undefined, it also affects
280 the modifications to @code{LIBGCC_SPEC} mentioned in
281 @code{REAL_LIBGCC_SPEC}.
282 @end defmac
283
284 @defmac STARTFILE_SPEC
285 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
286 difference between the two is that @code{STARTFILE_SPEC} is used at
287 the very beginning of the command given to the linker.
288
289 If this macro is not defined, a default is provided that loads the
290 standard C startup file from the usual place. See @file{gcc.c}.
291 @end defmac
292
293 @defmac ENDFILE_SPEC
294 Another C string constant used much like @code{LINK_SPEC}. The
295 difference between the two is that @code{ENDFILE_SPEC} is used at
296 the very end of the command given to the linker.
297
298 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
299 @end defmac
300
301 @defmac THREAD_MODEL_SPEC
302 GCC @code{-v} will print the thread model GCC was configured to use.
303 However, this doesn't work on platforms that are multilibbed on thread
304 models, such as AIX 4.3. On such platforms, define
305 @code{THREAD_MODEL_SPEC} such that it evaluates to a string without
306 blanks that names one of the recognized thread models. @code{%*}, the
307 default value of this macro, will expand to the value of
308 @code{thread_file} set in @file{config.gcc}.
309 @end defmac
310
311 @defmac SYSROOT_SUFFIX_SPEC
312 Define this macro to add a suffix to the target sysroot when GCC is
313 configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to search for usr/lib,
314 et al, within sysroot+suffix.
315 @end defmac
316
317 @defmac SYSROOT_HEADERS_SUFFIX_SPEC
318 Define this macro to add a headers_suffix to the target sysroot when
319 GCC is configured with a sysroot. This will cause GCC to pass the
320 updated sysroot+headers_suffix to CPP, causing it to search for
321 usr/include, et al, within sysroot+headers_suffix.
322 @end defmac
323
324 @defmac EXTRA_SPECS
325 Define this macro to provide additional specifications to put in the
326 @file{specs} file that can be used in various specifications like
327 @code{CC1_SPEC}.
328
329 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures,
330 containing a string constant, that defines the specification name, and a
331 string constant that provides the specification.
332
333 Do not define this macro if it does not need to do anything.
334
335 @code{EXTRA_SPECS} is useful when an architecture contains several
336 related targets, which have various @code{@dots{}_SPECS} which are similar
337 to each other, and the maintainer would like one central place to keep
338 these definitions.
339
340 For example, the PowerPC System V.4 targets use @code{EXTRA_SPECS} to
341 define either @code{_CALL_SYSV} when the System V calling sequence is
342 used or @code{_CALL_AIX} when the older AIX-based calling sequence is
343 used.
344
345 The @file{config/rs6000/rs6000.h} target file defines:
346
347 @smallexample
348 #define EXTRA_SPECS \
349 @{ "cpp_sysv_default", CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT @},
350
351 #define CPP_SYS_DEFAULT ""
352 @end smallexample
353
354 The @file{config/rs6000/sysv.h} target file defines:
355 @smallexample
356 #undef CPP_SPEC
357 #define CPP_SPEC \
358 "%@{posix: -D_POSIX_SOURCE @} \
359 %@{mcall-sysv: -D_CALL_SYSV @} \
360 %@{!mcall-sysv: %(cpp_sysv_default) @} \
361 %@{msoft-float: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@} %@{mcpu=403: -D_SOFT_FLOAT@}"
362
363 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
364 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_SYSV"
365 @end smallexample
366
367 while the @file{config/rs6000/eabiaix.h} target file defines
368 @code{CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT} as:
369
370 @smallexample
371 #undef CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT
372 #define CPP_SYSV_DEFAULT "-D_CALL_AIX"
373 @end smallexample
374 @end defmac
375
376 @defmac LINK_LIBGCC_SPECIAL_1
377 Define this macro if the driver program should find the library
378 @file{libgcc.a}. If you do not define this macro, the driver program will pass
379 the argument @option{-lgcc} to tell the linker to do the search.
380 @end defmac
381
382 @defmac LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC
383 The sequence in which libgcc and libc are specified to the linker.
384 By default this is @code{%G %L %G}.
385 @end defmac
386
387 @defmac POST_LINK_SPEC
388 Define this macro to add additional steps to be executed after linker.
389 The default value of this macro is empty string.
390 @end defmac
391
392 @defmac LINK_COMMAND_SPEC
393 A C string constant giving the complete command line need to execute the
394 linker. When you do this, you will need to update your port each time a
395 change is made to the link command line within @file{gcc.c}. Therefore,
396 define this macro only if you need to completely redefine the command
397 line for invoking the linker and there is no other way to accomplish
398 the effect you need. Overriding this macro may be avoidable by overriding
399 @code{LINK_GCC_C_SEQUENCE_SPEC} instead.
400 @end defmac
401
402 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALWAYS_STRIP_DOTDOT
403 True if @file{..} components should always be removed from directory names computed relative to GCC's internal directories, false (default) if such components should be preserved and directory names containing them passed to other tools such as the linker.
404 @end deftypevr
405
406 @defmac MULTILIB_DEFAULTS
407 Define this macro as a C expression for the initializer of an array of
408 string to tell the driver program which options are defaults for this
409 target and thus do not need to be handled specially when using
410 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS}.
411
412 Do not define this macro if @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} is not defined in
413 the target makefile fragment or if none of the options listed in
414 @code{MULTILIB_OPTIONS} are set by default.
415 @xref{Target Fragment}.
416 @end defmac
417
418 @defmac RELATIVE_PREFIX_NOT_LINKDIR
419 Define this macro to tell @command{gcc} that it should only translate
420 a @option{-B} prefix into a @option{-L} linker option if the prefix
421 indicates an absolute file name.
422 @end defmac
423
424 @defmac MD_EXEC_PREFIX
425 If defined, this macro is an additional prefix to try after
426 @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched
427 when the compiler is built as a cross
428 compiler. If you define @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, then be sure to add it
429 to the list of directories used to find the assembler in @file{configure.ac}.
430 @end defmac
431
432 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
433 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
434 standard choice of @code{libdir} as the default prefix to
435 try when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
436 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX} is not searched when the compiler
437 is built as a cross compiler.
438 @end defmac
439
440 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
441 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
442 standard choice of @code{/lib} as a prefix to try after the default prefix
443 when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
444 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1} is not searched when the compiler
445 is built as a cross compiler.
446 @end defmac
447
448 @defmac STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2
449 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
450 standard choice of @code{/lib} as yet another prefix to try after the
451 default prefix when searching for startup files such as @file{crt0.o}.
452 @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2} is not searched when the compiler
453 is built as a cross compiler.
454 @end defmac
455
456 @defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX
457 If defined, this macro supplies an additional prefix to try after the
458 standard prefixes. @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX} is not searched when the
459 compiler is built as a cross compiler.
460 @end defmac
461
462 @defmac MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1
463 If defined, this macro supplies yet another prefix to try after the
464 standard prefixes. It is not searched when the compiler is built as a
465 cross compiler.
466 @end defmac
467
468 @defmac INIT_ENVIRONMENT
469 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to set environment
470 variables for programs called by the driver, such as the assembler and
471 loader. The driver passes the value of this macro to @code{putenv} to
472 initialize the necessary environment variables.
473 @end defmac
474
475 @defmac LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR
476 Define this macro as a C string constant if you wish to override the
477 standard choice of @file{/usr/local/include} as the default prefix to
478 try when searching for local header files. @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR}
479 comes before @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR} (set in
480 @file{config.gcc}, normally @file{/usr/include}) in the search order.
481
482 Cross compilers do not search either @file{/usr/local/include} or its
483 replacement.
484 @end defmac
485
486 @defmac NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_COMPONENT
487 The ``component'' corresponding to @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}.
488 See @code{INCLUDE_DEFAULTS}, below, for the description of components.
489 If you do not define this macro, no component is used.
490 @end defmac
491
492 @defmac INCLUDE_DEFAULTS
493 Define this macro if you wish to override the entire default search path
494 for include files. For a native compiler, the default search path
495 usually consists of @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR}, @code{LOCAL_INCLUDE_DIR},
496 @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}, and
497 @code{NATIVE_SYSTEM_HEADER_DIR}. In addition, @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR}
498 and @code{GCC_INCLUDE_DIR} are defined automatically by @file{Makefile},
499 and specify private search areas for GCC@. The directory
500 @code{GPLUSPLUS_INCLUDE_DIR} is used only for C++ programs.
501
502 The definition should be an initializer for an array of structures.
503 Each array element should have four elements: the directory name (a
504 string constant), the component name (also a string constant), a flag
505 for C++-only directories,
506 and a flag showing that the includes in the directory don't need to be
507 wrapped in @code{extern @samp{C}} when compiling C++. Mark the end of
508 the array with a null element.
509
510 The component name denotes what GNU package the include file is part of,
511 if any, in all uppercase letters. For example, it might be @samp{GCC}
512 or @samp{BINUTILS}. If the package is part of a vendor-supplied
513 operating system, code the component name as @samp{0}.
514
515 For example, here is the definition used for VAX/VMS:
516
517 @smallexample
518 #define INCLUDE_DEFAULTS \
519 @{ \
520 @{ "GNU_GXX_INCLUDE:", "G++", 1, 1@}, \
521 @{ "GNU_CC_INCLUDE:", "GCC", 0, 0@}, \
522 @{ "SYS$SYSROOT:[SYSLIB.]", 0, 0, 0@}, \
523 @{ ".", 0, 0, 0@}, \
524 @{ 0, 0, 0, 0@} \
525 @}
526 @end smallexample
527 @end defmac
528
529 Here is the order of prefixes tried for exec files:
530
531 @enumerate
532 @item
533 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
534
535 @item
536 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or, if @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX}
537 is not set and the compiler has not been installed in the configure-time
538 @var{prefix}, the location in which the compiler has actually been installed.
539
540 @item
541 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{COMPILER_PATH}.
542
543 @item
544 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if the compiler has been installed
545 in the configured-time @var{prefix}.
546
547 @item
548 The location @file{/usr/libexec/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
549
550 @item
551 The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
552
553 @item
554 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
555 compiler.
556 @end enumerate
557
558 Here is the order of prefixes tried for startfiles:
559
560 @enumerate
561 @item
562 Any prefixes specified by the user with @option{-B}.
563
564 @item
565 The environment variable @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} or its automatically determined
566 value based on the installed toolchain location.
567
568 @item
569 The directories specified by the environment variable @code{LIBRARY_PATH}
570 (or port-specific name; native only, cross compilers do not use this).
571
572 @item
573 The macro @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX}, but only if the toolchain is installed
574 in the configured @var{prefix} or this is a native compiler.
575
576 @item
577 The location @file{/usr/lib/gcc/}, but only if this is a native compiler.
578
579 @item
580 The macro @code{MD_EXEC_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a native
581 compiler.
582
583 @item
584 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, if defined, but only if this is a
585 native compiler, or we have a target system root.
586
587 @item
588 The macro @code{MD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, if defined, but only if this is a
589 native compiler, or we have a target system root.
590
591 @item
592 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX}, with any sysroot modifications.
593 If this path is relative it will be prefixed by @code{GCC_EXEC_PREFIX} and
594 the machine suffix or @code{STANDARD_EXEC_PREFIX} and the machine suffix.
595
596 @item
597 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_1}, but only if this is a native
598 compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
599 @file{/lib/}.
600
601 @item
602 The macro @code{STANDARD_STARTFILE_PREFIX_2}, but only if this is a native
603 compiler, or we have a target system root. The default for this macro is
604 @file{/usr/lib/}.
605 @end enumerate
606
607 @node Run-time Target
608 @section Run-time Target Specification
609 @cindex run-time target specification
610 @cindex predefined macros
611 @cindex target specifications
612
613 @c prevent bad page break with this line
614 Here are run-time target specifications.
615
616 @defmac TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS ()
617 This function-like macro expands to a block of code that defines
618 built-in preprocessor macros and assertions for the target CPU, using
619 the functions @code{builtin_define}, @code{builtin_define_std} and
620 @code{builtin_assert}. When the front end
621 calls this macro it provides a trailing semicolon, and since it has
622 finished command line option processing your code can use those
623 results freely.
624
625 @code{builtin_assert} takes a string in the form you pass to the
626 command-line option @option{-A}, such as @code{cpu=mips}, and creates
627 the assertion. @code{builtin_define} takes a string in the form
628 accepted by option @option{-D} and unconditionally defines the macro.
629
630 @code{builtin_define_std} takes a string representing the name of an
631 object-like macro. If it doesn't lie in the user's namespace,
632 @code{builtin_define_std} defines it unconditionally. Otherwise, it
633 defines a version with two leading underscores, and another version
634 with two leading and trailing underscores, and defines the original
635 only if an ISO standard was not requested on the command line. For
636 example, passing @code{unix} defines @code{__unix}, @code{__unix__}
637 and possibly @code{unix}; passing @code{_mips} defines @code{__mips},
638 @code{__mips__} and possibly @code{_mips}, and passing @code{_ABI64}
639 defines only @code{_ABI64}.
640
641 You can also test for the C dialect being compiled. The variable
642 @code{c_language} is set to one of @code{clk_c}, @code{clk_cplusplus}
643 or @code{clk_objective_c}. Note that if we are preprocessing
644 assembler, this variable will be @code{clk_c} but the function-like
645 macro @code{preprocessing_asm_p()} will return true, so you might want
646 to check for that first. If you need to check for strict ANSI, the
647 variable @code{flag_iso} can be used. The function-like macro
648 @code{preprocessing_trad_p()} can be used to check for traditional
649 preprocessing.
650 @end defmac
651
652 @defmac TARGET_OS_CPP_BUILTINS ()
653 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
654 and is used for the target operating system instead.
655 @end defmac
656
657 @defmac TARGET_OBJFMT_CPP_BUILTINS ()
658 Similarly to @code{TARGET_CPU_CPP_BUILTINS} but this macro is optional
659 and is used for the target object format. @file{elfos.h} uses this
660 macro to define @code{__ELF__}, so you probably do not need to define
661 it yourself.
662 @end defmac
663
664 @deftypevar {extern int} target_flags
665 This variable is declared in @file{options.h}, which is included before
666 any target-specific headers.
667 @end deftypevar
668
669 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} int TARGET_DEFAULT_TARGET_FLAGS
670 This variable specifies the initial value of @code{target_flags}.
671 Its default setting is 0.
672 @end deftypevr
673
674 @cindex optional hardware or system features
675 @cindex features, optional, in system conventions
676
677 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION (struct gcc_options *@var{opts}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts_set}, const struct cl_decoded_option *@var{decoded}, location_t @var{loc})
678 This hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
679 target-specific options described by the @file{.opt} definition files
680 (@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some option-specific
681 processing and should return true if the option is valid. The default
682 definition does nothing but return true.
683
684 @var{decoded} specifies the option and its arguments. @var{opts} and
685 @var{opts_set} are the @code{gcc_options} structures to be used for
686 storing option state, and @var{loc} is the location at which the
687 option was passed (@code{UNKNOWN_LOCATION} except for options passed
688 via attributes).
689 @end deftypefn
690
691 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION (size_t @var{code}, const char *@var{arg}, int @var{value})
692 This target hook is called whenever the user specifies one of the
693 target-specific C language family options described by the @file{.opt}
694 definition files(@pxref{Options}). It has the opportunity to do some
695 option-specific processing and should return true if the option is
696 valid. The arguments are like for @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION}. The
697 default definition does nothing but return false.
698
699 In general, you should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_OPTION} to handle
700 options. However, if processing an option requires routines that are
701 only available in the C (and related language) front ends, then you
702 should use @code{TARGET_HANDLE_C_OPTION} instead.
703 @end deftypefn
704
705 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} tree TARGET_OBJC_CONSTRUCT_STRING_OBJECT (tree @var{string})
706 Targets may provide a string object type that can be used within and between C, C++ and their respective Objective-C dialects. A string object might, for example, embed encoding and length information. These objects are considered opaque to the compiler and handled as references. An ideal implementation makes the composition of the string object match that of the Objective-C @code{NSString} (@code{NXString} for GNUStep), allowing efficient interworking between C-only and Objective-C code. If a target implements string objects then this hook should return a reference to such an object constructed from the normal `C' string representation provided in @var{string}. At present, the hook is used by Objective-C only, to obtain a common-format string object when the target provides one.
707 @end deftypefn
708
709 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_UNRESOLVED_CLASS_REFERENCE (const char *@var{classname})
710 Declare that Objective C class @var{classname} is referenced by the current TU.
711 @end deftypefn
712
713 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_OBJC_DECLARE_CLASS_DEFINITION (const char *@var{classname})
714 Declare that Objective C class @var{classname} is defined by the current TU.
715 @end deftypefn
716
717 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRING_OBJECT_REF_TYPE_P (const_tree @var{stringref})
718 If a target implements string objects then this hook should return @code{true} if @var{stringref} is a valid reference to such an object.
719 @end deftypefn
720
721 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} void TARGET_CHECK_STRING_OBJECT_FORMAT_ARG (tree @var{format_arg}, tree @var{args_list})
722 If a target implements string objects then this hook should should provide a facility to check the function arguments in @var{args_list} against the format specifiers in @var{format_arg} where the type of @var{format_arg} is one recognized as a valid string reference type.
723 @end deftypefn
724
725 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE (void)
726 This target function is similar to the hook @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}
727 but is called when the optimize level is changed via an attribute or
728 pragma or when it is reset at the end of the code affected by the
729 attribute or pragma. It is not called at the beginning of compilation
730 when @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} is called so if you want to perform these
731 actions then, you should have @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} call
732 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}.
733 @end deftypefn
734
735 @defmac C_COMMON_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS
736 This is similar to the @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} hook
737 but is only used in the C
738 language frontends (C, Objective-C, C++, Objective-C++) and so can be
739 used to alter option flag variables which only exist in those
740 frontends.
741 @end defmac
742
743 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} {const struct default_options *} TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION_TABLE
744 Some machines may desire to change what optimizations are performed for
745 various optimization levels. This variable, if defined, describes
746 options to enable at particular sets of optimization levels. These
747 options are processed once
748 just after the optimization level is determined and before the remainder
749 of the command options have been parsed, so may be overridden by other
750 options passed explicitly.
751
752 This processing is run once at program startup and when the optimization
753 options are changed via @code{#pragma GCC optimize} or by using the
754 @code{optimize} attribute.
755 @end deftypevr
756
757 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_INIT_STRUCT (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
758 Set target-dependent initial values of fields in @var{opts}.
759 @end deftypefn
760
761 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_DEFAULT_PARAMS (void)
762 Set target-dependent default values for @option{--param} settings, using calls to @code{set_default_param_value}.
763 @end deftypefn
764
765 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_VALIDATE_PARAM (int, @var{int})
766 Validate target-dependent value for @option{--param} settings, using calls to @code{set_param_value}.
767 @end deftypefn
768
769 @defmac SWITCHABLE_TARGET
770 Some targets need to switch between substantially different subtargets
771 during compilation. For example, the MIPS target has one subtarget for
772 the traditional MIPS architecture and another for MIPS16. Source code
773 can switch between these two subarchitectures using the @code{mips16}
774 and @code{nomips16} attributes.
775
776 Such subtargets can differ in things like the set of available
777 registers, the set of available instructions, the costs of various
778 operations, and so on. GCC caches a lot of this type of information
779 in global variables, and recomputing them for each subtarget takes a
780 significant amount of time. The compiler therefore provides a facility
781 for maintaining several versions of the global variables and quickly
782 switching between them; see @file{target-globals.h} for details.
783
784 Define this macro to 1 if your target needs this facility. The default
785 is 0.
786 @end defmac
787
788 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FLOAT_EXCEPTIONS_ROUNDING_SUPPORTED_P (void)
789 Returns true if the target supports IEEE 754 floating-point exceptions and rounding modes, false otherwise. This is intended to relate to the @code{float} and @code{double} types, but not necessarily @code{long double}. By default, returns true if the @code{adddf3} instruction pattern is available and false otherwise, on the assumption that hardware floating point supports exceptions and rounding modes but software floating point does not.
790 @end deftypefn
791
792 @node Per-Function Data
793 @section Defining data structures for per-function information.
794 @cindex per-function data
795 @cindex data structures
796
797 If the target needs to store information on a per-function basis, GCC
798 provides a macro and a couple of variables to allow this. Note, just
799 using statics to store the information is a bad idea, since GCC supports
800 nested functions, so you can be halfway through encoding one function
801 when another one comes along.
802
803 GCC defines a data structure called @code{struct function} which
804 contains all of the data specific to an individual function. This
805 structure contains a field called @code{machine} whose type is
806 @code{struct machine_function *}, which can be used by targets to point
807 to their own specific data.
808
809 If a target needs per-function specific data it should define the type
810 @code{struct machine_function} and also the macro @code{INIT_EXPANDERS}.
811 This macro should be used to initialize the function pointer
812 @code{init_machine_status}. This pointer is explained below.
813
814 One typical use of per-function, target specific data is to create an
815 RTX to hold the register containing the function's return address. This
816 RTX can then be used to implement the @code{__builtin_return_address}
817 function, for level 0.
818
819 Note---earlier implementations of GCC used a single data area to hold
820 all of the per-function information. Thus when processing of a nested
821 function began the old per-function data had to be pushed onto a
822 stack, and when the processing was finished, it had to be popped off the
823 stack. GCC used to provide function pointers called
824 @code{save_machine_status} and @code{restore_machine_status} to handle
825 the saving and restoring of the target specific information. Since the
826 single data area approach is no longer used, these pointers are no
827 longer supported.
828
829 @defmac INIT_EXPANDERS
830 Macro called to initialize any target specific information. This macro
831 is called once per function, before generation of any RTL has begun.
832 The intention of this macro is to allow the initialization of the
833 function pointer @code{init_machine_status}.
834 @end defmac
835
836 @deftypevar {void (*)(struct function *)} init_machine_status
837 If this function pointer is non-@code{NULL} it will be called once per
838 function, before function compilation starts, in order to allow the
839 target to perform any target specific initialization of the
840 @code{struct function} structure. It is intended that this would be
841 used to initialize the @code{machine} of that structure.
842
843 @code{struct machine_function} structures are expected to be freed by GC@.
844 Generally, any memory that they reference must be allocated by using
845 GC allocation, including the structure itself.
846 @end deftypevar
847
848 @node Storage Layout
849 @section Storage Layout
850 @cindex storage layout
851
852 Note that the definitions of the macros in this table which are sizes or
853 alignments measured in bits do not need to be constant. They can be C
854 expressions that refer to static variables, such as the @code{target_flags}.
855 @xref{Run-time Target}.
856
857 @defmac BITS_BIG_ENDIAN
858 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant bit in a
859 byte has the lowest number; otherwise define it to have the value zero.
860 This means that bit-field instructions count from the most significant
861 bit. If the machine has no bit-field instructions, then this must still
862 be defined, but it doesn't matter which value it is defined to. This
863 macro need not be a constant.
864
865 This macro does not affect the way structure fields are packed into
866 bytes or words; that is controlled by @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN}.
867 @end defmac
868
869 @defmac BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN
870 Define this macro to have the value 1 if the most significant byte in a
871 word has the lowest number. This macro need not be a constant.
872 @end defmac
873
874 @defmac WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
875 Define this macro to have the value 1 if, in a multiword object, the
876 most significant word has the lowest number. This applies to both
877 memory locations and registers; see @code{REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} if the
878 order of words in memory is not the same as the order in registers. This
879 macro need not be a constant.
880 @end defmac
881
882 @defmac REG_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
883 On some machines, the order of words in a multiword object differs between
884 registers in memory. In such a situation, define this macro to describe
885 the order of words in a register. The macro @code{WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN} controls
886 the order of words in memory.
887 @end defmac
888
889 @defmac FLOAT_WORDS_BIG_ENDIAN
890 Define this macro to have the value 1 if @code{DFmode}, @code{XFmode} or
891 @code{TFmode} floating point numbers are stored in memory with the word
892 containing the sign bit at the lowest address; otherwise define it to
893 have the value 0. This macro need not be a constant.
894
895 You need not define this macro if the ordering is the same as for
896 multi-word integers.
897 @end defmac
898
899 @defmac BITS_PER_WORD
900 Number of bits in a word. If you do not define this macro, the default
901 is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * UNITS_PER_WORD}.
902 @end defmac
903
904 @defmac MAX_BITS_PER_WORD
905 Maximum number of bits in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
906 @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
907 largest value that @code{BITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
908 @end defmac
909
910 @defmac UNITS_PER_WORD
911 Number of storage units in a word; normally the size of a general-purpose
912 register, a power of two from 1 or 8.
913 @end defmac
914
915 @defmac MIN_UNITS_PER_WORD
916 Minimum number of units in a word. If this is undefined, the default is
917 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. Otherwise, it is the constant value that is the
918 smallest value that @code{UNITS_PER_WORD} can have at run-time.
919 @end defmac
920
921 @defmac POINTER_SIZE
922 Width of a pointer, in bits. You must specify a value no wider than the
923 width of @code{Pmode}. If it is not equal to the width of @code{Pmode},
924 you must define @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED}. If you do not specify
925 a value the default is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
926 @end defmac
927
928 @defmac POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED
929 A C expression that determines how pointers should be extended from
930 @code{ptr_mode} to either @code{Pmode} or @code{word_mode}. It is
931 greater than zero if pointers should be zero-extended, zero if they
932 should be sign-extended, and negative if some other sort of conversion
933 is needed. In the last case, the extension is done by the target's
934 @code{ptr_extend} instruction.
935
936 You need not define this macro if the @code{ptr_mode}, @code{Pmode}
937 and @code{word_mode} are all the same width.
938 @end defmac
939
940 @defmac PROMOTE_MODE (@var{m}, @var{unsignedp}, @var{type})
941 A macro to update @var{m} and @var{unsignedp} when an object whose type
942 is @var{type} and which has the specified mode and signedness is to be
943 stored in a register. This macro is only called when @var{type} is a
944 scalar type.
945
946 On most RISC machines, which only have operations that operate on a full
947 register, define this macro to set @var{m} to @code{word_mode} if
948 @var{m} is an integer mode narrower than @code{BITS_PER_WORD}. In most
949 cases, only integer modes should be widened because wider-precision
950 floating-point operations are usually more expensive than their narrower
951 counterparts.
952
953 For most machines, the macro definition does not change @var{unsignedp}.
954 However, some machines, have instructions that preferentially handle
955 either signed or unsigned quantities of certain modes. For example, on
956 the DEC Alpha, 32-bit loads from memory and 32-bit add instructions
957 sign-extend the result to 64 bits. On such machines, set
958 @var{unsignedp} according to which kind of extension is more efficient.
959
960 Do not define this macro if it would never modify @var{m}.
961 @end defmac
962
963 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum flt_eval_method} TARGET_C_EXCESS_PRECISION (enum excess_precision_type @var{type})
964 Return a value, with the same meaning as the C99 macro @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD} that describes which excess precision should be applied. @var{type} is either @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_IMPLICIT}, @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_FAST}, or @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_STANDARD}. For @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_IMPLICIT}, the target should return which precision and range operations will be implictly evaluated in regardless of the excess precision explicitly added. For @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_STANDARD} and @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_FAST}, the target should return the explicit excess precision that should be added depending on the value set for @option{-fexcess-precision=@r{[}standard@r{|}fast@r{]}}. Note that unpredictable explicit excess precision does not make sense, so a target should never return @code{FLT_EVAL_METHOD_UNPREDICTABLE} when @var{type} is @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_STANDARD} or @code{EXCESS_PRECISION_TYPE_FAST}.
965 @end deftypefn
966
967 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_MODE (const_tree @var{type}, machine_mode @var{mode}, int *@var{punsignedp}, const_tree @var{funtype}, int @var{for_return})
968 Like @code{PROMOTE_MODE}, but it is applied to outgoing function arguments or
969 function return values. The target hook should return the new mode
970 and possibly change @code{*@var{punsignedp}} if the promotion should
971 change signedness. This function is called only for scalar @emph{or
972 pointer} types.
973
974 @var{for_return} allows to distinguish the promotion of arguments and
975 return values. If it is @code{1}, a return value is being promoted and
976 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must perform the same promotions done here.
977 If it is @code{2}, the returned mode should be that of the register in
978 which an incoming parameter is copied, or the outgoing result is computed;
979 then the hook should return the same mode as @code{promote_mode}, though
980 the signedness may be different.
981
982 @var{type} can be NULL when promoting function arguments of libcalls.
983
984 The default is to not promote arguments and return values. You can
985 also define the hook to @code{default_promote_function_mode_always_promote}
986 if you would like to apply the same rules given by @code{PROMOTE_MODE}.
987 @end deftypefn
988
989 @defmac PARM_BOUNDARY
990 Normal alignment required for function parameters on the stack, in
991 bits. All stack parameters receive at least this much alignment
992 regardless of data type. On most machines, this is the same as the
993 size of an integer.
994 @end defmac
995
996 @defmac STACK_BOUNDARY
997 Define this macro to the minimum alignment enforced by hardware for the
998 stack pointer on this machine. The definition is a C expression for the
999 desired alignment (measured in bits). This value is used as a default
1000 if @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY} is not defined. On most machines,
1001 this should be the same as @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}.
1002 @end defmac
1003
1004 @defmac PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY
1005 Define this macro if you wish to preserve a certain alignment for the
1006 stack pointer, greater than what the hardware enforces. The definition
1007 is a C expression for the desired alignment (measured in bits). This
1008 macro must evaluate to a value equal to or larger than
1009 @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1010 @end defmac
1011
1012 @defmac INCOMING_STACK_BOUNDARY
1013 Define this macro if the incoming stack boundary may be different
1014 from @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}. This macro must evaluate
1015 to a value equal to or larger than @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1016 @end defmac
1017
1018 @defmac FUNCTION_BOUNDARY
1019 Alignment required for a function entry point, in bits.
1020 @end defmac
1021
1022 @defmac BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1023 Biggest alignment that any data type can require on this machine, in
1024 bits. Note that this is not the biggest alignment that is supported,
1025 just the biggest alignment that, when violated, may cause a fault.
1026 @end defmac
1027
1028 @deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_ABSOLUTE_BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT
1029 If defined, this target hook specifies the absolute biggest alignment
1030 that a type or variable can have on this machine, otherwise,
1031 @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} is used.
1032 @end deftypevr
1033
1034 @defmac MALLOC_ABI_ALIGNMENT
1035 Alignment, in bits, a C conformant malloc implementation has to
1036 provide. If not defined, the default value is @code{BITS_PER_WORD}.
1037 @end defmac
1038
1039 @defmac ATTRIBUTE_ALIGNED_VALUE
1040 Alignment used by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned))} construct. If
1041 not defined, the default value is @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1042 @end defmac
1043
1044 @defmac MINIMUM_ATOMIC_ALIGNMENT
1045 If defined, the smallest alignment, in bits, that can be given to an
1046 object that can be referenced in one operation, without disturbing any
1047 nearby object. Normally, this is @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}, but may be larger
1048 on machines that don't have byte or half-word store operations.
1049 @end defmac
1050
1051 @defmac BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT
1052 Biggest alignment that any structure or union field can require on this
1053 machine, in bits. If defined, this overrides @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} for
1054 structure and union fields only, unless the field alignment has been set
1055 by the @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct.
1056 @end defmac
1057
1058 @defmac ADJUST_FIELD_ALIGN (@var{field}, @var{type}, @var{computed})
1059 An expression for the alignment of a structure field @var{field} of
1060 type @var{type} if the alignment computed in the usual way (including
1061 applying of @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT} and @code{BIGGEST_FIELD_ALIGNMENT} to the
1062 alignment) is @var{computed}. It overrides alignment only if the
1063 field alignment has not been set by the
1064 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct. Note that @var{field}
1065 may be @code{NULL_TREE} in case we just query for the minimum alignment
1066 of a field of type @var{type} in structure context.
1067 @end defmac
1068
1069 @defmac MAX_STACK_ALIGNMENT
1070 Biggest stack alignment guaranteed by the backend. Use this macro
1071 to specify the maximum alignment of a variable on stack.
1072
1073 If not defined, the default value is @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1074
1075 @c FIXME: The default should be @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}.
1076 @c But the fix for PR 32893 indicates that we can only guarantee
1077 @c maximum stack alignment on stack up to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, not
1078 @c @code{PREFERRED_STACK_BOUNDARY}, if stack alignment isn't supported.
1079 @end defmac
1080
1081 @defmac MAX_OFILE_ALIGNMENT
1082 Biggest alignment supported by the object file format of this machine.
1083 Use this macro to limit the alignment which can be specified using the
1084 @code{__attribute__ ((aligned (@var{n})))} construct for functions and
1085 objects with static storage duration. The alignment of automatic
1086 objects may exceed the object file format maximum up to the maximum
1087 supported by GCC. If not defined, the default value is
1088 @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1089
1090 On systems that use ELF, the default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is
1091 the largest supported 32-bit ELF section alignment representable on
1092 a 32-bit host e.g.@: @samp{(((uint64_t) 1 << 28) * 8)}.
1093 On 32-bit ELF the largest supported section alignment in bits is
1094 @samp{(0x80000000 * 8)}, but this is not representable on 32-bit hosts.
1095 @end defmac
1096
1097 @deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_STATIC_RTX_ALIGNMENT (machine_mode @var{mode})
1098 This hook returns the preferred alignment in bits for a
1099 statically-allocated rtx, such as a constant pool entry. @var{mode}
1100 is the mode of the rtx. The default implementation returns
1101 @samp{GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (@var{mode})}.
1102 @end deftypefn
1103
1104 @defmac DATA_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1105 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1106 the static store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1107 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1108 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1109
1110 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1111
1112 @findex strcpy
1113 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1114 make it all fit in fewer cache lines. Another is to cause character
1115 arrays to be word-aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1116 constants to character arrays can be done inline.
1117 @end defmac
1118
1119 @defmac DATA_ABI_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1120 Similar to @code{DATA_ALIGNMENT}, but for the cases where the ABI mandates
1121 some alignment increase, instead of optimization only purposes. E.g.@
1122 AMD x86-64 psABI says that variables with array type larger than 15 bytes
1123 must be aligned to 16 byte boundaries.
1124
1125 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1126 @end defmac
1127
1128 @deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_CONSTANT_ALIGNMENT (const_tree @var{constant}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{basic_align})
1129 This hook returns the alignment in bits of a constant that is being
1130 placed in memory. @var{constant} is the constant and @var{basic_align}
1131 is the alignment that the object would ordinarily have.
1132
1133 The default definition just returns @var{basic_align}.
1134
1135 The typical use of this hook is to increase alignment for string
1136 constants to be word aligned so that @code{strcpy} calls that copy
1137 constants can be done inline. The function
1138 @code{constant_alignment_word_strings} provides such a definition.
1139 @end deftypefn
1140
1141 @defmac LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{basic-align})
1142 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a variable in
1143 the local store. @var{type} is the data type, and @var{basic-align} is
1144 the alignment that the object would ordinarily have. The value of this
1145 macro is used instead of that alignment to align the object.
1146
1147 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used.
1148
1149 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1150 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1151
1152 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1153 @end defmac
1154
1155 @deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT (const_tree @var{type})
1156 This hook can be used to define the alignment for a vector of type
1157 @var{type}, in order to comply with a platform ABI. The default is to
1158 require natural alignment for vector types. The alignment returned by
1159 this hook must be a power-of-two multiple of the default alignment of
1160 the vector element type.
1161 @end deftypefn
1162
1163 @defmac STACK_SLOT_ALIGNMENT (@var{type}, @var{mode}, @var{basic-align})
1164 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for stack slot.
1165 @var{type} is the data type, @var{mode} is the widest mode available,
1166 and @var{basic-align} is the alignment that the slot would ordinarily
1167 have. The value of this macro is used instead of that alignment to
1168 align the slot.
1169
1170 If this macro is not defined, then @var{basic-align} is used when
1171 @var{type} is @code{NULL}. Otherwise, @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT} will
1172 be used.
1173
1174 This macro is to set alignment of stack slot to the maximum alignment
1175 of all possible modes which the slot may have.
1176
1177 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1178 @end defmac
1179
1180 @defmac LOCAL_DECL_ALIGNMENT (@var{decl})
1181 If defined, a C expression to compute the alignment for a local
1182 variable @var{decl}.
1183
1184 If this macro is not defined, then
1185 @code{LOCAL_ALIGNMENT (TREE_TYPE (@var{decl}), DECL_ALIGN (@var{decl}))}
1186 is used.
1187
1188 One use of this macro is to increase alignment of medium-size data to
1189 make it all fit in fewer cache lines.
1190
1191 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
1192 @end defmac
1193
1194 @defmac MINIMUM_ALIGNMENT (@var{exp}, @var{mode}, @var{align})
1195 If defined, a C expression to compute the minimum required alignment
1196 for dynamic stack realignment purposes for @var{exp} (a type or decl),
1197 @var{mode}, assuming normal alignment @var{align}.
1198
1199 If this macro is not defined, then @var{align} will be used.
1200 @end defmac
1201
1202 @defmac EMPTY_FIELD_BOUNDARY
1203 Alignment in bits to be given to a structure bit-field that follows an
1204 empty field such as @code{int : 0;}.
1205
1206 If @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true, it overrides this macro.
1207 @end defmac
1208
1209 @defmac STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY
1210 Number of bits which any structure or union's size must be a multiple of.
1211 Each structure or union's size is rounded up to a multiple of this.
1212
1213 If you do not define this macro, the default is the same as
1214 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1215 @end defmac
1216
1217 @defmac STRICT_ALIGNMENT
1218 Define this macro to be the value 1 if instructions will fail to work
1219 if given data not on the nominal alignment. If instructions will merely
1220 go slower in that case, define this macro as 0.
1221 @end defmac
1222
1223 @defmac PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS
1224 Define this if you wish to imitate the way many other C compilers handle
1225 alignment of bit-fields and the structures that contain them.
1226
1227 The behavior is that the type written for a named bit-field (@code{int},
1228 @code{short}, or other integer type) imposes an alignment for the entire
1229 structure, as if the structure really did contain an ordinary field of
1230 that type. In addition, the bit-field is placed within the structure so
1231 that it would fit within such a field, not crossing a boundary for it.
1232
1233 Thus, on most machines, a named bit-field whose type is written as
1234 @code{int} would not cross a four-byte boundary, and would force
1235 four-byte alignment for the whole structure. (The alignment used may
1236 not be four bytes; it is controlled by the other alignment parameters.)
1237
1238 An unnamed bit-field will not affect the alignment of the containing
1239 structure.
1240
1241 If the macro is defined, its definition should be a C expression;
1242 a nonzero value for the expression enables this behavior.
1243
1244 Note that if this macro is not defined, or its value is zero, some
1245 bit-fields may cross more than one alignment boundary. The compiler can
1246 support such references if there are @samp{insv}, @samp{extv}, and
1247 @samp{extzv} insns that can directly reference memory.
1248
1249 The other known way of making bit-fields work is to define
1250 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} as large as @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}.
1251 Then every structure can be accessed with fullwords.
1252
1253 Unless the machine has bit-field instructions or you define
1254 @code{STRUCTURE_SIZE_BOUNDARY} that way, you must define
1255 @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} to have a nonzero value.
1256
1257 If your aim is to make GCC use the same conventions for laying out
1258 bit-fields as are used by another compiler, here is how to investigate
1259 what the other compiler does. Compile and run this program:
1260
1261 @smallexample
1262 struct foo1
1263 @{
1264 char x;
1265 char :0;
1266 char y;
1267 @};
1268
1269 struct foo2
1270 @{
1271 char x;
1272 int :0;
1273 char y;
1274 @};
1275
1276 main ()
1277 @{
1278 printf ("Size of foo1 is %d\n",
1279 sizeof (struct foo1));
1280 printf ("Size of foo2 is %d\n",
1281 sizeof (struct foo2));
1282 exit (0);
1283 @}
1284 @end smallexample
1285
1286 If this prints 2 and 5, then the compiler's behavior is what you would
1287 get from @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS}.
1288 @end defmac
1289
1290 @defmac BITFIELD_NBYTES_LIMITED
1291 Like @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} except that its effect is limited
1292 to aligning a bit-field within the structure.
1293 @end defmac
1294
1295 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALIGN_ANON_BITFIELD (void)
1296 When @code{PCC_BITFIELD_TYPE_MATTERS} is true this hook will determine
1297 whether unnamed bitfields affect the alignment of the containing
1298 structure. The hook should return true if the structure should inherit
1299 the alignment requirements of an unnamed bitfield's type.
1300 @end deftypefn
1301
1302 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NARROW_VOLATILE_BITFIELD (void)
1303 This target hook should return @code{true} if accesses to volatile bitfields
1304 should use the narrowest mode possible. It should return @code{false} if
1305 these accesses should use the bitfield container type.
1306
1307 The default is @code{false}.
1308 @end deftypefn
1309
1310 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MEMBER_TYPE_FORCES_BLK (const_tree @var{field}, machine_mode @var{mode})
1311 Return true if a structure, union or array containing @var{field} should
1312 be accessed using @code{BLKMODE}.
1313
1314 If @var{field} is the only field in the structure, @var{mode} is its
1315 mode, otherwise @var{mode} is VOIDmode. @var{mode} is provided in the
1316 case where structures of one field would require the structure's mode to
1317 retain the field's mode.
1318
1319 Normally, this is not needed.
1320 @end deftypefn
1321
1322 @defmac ROUND_TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type}, @var{computed}, @var{specified})
1323 Define this macro as an expression for the alignment of a type (given
1324 by @var{type} as a tree node) if the alignment computed in the usual
1325 way is @var{computed} and the alignment explicitly specified was
1326 @var{specified}.
1327
1328 The default is to use @var{specified} if it is larger; otherwise, use
1329 the smaller of @var{computed} and @code{BIGGEST_ALIGNMENT}
1330 @end defmac
1331
1332 @defmac MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE
1333 An integer expression for the size in bits of the largest integer
1334 machine mode that should actually be used. All integer machine modes of
1335 this size or smaller can be used for structures and unions with the
1336 appropriate sizes. If this macro is undefined, @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE
1337 (DImode)} is assumed.
1338 @end defmac
1339
1340 @defmac STACK_SAVEAREA_MODE (@var{save_level})
1341 If defined, an expression of type @code{machine_mode} that
1342 specifies the mode of the save area operand of a
1343 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1344 @var{save_level} is one of @code{SAVE_BLOCK}, @code{SAVE_FUNCTION}, or
1345 @code{SAVE_NONLOCAL} and selects which of the three named patterns is
1346 having its mode specified.
1347
1348 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{Pmode}. You
1349 would most commonly define this macro if the
1350 @code{save_stack_@var{level}} patterns need to support both a 32- and a
1351 64-bit mode.
1352 @end defmac
1353
1354 @defmac STACK_SIZE_MODE
1355 If defined, an expression of type @code{machine_mode} that
1356 specifies the mode of the size increment operand of an
1357 @code{allocate_stack} named pattern (@pxref{Standard Names}).
1358
1359 You need not define this macro if it always returns @code{word_mode}.
1360 You would most commonly define this macro if the @code{allocate_stack}
1361 pattern needs to support both a 32- and a 64-bit mode.
1362 @end defmac
1363
1364 @deftypefn {Target Hook} scalar_int_mode TARGET_LIBGCC_CMP_RETURN_MODE (void)
1365 This target hook should return the mode to be used for the return value
1366 of compare instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1367 @code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1368 targets.
1369 @end deftypefn
1370
1371 @deftypefn {Target Hook} scalar_int_mode TARGET_LIBGCC_SHIFT_COUNT_MODE (void)
1372 This target hook should return the mode to be used for the shift count operand
1373 of shift instructions expanded to libgcc calls. If not defined
1374 @code{word_mode} is returned which is the right choice for a majority of
1375 targets.
1376 @end deftypefn
1377
1378 @deftypefn {Target Hook} scalar_int_mode TARGET_UNWIND_WORD_MODE (void)
1379 Return machine mode to be used for @code{_Unwind_Word} type.
1380 The default is to use @code{word_mode}.
1381 @end deftypefn
1382
1383 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MS_BITFIELD_LAYOUT_P (const_tree @var{record_type})
1384 This target hook returns @code{true} if bit-fields in the given
1385 @var{record_type} are to be laid out following the rules of Microsoft
1386 Visual C/C++, namely: (i) a bit-field won't share the same storage
1387 unit with the previous bit-field if their underlying types have
1388 different sizes, and the bit-field will be aligned to the highest
1389 alignment of the underlying types of itself and of the previous
1390 bit-field; (ii) a zero-sized bit-field will affect the alignment of
1391 the whole enclosing structure, even if it is unnamed; except that
1392 (iii) a zero-sized bit-field will be disregarded unless it follows
1393 another bit-field of nonzero size. If this hook returns @code{true},
1394 other macros that control bit-field layout are ignored.
1395
1396 When a bit-field is inserted into a packed record, the whole size
1397 of the underlying type is used by one or more same-size adjacent
1398 bit-fields (that is, if its long:3, 32 bits is used in the record,
1399 and any additional adjacent long bit-fields are packed into the same
1400 chunk of 32 bits. However, if the size changes, a new field of that
1401 size is allocated). In an unpacked record, this is the same as using
1402 alignment, but not equivalent when packing.
1403
1404 If both MS bit-fields and @samp{__attribute__((packed))} are used,
1405 the latter will take precedence. If @samp{__attribute__((packed))} is
1406 used on a single field when MS bit-fields are in use, it will take
1407 precedence for that field, but the alignment of the rest of the structure
1408 may affect its placement.
1409 @end deftypefn
1410
1411 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DECIMAL_FLOAT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
1412 Returns true if the target supports decimal floating point.
1413 @end deftypefn
1414
1415 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_POINT_SUPPORTED_P (void)
1416 Returns true if the target supports fixed-point arithmetic.
1417 @end deftypefn
1418
1419 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXPAND_TO_RTL_HOOK (void)
1420 This hook is called just before expansion into rtl, allowing the target
1421 to perform additional initializations or analysis before the expansion.
1422 For example, the rs6000 port uses it to allocate a scratch stack slot
1423 for use in copying SDmode values between memory and floating point
1424 registers whenever the function being expanded has any SDmode
1425 usage.
1426 @end deftypefn
1427
1428 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSTANTIATE_DECLS (void)
1429 This hook allows the backend to perform additional instantiations on rtl
1430 that are not actually in any insns yet, but will be later.
1431 @end deftypefn
1432
1433 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_MANGLE_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
1434 If your target defines any fundamental types, or any types your target
1435 uses should be mangled differently from the default, define this hook
1436 to return the appropriate encoding for these types as part of a C++
1437 mangled name. The @var{type} argument is the tree structure representing
1438 the type to be mangled. The hook may be applied to trees which are
1439 not target-specific fundamental types; it should return @code{NULL}
1440 for all such types, as well as arguments it does not recognize. If the
1441 return value is not @code{NULL}, it must point to a statically-allocated
1442 string constant.
1443
1444 Target-specific fundamental types might be new fundamental types or
1445 qualified versions of ordinary fundamental types. Encode new
1446 fundamental types as @samp{@w{u @var{n} @var{name}}}, where @var{name}
1447 is the name used for the type in source code, and @var{n} is the
1448 length of @var{name} in decimal. Encode qualified versions of
1449 ordinary types as @samp{@w{U @var{n} @var{name} @var{code}}}, where
1450 @var{name} is the name used for the type qualifier in source code,
1451 @var{n} is the length of @var{name} as above, and @var{code} is the
1452 code used to represent the unqualified version of this type. (See
1453 @code{write_builtin_type} in @file{cp/mangle.c} for the list of
1454 codes.) In both cases the spaces are for clarity; do not include any
1455 spaces in your string.
1456
1457 This hook is applied to types prior to typedef resolution. If the mangled
1458 name for a particular type depends only on that type's main variant, you
1459 can perform typedef resolution yourself using @code{TYPE_MAIN_VARIANT}
1460 before mangling.
1461
1462 The default version of this hook always returns @code{NULL}, which is
1463 appropriate for a target that does not define any new fundamental
1464 types.
1465 @end deftypefn
1466
1467 @node Type Layout
1468 @section Layout of Source Language Data Types
1469
1470 These macros define the sizes and other characteristics of the standard
1471 basic data types used in programs being compiled. Unlike the macros in
1472 the previous section, these apply to specific features of C and related
1473 languages, rather than to fundamental aspects of storage layout.
1474
1475 @defmac INT_TYPE_SIZE
1476 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{int} on the
1477 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1478 @end defmac
1479
1480 @defmac SHORT_TYPE_SIZE
1481 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short} on the
1482 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is half a word.
1483 (If this would be less than one storage unit, it is rounded up to one
1484 unit.)
1485 @end defmac
1486
1487 @defmac LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1488 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long} on the
1489 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1490 @end defmac
1491
1492 @defmac ADA_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1493 On some machines, the size used for the Ada equivalent of the type
1494 @code{long} by a native Ada compiler differs from that used by C@. In
1495 that situation, define this macro to be a C expression to be used for
1496 the size of that type. If you don't define this, the default is the
1497 value of @code{LONG_TYPE_SIZE}.
1498 @end defmac
1499
1500 @defmac LONG_LONG_TYPE_SIZE
1501 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long} on the
1502 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1503 words. If you want to support GNU Ada on your machine, the value of this
1504 macro must be at least 64.
1505 @end defmac
1506
1507 @defmac CHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1508 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{char} on the
1509 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1510 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1511 @end defmac
1512
1513 @defmac BOOL_TYPE_SIZE
1514 A C expression for the size in bits of the C++ type @code{bool} and
1515 C99 type @code{_Bool} on the target machine. If you don't define
1516 this, and you probably shouldn't, the default is @code{CHAR_TYPE_SIZE}.
1517 @end defmac
1518
1519 @defmac FLOAT_TYPE_SIZE
1520 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{float} on the
1521 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is one word.
1522 @end defmac
1523
1524 @defmac DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1525 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{double} on the
1526 target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1527 words.
1528 @end defmac
1529
1530 @defmac LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE
1531 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long double} on
1532 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is two
1533 words.
1534 @end defmac
1535
1536 @defmac SHORT_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1537 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Fract} on
1538 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1539 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT}.
1540 @end defmac
1541
1542 @defmac FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1543 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Fract} on
1544 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1545 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1546 @end defmac
1547
1548 @defmac LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1549 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Fract} on
1550 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1551 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1552 @end defmac
1553
1554 @defmac LONG_LONG_FRACT_TYPE_SIZE
1555 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Fract} on
1556 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1557 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1558 @end defmac
1559
1560 @defmac SHORT_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1561 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{short _Accum} on
1562 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1563 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 2}.
1564 @end defmac
1565
1566 @defmac ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1567 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{_Accum} on
1568 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1569 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 4}.
1570 @end defmac
1571
1572 @defmac LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1573 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long _Accum} on
1574 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1575 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 8}.
1576 @end defmac
1577
1578 @defmac LONG_LONG_ACCUM_TYPE_SIZE
1579 A C expression for the size in bits of the type @code{long long _Accum} on
1580 the target machine. If you don't define this, the default is
1581 @code{BITS_PER_UNIT * 16}.
1582 @end defmac
1583
1584 @defmac LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX
1585 This macro corresponds to the @code{TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX} target
1586 hook and should be defined if that hook is overriden to be true. It
1587 causes function names in libgcc to be changed to use a @code{__gnu_}
1588 prefix for their name rather than the default @code{__}. A port which
1589 uses this macro should also arrange to use @file{t-gnu-prefix} in
1590 the libgcc @file{config.host}.
1591 @end defmac
1592
1593 @defmac WIDEST_HARDWARE_FP_SIZE
1594 A C expression for the size in bits of the widest floating-point format
1595 supported by the hardware. If you define this macro, you must specify a
1596 value less than or equal to the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}.
1597 If you do not define this macro, the value of @code{LONG_DOUBLE_TYPE_SIZE}
1598 is the default.
1599 @end defmac
1600
1601 @defmac DEFAULT_SIGNED_CHAR
1602 An expression whose value is 1 or 0, according to whether the type
1603 @code{char} should be signed or unsigned by default. The user can
1604 always override this default with the options @option{-fsigned-char}
1605 and @option{-funsigned-char}.
1606 @end defmac
1607
1608 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DEFAULT_SHORT_ENUMS (void)
1609 This target hook should return true if the compiler should give an
1610 @code{enum} type only as many bytes as it takes to represent the range
1611 of possible values of that type. It should return false if all
1612 @code{enum} types should be allocated like @code{int}.
1613
1614 The default is to return false.
1615 @end deftypefn
1616
1617 @defmac SIZE_TYPE
1618 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1619 for size values. The typedef name @code{size_t} is defined using the
1620 contents of the string.
1621
1622 The string can contain more than one keyword. If so, separate them with
1623 spaces, and write first any length keyword, then @code{unsigned} if
1624 appropriate, and finally @code{int}. The string must exactly match one
1625 of the data type names defined in the function
1626 @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins} in the file @file{c-family/c-common.c}.
1627 You may not omit @code{int} or change the order---that would cause the
1628 compiler to crash on startup.
1629
1630 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long unsigned
1631 int"}.
1632 @end defmac
1633
1634 @defmac SIZETYPE
1635 GCC defines internal types (@code{sizetype}, @code{ssizetype},
1636 @code{bitsizetype} and @code{sbitsizetype}) for expressions
1637 dealing with size. This macro is a C expression for a string describing
1638 the name of the data type from which the precision of @code{sizetype}
1639 is extracted.
1640
1641 The string has the same restrictions as @code{SIZE_TYPE} string.
1642
1643 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{SIZE_TYPE}.
1644 @end defmac
1645
1646 @defmac PTRDIFF_TYPE
1647 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1648 for the result of subtracting two pointers. The typedef name
1649 @code{ptrdiff_t} is defined using the contents of the string. See
1650 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1651
1652 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"long int"}.
1653 @end defmac
1654
1655 @defmac WCHAR_TYPE
1656 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to use
1657 for wide characters. The typedef name @code{wchar_t} is defined using
1658 the contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1659 information.
1660
1661 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"int"}.
1662 @end defmac
1663
1664 @defmac WCHAR_TYPE_SIZE
1665 A C expression for the size in bits of the data type for wide
1666 characters. This is used in @code{cpp}, which cannot make use of
1667 @code{WCHAR_TYPE}.
1668 @end defmac
1669
1670 @defmac WINT_TYPE
1671 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type to
1672 use for wide characters passed to @code{printf} and returned from
1673 @code{getwc}. The typedef name @code{wint_t} is defined using the
1674 contents of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more
1675 information.
1676
1677 If you don't define this macro, the default is @code{"unsigned int"}.
1678 @end defmac
1679
1680 @defmac INTMAX_TYPE
1681 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1682 can represent any value of any standard or extended signed integer type.
1683 The typedef name @code{intmax_t} is defined using the contents of the
1684 string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1685
1686 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1687 @code{"int"}, @code{"long int"}, or @code{"long long int"} that has as
1688 much precision as @code{long long int}.
1689 @end defmac
1690
1691 @defmac UINTMAX_TYPE
1692 A C expression for a string describing the name of the data type that
1693 can represent any value of any standard or extended unsigned integer
1694 type. The typedef name @code{uintmax_t} is defined using the contents
1695 of the string. See @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1696
1697 If you don't define this macro, the default is the first of
1698 @code{"unsigned int"}, @code{"long unsigned int"}, or @code{"long long
1699 unsigned int"} that has as much precision as @code{long long unsigned
1700 int}.
1701 @end defmac
1702
1703 @defmac SIG_ATOMIC_TYPE
1704 @defmacx INT8_TYPE
1705 @defmacx INT16_TYPE
1706 @defmacx INT32_TYPE
1707 @defmacx INT64_TYPE
1708 @defmacx UINT8_TYPE
1709 @defmacx UINT16_TYPE
1710 @defmacx UINT32_TYPE
1711 @defmacx UINT64_TYPE
1712 @defmacx INT_LEAST8_TYPE
1713 @defmacx INT_LEAST16_TYPE
1714 @defmacx INT_LEAST32_TYPE
1715 @defmacx INT_LEAST64_TYPE
1716 @defmacx UINT_LEAST8_TYPE
1717 @defmacx UINT_LEAST16_TYPE
1718 @defmacx UINT_LEAST32_TYPE
1719 @defmacx UINT_LEAST64_TYPE
1720 @defmacx INT_FAST8_TYPE
1721 @defmacx INT_FAST16_TYPE
1722 @defmacx INT_FAST32_TYPE
1723 @defmacx INT_FAST64_TYPE
1724 @defmacx UINT_FAST8_TYPE
1725 @defmacx UINT_FAST16_TYPE
1726 @defmacx UINT_FAST32_TYPE
1727 @defmacx UINT_FAST64_TYPE
1728 @defmacx INTPTR_TYPE
1729 @defmacx UINTPTR_TYPE
1730 C expressions for the standard types @code{sig_atomic_t},
1731 @code{int8_t}, @code{int16_t}, @code{int32_t}, @code{int64_t},
1732 @code{uint8_t}, @code{uint16_t}, @code{uint32_t}, @code{uint64_t},
1733 @code{int_least8_t}, @code{int_least16_t}, @code{int_least32_t},
1734 @code{int_least64_t}, @code{uint_least8_t}, @code{uint_least16_t},
1735 @code{uint_least32_t}, @code{uint_least64_t}, @code{int_fast8_t},
1736 @code{int_fast16_t}, @code{int_fast32_t}, @code{int_fast64_t},
1737 @code{uint_fast8_t}, @code{uint_fast16_t}, @code{uint_fast32_t},
1738 @code{uint_fast64_t}, @code{intptr_t}, and @code{uintptr_t}. See
1739 @code{SIZE_TYPE} above for more information.
1740
1741 If any of these macros evaluates to a null pointer, the corresponding
1742 type is not supported; if GCC is configured to provide
1743 @code{<stdint.h>} in such a case, the header provided may not conform
1744 to C99, depending on the type in question. The defaults for all of
1745 these macros are null pointers.
1746 @end defmac
1747
1748 @defmac TARGET_PTRMEMFUNC_VBIT_LOCATION
1749 The C++ compiler represents a pointer-to-member-function with a struct
1750 that looks like:
1751
1752 @smallexample
1753 struct @{
1754 union @{
1755 void (*fn)();
1756 ptrdiff_t vtable_index;
1757 @};
1758 ptrdiff_t delta;
1759 @};
1760 @end smallexample
1761
1762 @noindent
1763 The C++ compiler must use one bit to indicate whether the function that
1764 will be called through a pointer-to-member-function is virtual.
1765 Normally, we assume that the low-order bit of a function pointer must
1766 always be zero. Then, by ensuring that the vtable_index is odd, we can
1767 distinguish which variant of the union is in use. But, on some
1768 platforms function pointers can be odd, and so this doesn't work. In
1769 that case, we use the low-order bit of the @code{delta} field, and shift
1770 the remainder of the @code{delta} field to the left.
1771
1772 GCC will automatically make the right selection about where to store
1773 this bit using the @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY} setting for your platform.
1774 However, some platforms such as ARM/Thumb have @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}
1775 set such that functions always start at even addresses, but the lowest
1776 bit of pointers to functions indicate whether the function at that
1777 address is in ARM or Thumb mode. If this is the case of your
1778 architecture, you should define this macro to
1779 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_delta}.
1780
1781 In general, you should not have to define this macro. On architectures
1782 in which function addresses are always even, according to
1783 @code{FUNCTION_BOUNDARY}, GCC will automatically define this macro to
1784 @code{ptrmemfunc_vbit_in_pfn}.
1785 @end defmac
1786
1787 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS
1788 Normally, the C++ compiler uses function pointers in vtables. This
1789 macro allows the target to change to use ``function descriptors''
1790 instead. Function descriptors are found on targets for whom a
1791 function pointer is actually a small data structure. Normally the
1792 data structure consists of the actual code address plus a data
1793 pointer to which the function's data is relative.
1794
1795 If vtables are used, the value of this macro should be the number
1796 of words that the function descriptor occupies.
1797 @end defmac
1798
1799 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN
1800 By default, the vtable entries are void pointers, the so the alignment
1801 is the same as pointer alignment. The value of this macro specifies
1802 the alignment of the vtable entry in bits. It should be defined only
1803 when special alignment is necessary. */
1804 @end defmac
1805
1806 @defmac TARGET_VTABLE_DATA_ENTRY_DISTANCE
1807 There are a few non-descriptor entries in the vtable at offsets below
1808 zero. If these entries must be padded (say, to preserve the alignment
1809 specified by @code{TARGET_VTABLE_ENTRY_ALIGN}), set this to the number
1810 of words in each data entry.
1811 @end defmac
1812
1813 @node Registers
1814 @section Register Usage
1815 @cindex register usage
1816
1817 This section explains how to describe what registers the target machine
1818 has, and how (in general) they can be used.
1819
1820 The description of which registers a specific instruction can use is
1821 done with register classes; see @ref{Register Classes}. For information
1822 on using registers to access a stack frame, see @ref{Frame Registers}.
1823 For passing values in registers, see @ref{Register Arguments}.
1824 For returning values in registers, see @ref{Scalar Return}.
1825
1826 @menu
1827 * Register Basics:: Number and kinds of registers.
1828 * Allocation Order:: Order in which registers are allocated.
1829 * Values in Registers:: What kinds of values each reg can hold.
1830 * Leaf Functions:: Renumbering registers for leaf functions.
1831 * Stack Registers:: Handling a register stack such as 80387.
1832 @end menu
1833
1834 @node Register Basics
1835 @subsection Basic Characteristics of Registers
1836
1837 @c prevent bad page break with this line
1838 Registers have various characteristics.
1839
1840 @defmac FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER
1841 Number of hardware registers known to the compiler. They receive
1842 numbers 0 through @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER-1}; thus, the first
1843 pseudo register's number really is assigned the number
1844 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
1845 @end defmac
1846
1847 @defmac FIXED_REGISTERS
1848 @cindex fixed register
1849 An initializer that says which registers are used for fixed purposes
1850 all throughout the compiled code and are therefore not available for
1851 general allocation. These would include the stack pointer, the frame
1852 pointer (except on machines where that can be used as a general
1853 register when no frame pointer is needed), the program counter on
1854 machines where that is considered one of the addressable registers,
1855 and any other numbered register with a standard use.
1856
1857 This information is expressed as a sequence of numbers, separated by
1858 commas and surrounded by braces. The @var{n}th number is 1 if
1859 register @var{n} is fixed, 0 otherwise.
1860
1861 The table initialized from this macro, and the table initialized by
1862 the following one, may be overridden at run time either automatically,
1863 by the actions of the macro @code{CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}, or by
1864 the user with the command options @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1865 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}.
1866 @end defmac
1867
1868 @defmac CALL_USED_REGISTERS
1869 @cindex call-used register
1870 @cindex call-clobbered register
1871 @cindex call-saved register
1872 Like @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} but has 1 for each register that is
1873 clobbered (in general) by function calls as well as for fixed
1874 registers. This macro therefore identifies the registers that are not
1875 available for general allocation of values that must live across
1876 function calls.
1877
1878 If a register has 0 in @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}, the compiler
1879 automatically saves it on function entry and restores it on function
1880 exit, if the register is used within the function.
1881 @end defmac
1882
1883 @defmac CALL_REALLY_USED_REGISTERS
1884 @cindex call-used register
1885 @cindex call-clobbered register
1886 @cindex call-saved register
1887 Like @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} except this macro doesn't require
1888 that the entire set of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} be included.
1889 (@code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} must be a superset of @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}).
1890 This macro is optional. If not specified, it defaults to the value
1891 of @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS}.
1892 @end defmac
1893
1894 @cindex call-used register
1895 @cindex call-clobbered register
1896 @cindex call-saved register
1897 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HARD_REGNO_CALL_PART_CLOBBERED (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, unsigned int @var{regno}, machine_mode @var{mode})
1898 This hook should return true if @var{regno} is partly call-saved and
1899 partly call-clobbered, and if a value of mode @var{mode} would be partly
1900 clobbered by call instruction @var{insn}. If @var{insn} is NULL then it
1901 should return true if any call could partly clobber the register.
1902 For example, if the low 32 bits of @var{regno} are preserved across a call
1903 but higher bits are clobbered, this hook should return true for a 64-bit
1904 mode but false for a 32-bit mode.
1905
1906 The default implementation returns false, which is correct
1907 for targets that don't have partly call-clobbered registers.
1908 @end deftypefn
1909
1910 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_REMOVE_EXTRA_CALL_PRESERVED_REGS (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, HARD_REG_SET *@var{used_regs})
1911 This hook removes registers from the set of call-clobbered registers
1912 in @var{used_regs} if, contrary to the default rules, something guarantees
1913 that @samp{insn} preserves those registers. For example, some targets
1914 support variant ABIs in which functions preserve more registers than
1915 normal functions would. Removing those extra registers from @var{used_regs}
1916 can lead to better register allocation.
1917
1918 The default implementation does nothing, which is always safe.
1919 Defining the hook is purely an optimization.
1920 @end deftypefn
1921
1922 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {rtx_insn *} TARGET_RETURN_CALL_WITH_MAX_CLOBBERS (rtx_insn *@var{call_1}, rtx_insn *@var{call_2})
1923 This hook returns a pointer to the call that partially clobbers the
1924 most registers. If a platform supports multiple ABIs where the registers
1925 that are partially clobbered may vary, this function compares two
1926 calls and returns a pointer to the one that clobbers the most registers.
1927 If both calls clobber the same registers, @var{call_1} must be returned.
1928
1929 The registers clobbered in different ABIs must be a proper subset or
1930 superset of all other ABIs. @var{call_1} must always be a call insn,
1931 call_2 may be NULL or a call insn.
1932 @end deftypefn
1933
1934 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_GET_MULTILIB_ABI_NAME (void)
1935 This hook returns name of multilib ABI name.
1936 @end deftypefn
1937
1938 @findex fixed_regs
1939 @findex call_used_regs
1940 @findex global_regs
1941 @findex reg_names
1942 @findex reg_class_contents
1943 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE (void)
1944 This hook may conditionally modify five variables
1945 @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs}, @code{global_regs},
1946 @code{reg_names}, and @code{reg_class_contents}, to take into account
1947 any dependence of these register sets on target flags. The first three
1948 of these are of type @code{char []} (interpreted as boolean vectors).
1949 @code{global_regs} is a @code{const char *[]}, and
1950 @code{reg_class_contents} is a @code{HARD_REG_SET}. Before the macro is
1951 called, @code{fixed_regs}, @code{call_used_regs},
1952 @code{reg_class_contents}, and @code{reg_names} have been initialized
1953 from @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS},
1954 @code{REG_CLASS_CONTENTS}, and @code{REGISTER_NAMES}, respectively.
1955 @code{global_regs} has been cleared, and any @option{-ffixed-@var{reg}},
1956 @option{-fcall-used-@var{reg}} and @option{-fcall-saved-@var{reg}}
1957 command options have been applied.
1958
1959 @cindex disabling certain registers
1960 @cindex controlling register usage
1961 If the usage of an entire class of registers depends on the target
1962 flags, you may indicate this to GCC by using this macro to modify
1963 @code{fixed_regs} and @code{call_used_regs} to 1 for each of the
1964 registers in the classes which should not be used by GCC@. Also make
1965 @code{define_register_constraint}s return @code{NO_REGS} for constraints
1966 that shouldn't be used.
1967
1968 (However, if this class is not included in @code{GENERAL_REGS} and all
1969 of the insn patterns whose constraints permit this class are
1970 controlled by target switches, then GCC will automatically avoid using
1971 these registers when the target switches are opposed to them.)
1972 @end deftypefn
1973
1974 @defmac INCOMING_REGNO (@var{out})
1975 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1976 expression returns the register number as seen by the called function
1977 corresponding to the register number @var{out} as seen by the calling
1978 function. Return @var{out} if register number @var{out} is not an
1979 outbound register.
1980 @end defmac
1981
1982 @defmac OUTGOING_REGNO (@var{in})
1983 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1984 expression returns the register number as seen by the calling function
1985 corresponding to the register number @var{in} as seen by the called
1986 function. Return @var{in} if register number @var{in} is not an inbound
1987 register.
1988 @end defmac
1989
1990 @defmac LOCAL_REGNO (@var{regno})
1991 Define this macro if the target machine has register windows. This C
1992 expression returns true if the register is call-saved but is in the
1993 register window. Unlike most call-saved registers, such registers
1994 need not be explicitly restored on function exit or during non-local
1995 gotos.
1996 @end defmac
1997
1998 @defmac PC_REGNUM
1999 If the program counter has a register number, define this as that
2000 register number. Otherwise, do not define it.
2001 @end defmac
2002
2003 @node Allocation Order
2004 @subsection Order of Allocation of Registers
2005 @cindex order of register allocation
2006 @cindex register allocation order
2007
2008 @c prevent bad page break with this line
2009 Registers are allocated in order.
2010
2011 @defmac REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2012 If defined, an initializer for a vector of integers, containing the
2013 numbers of hard registers in the order in which GCC should prefer
2014 to use them (from most preferred to least).
2015
2016 If this macro is not defined, registers are used lowest numbered first
2017 (all else being equal).
2018
2019 One use of this macro is on machines where the highest numbered
2020 registers must always be saved and the save-multiple-registers
2021 instruction supports only sequences of consecutive registers. On such
2022 machines, define @code{REG_ALLOC_ORDER} to be an initializer that lists
2023 the highest numbered allocable register first.
2024 @end defmac
2025
2026 @defmac ADJUST_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2027 A C statement (sans semicolon) to choose the order in which to allocate
2028 hard registers for pseudo-registers local to a basic block.
2029
2030 Store the desired register order in the array @code{reg_alloc_order}.
2031 Element 0 should be the register to allocate first; element 1, the next
2032 register; and so on.
2033
2034 The macro body should not assume anything about the contents of
2035 @code{reg_alloc_order} before execution of the macro.
2036
2037 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2038 @end defmac
2039
2040 @defmac HONOR_REG_ALLOC_ORDER
2041 Normally, IRA tries to estimate the costs for saving a register in the
2042 prologue and restoring it in the epilogue. This discourages it from
2043 using call-saved registers. If a machine wants to ensure that IRA
2044 allocates registers in the order given by REG_ALLOC_ORDER even if some
2045 call-saved registers appear earlier than call-used ones, then define this
2046 macro as a C expression to nonzero. Default is 0.
2047 @end defmac
2048
2049 @defmac IRA_HARD_REGNO_ADD_COST_MULTIPLIER (@var{regno})
2050 In some case register allocation order is not enough for the
2051 Integrated Register Allocator (@acronym{IRA}) to generate a good code.
2052 If this macro is defined, it should return a floating point value
2053 based on @var{regno}. The cost of using @var{regno} for a pseudo will
2054 be increased by approximately the pseudo's usage frequency times the
2055 value returned by this macro. Not defining this macro is equivalent
2056 to having it always return @code{0.0}.
2057
2058 On most machines, it is not necessary to define this macro.
2059 @end defmac
2060
2061 @node Values in Registers
2062 @subsection How Values Fit in Registers
2063
2064 This section discusses the macros that describe which kinds of values
2065 (specifically, which machine modes) each register can hold, and how many
2066 consecutive registers are needed for a given mode.
2067
2068 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_HARD_REGNO_NREGS (unsigned int @var{regno}, machine_mode @var{mode})
2069 This hook returns the number of consecutive hard registers, starting
2070 at register number @var{regno}, required to hold a value of mode
2071 @var{mode}. This hook must never return zero, even if a register
2072 cannot hold the requested mode - indicate that with
2073 @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} and/or
2074 @code{TARGET_CAN_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} instead.
2075
2076 The default definition returns the number of words in @var{mode}.
2077 @end deftypefn
2078
2079 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2080 A C expression that is nonzero if a value of mode @var{mode}, stored
2081 in memory, ends with padding that causes it to take up more space than
2082 in registers starting at register number @var{regno} (as determined by
2083 multiplying GCC's notion of the size of the register when containing
2084 this mode by the number of registers returned by
2085 @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_NREGS}). By default this is zero.
2086
2087 For example, if a floating-point value is stored in three 32-bit
2088 registers but takes up 128 bits in memory, then this would be
2089 nonzero.
2090
2091 This macros only needs to be defined if there are cases where
2092 @code{subreg_get_info}
2093 would otherwise wrongly determine that a @code{subreg} can be
2094 represented by an offset to the register number, when in fact such a
2095 @code{subreg} would contain some of the padding not stored in
2096 registers and so not be representable.
2097 @end defmac
2098
2099 @defmac HARD_REGNO_NREGS_WITH_PADDING (@var{regno}, @var{mode})
2100 For values of @var{regno} and @var{mode} for which
2101 @code{HARD_REGNO_NREGS_HAS_PADDING} returns nonzero, a C expression
2102 returning the greater number of registers required to hold the value
2103 including any padding. In the example above, the value would be four.
2104 @end defmac
2105
2106 @defmac REGMODE_NATURAL_SIZE (@var{mode})
2107 Define this macro if the natural size of registers that hold values
2108 of mode @var{mode} is not the word size. It is a C expression that
2109 should give the natural size in bytes for the specified mode. It is
2110 used by the register allocator to try to optimize its results. This
2111 happens for example on SPARC 64-bit where the natural size of
2112 floating-point registers is still 32-bit.
2113 @end defmac
2114
2115 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (unsigned int @var{regno}, machine_mode @var{mode})
2116 This hook returns true if it is permissible to store a value
2117 of mode @var{mode} in hard register number @var{regno} (or in several
2118 registers starting with that one). The default definition returns true
2119 unconditionally.
2120
2121 You need not include code to check for the numbers of fixed registers,
2122 because the allocation mechanism considers them to be always occupied.
2123
2124 @cindex register pairs
2125 On some machines, double-precision values must be kept in even/odd
2126 register pairs. You can implement that by defining this hook to reject
2127 odd register numbers for such modes.
2128
2129 The minimum requirement for a mode to be OK in a register is that the
2130 @samp{mov@var{mode}} instruction pattern support moves between the
2131 register and other hard register in the same class and that moving a
2132 value into the register and back out not alter it.
2133
2134 Since the same instruction used to move @code{word_mode} will work for
2135 all narrower integer modes, it is not necessary on any machine for
2136 this hook to distinguish between these modes, provided you define
2137 patterns @samp{movhi}, etc., to take advantage of this. This is
2138 useful because of the interaction between @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}
2139 and @code{TARGET_MODES_TIEABLE_P}; it is very desirable for all integer
2140 modes to be tieable.
2141
2142 Many machines have special registers for floating point arithmetic.
2143 Often people assume that floating point machine modes are allowed only
2144 in floating point registers. This is not true. Any registers that
2145 can hold integers can safely @emph{hold} a floating point machine
2146 mode, whether or not floating arithmetic can be done on it in those
2147 registers. Integer move instructions can be used to move the values.
2148
2149 On some machines, though, the converse is true: fixed-point machine
2150 modes may not go in floating registers. This is true if the floating
2151 registers normalize any value stored in them, because storing a
2152 non-floating value there would garble it. In this case,
2153 @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK} should reject fixed-point machine modes in
2154 floating registers. But if the floating registers do not automatically
2155 normalize, if you can store any bit pattern in one and retrieve it
2156 unchanged without a trap, then any machine mode may go in a floating
2157 register, so you can define this hook to say so.
2158
2159 The primary significance of special floating registers is rather that
2160 they are the registers acceptable in floating point arithmetic
2161 instructions. However, this is of no concern to
2162 @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}. You handle it by writing the proper
2163 constraints for those instructions.
2164
2165 On some machines, the floating registers are especially slow to access,
2166 so that it is better to store a value in a stack frame than in such a
2167 register if floating point arithmetic is not being done. As long as the
2168 floating registers are not in class @code{GENERAL_REGS}, they will not
2169 be used unless some pattern's constraint asks for one.
2170 @end deftypefn
2171
2172 @defmac HARD_REGNO_RENAME_OK (@var{from}, @var{to})
2173 A C expression that is nonzero if it is OK to rename a hard register
2174 @var{from} to another hard register @var{to}.
2175
2176 One common use of this macro is to prevent renaming of a register to
2177 another register that is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt
2178 handler.
2179
2180 The default is always nonzero.
2181 @end defmac
2182
2183 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MODES_TIEABLE_P (machine_mode @var{mode1}, machine_mode @var{mode2})
2184 This hook returns true if a value of mode @var{mode1} is accessible
2185 in mode @var{mode2} without copying.
2186
2187 If @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode1})} and
2188 @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK (@var{r}, @var{mode2})} are always
2189 the same for any @var{r}, then
2190 @code{TARGET_MODES_TIEABLE_P (@var{mode1}, @var{mode2})}
2191 should be true. If they differ for any @var{r}, you should define
2192 this hook to return false unless some other mechanism ensures the
2193 accessibility of the value in a narrower mode.
2194
2195 You should define this hook to return true in as many cases as
2196 possible since doing so will allow GCC to perform better register
2197 allocation. The default definition returns true unconditionally.
2198 @end deftypefn
2199
2200 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HARD_REGNO_SCRATCH_OK (unsigned int @var{regno})
2201 This target hook should return @code{true} if it is OK to use a hard register
2202 @var{regno} as scratch reg in peephole2.
2203
2204 One common use of this macro is to prevent using of a register that
2205 is not saved by a prologue in an interrupt handler.
2206
2207 The default version of this hook always returns @code{true}.
2208 @end deftypefn
2209
2210 @defmac AVOID_CCMODE_COPIES
2211 Define this macro if the compiler should avoid copies to/from @code{CCmode}
2212 registers. You should only define this macro if support for copying to/from
2213 @code{CCmode} is incomplete.
2214 @end defmac
2215
2216 @node Leaf Functions
2217 @subsection Handling Leaf Functions
2218
2219 @cindex leaf functions
2220 @cindex functions, leaf
2221 On some machines, a leaf function (i.e., one which makes no calls) can run
2222 more efficiently if it does not make its own register window. Often this
2223 means it is required to receive its arguments in the registers where they
2224 are passed by the caller, instead of the registers where they would
2225 normally arrive.
2226
2227 The special treatment for leaf functions generally applies only when
2228 other conditions are met; for example, often they may use only those
2229 registers for its own variables and temporaries. We use the term ``leaf
2230 function'' to mean a function that is suitable for this special
2231 handling, so that functions with no calls are not necessarily ``leaf
2232 functions''.
2233
2234 GCC assigns register numbers before it knows whether the function is
2235 suitable for leaf function treatment. So it needs to renumber the
2236 registers in order to output a leaf function. The following macros
2237 accomplish this.
2238
2239 @defmac LEAF_REGISTERS
2240 Name of a char vector, indexed by hard register number, which
2241 contains 1 for a register that is allowable in a candidate for leaf
2242 function treatment.
2243
2244 If leaf function treatment involves renumbering the registers, then the
2245 registers marked here should be the ones before renumbering---those that
2246 GCC would ordinarily allocate. The registers which will actually be
2247 used in the assembler code, after renumbering, should not be marked with 1
2248 in this vector.
2249
2250 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize
2251 the treatment of leaf functions.
2252 @end defmac
2253
2254 @defmac LEAF_REG_REMAP (@var{regno})
2255 A C expression whose value is the register number to which @var{regno}
2256 should be renumbered, when a function is treated as a leaf function.
2257
2258 If @var{regno} is a register number which should not appear in a leaf
2259 function before renumbering, then the expression should yield @minus{}1, which
2260 will cause the compiler to abort.
2261
2262 Define this macro only if the target machine offers a way to optimize the
2263 treatment of leaf functions, and registers need to be renumbered to do
2264 this.
2265 @end defmac
2266
2267 @findex current_function_is_leaf
2268 @findex current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs
2269 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
2270 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must usually treat leaf functions
2271 specially. They can test the C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf}
2272 which is nonzero for leaf functions. @code{current_function_is_leaf} is
2273 set prior to local register allocation and is valid for the remaining
2274 compiler passes. They can also test the C variable
2275 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} which is nonzero for leaf
2276 functions which only use leaf registers.
2277 @code{current_function_uses_only_leaf_regs} is valid after all passes
2278 that modify the instructions have been run and is only useful if
2279 @code{LEAF_REGISTERS} is defined.
2280 @c changed this to fix overfull. ALSO: why the "it" at the beginning
2281 @c of the next paragraph?! --mew 2feb93
2282
2283 @node Stack Registers
2284 @subsection Registers That Form a Stack
2285
2286 There are special features to handle computers where some of the
2287 ``registers'' form a stack. Stack registers are normally written by
2288 pushing onto the stack, and are numbered relative to the top of the
2289 stack.
2290
2291 Currently, GCC can only handle one group of stack-like registers, and
2292 they must be consecutively numbered. Furthermore, the existing
2293 support for stack-like registers is specific to the 80387 floating
2294 point coprocessor. If you have a new architecture that uses
2295 stack-like registers, you will need to do substantial work on
2296 @file{reg-stack.c} and write your machine description to cooperate
2297 with it, as well as defining these macros.
2298
2299 @defmac STACK_REGS
2300 Define this if the machine has any stack-like registers.
2301 @end defmac
2302
2303 @defmac STACK_REG_COVER_CLASS
2304 This is a cover class containing the stack registers. Define this if
2305 the machine has any stack-like registers.
2306 @end defmac
2307
2308 @defmac FIRST_STACK_REG
2309 The number of the first stack-like register. This one is the top
2310 of the stack.
2311 @end defmac
2312
2313 @defmac LAST_STACK_REG
2314 The number of the last stack-like register. This one is the bottom of
2315 the stack.
2316 @end defmac
2317
2318 @node Register Classes
2319 @section Register Classes
2320 @cindex register class definitions
2321 @cindex class definitions, register
2322
2323 On many machines, the numbered registers are not all equivalent.
2324 For example, certain registers may not be allowed for indexed addressing;
2325 certain registers may not be allowed in some instructions. These machine
2326 restrictions are described to the compiler using @dfn{register classes}.
2327
2328 You define a number of register classes, giving each one a name and saying
2329 which of the registers belong to it. Then you can specify register classes
2330 that are allowed as operands to particular instruction patterns.
2331
2332 @findex ALL_REGS
2333 @findex NO_REGS
2334 In general, each register will belong to several classes. In fact, one
2335 class must be named @code{ALL_REGS} and contain all the registers. Another
2336 class must be named @code{NO_REGS} and contain no registers. Often the
2337 union of two classes will be another class; however, this is not required.
2338
2339 @findex GENERAL_REGS
2340 One of the classes must be named @code{GENERAL_REGS}. There is nothing
2341 terribly special about the name, but the operand constraint letters
2342 @samp{r} and @samp{g} specify this class. If @code{GENERAL_REGS} is
2343 the same as @code{ALL_REGS}, just define it as a macro which expands
2344 to @code{ALL_REGS}.
2345
2346 Order the classes so that if class @var{x} is contained in class @var{y}
2347 then @var{x} has a lower class number than @var{y}.
2348
2349 The way classes other than @code{GENERAL_REGS} are specified in operand
2350 constraints is through machine-dependent operand constraint letters.
2351 You can define such letters to correspond to various classes, then use
2352 them in operand constraints.
2353
2354 You must define the narrowest register classes for allocatable
2355 registers, so that each class either has no subclasses, or that for
2356 some mode, the move cost between registers within the class is
2357 cheaper than moving a register in the class to or from memory
2358 (@pxref{Costs}).
2359
2360 You should define a class for the union of two classes whenever some
2361 instruction allows both classes. For example, if an instruction allows
2362 either a floating point (coprocessor) register or a general register for a
2363 certain operand, you should define a class @code{FLOAT_OR_GENERAL_REGS}
2364 which includes both of them. Otherwise you will get suboptimal code,
2365 or even internal compiler errors when reload cannot find a register in the
2366 class computed via @code{reg_class_subunion}.
2367
2368 You must also specify certain redundant information about the register
2369 classes: for each class, which classes contain it and which ones are
2370 contained in it; for each pair of classes, the largest class contained
2371 in their union.
2372
2373 When a value occupying several consecutive registers is expected in a
2374 certain class, all the registers used must belong to that class.
2375 Therefore, register classes cannot be used to enforce a requirement for
2376 a register pair to start with an even-numbered register. The way to
2377 specify this requirement is with @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_MODE_OK}.
2378
2379 Register classes used for input-operands of bitwise-and or shift
2380 instructions have a special requirement: each such class must have, for
2381 each fixed-point machine mode, a subclass whose registers can transfer that
2382 mode to or from memory. For example, on some machines, the operations for
2383 single-byte values (@code{QImode}) are limited to certain registers. When
2384 this is so, each register class that is used in a bitwise-and or shift
2385 instruction must have a subclass consisting of registers from which
2386 single-byte values can be loaded or stored. This is so that
2387 @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} can always have a possible value to return.
2388
2389 @deftp {Data type} {enum reg_class}
2390 An enumerated type that must be defined with all the register class names
2391 as enumerated values. @code{NO_REGS} must be first. @code{ALL_REGS}
2392 must be the last register class, followed by one more enumerated value,
2393 @code{LIM_REG_CLASSES}, which is not a register class but rather
2394 tells how many classes there are.
2395
2396 Each register class has a number, which is the value of casting
2397 the class name to type @code{int}. The number serves as an index
2398 in many of the tables described below.
2399 @end deftp
2400
2401 @defmac N_REG_CLASSES
2402 The number of distinct register classes, defined as follows:
2403
2404 @smallexample
2405 #define N_REG_CLASSES (int) LIM_REG_CLASSES
2406 @end smallexample
2407 @end defmac
2408
2409 @defmac REG_CLASS_NAMES
2410 An initializer containing the names of the register classes as C string
2411 constants. These names are used in writing some of the debugging dumps.
2412 @end defmac
2413
2414 @defmac REG_CLASS_CONTENTS
2415 An initializer containing the contents of the register classes, as integers
2416 which are bit masks. The @var{n}th integer specifies the contents of class
2417 @var{n}. The way the integer @var{mask} is interpreted is that
2418 register @var{r} is in the class if @code{@var{mask} & (1 << @var{r})} is 1.
2419
2420 When the machine has more than 32 registers, an integer does not suffice.
2421 Then the integers are replaced by sub-initializers, braced groupings containing
2422 several integers. Each sub-initializer must be suitable as an initializer
2423 for the type @code{HARD_REG_SET} which is defined in @file{hard-reg-set.h}.
2424 In this situation, the first integer in each sub-initializer corresponds to
2425 registers 0 through 31, the second integer to registers 32 through 63, and
2426 so on.
2427 @end defmac
2428
2429 @defmac REGNO_REG_CLASS (@var{regno})
2430 A C expression whose value is a register class containing hard register
2431 @var{regno}. In general there is more than one such class; choose a class
2432 which is @dfn{minimal}, meaning that no smaller class also contains the
2433 register.
2434 @end defmac
2435
2436 @defmac BASE_REG_CLASS
2437 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2438 base register must belong. A base register is one used in an address
2439 which is the register value plus a displacement.
2440 @end defmac
2441
2442 @defmac MODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2443 This is a variation of the @code{BASE_REG_CLASS} macro which allows
2444 the selection of a base register in a mode dependent manner. If
2445 @var{mode} is VOIDmode then it should return the same value as
2446 @code{BASE_REG_CLASS}.
2447 @end defmac
2448
2449 @defmac MODE_BASE_REG_REG_CLASS (@var{mode})
2450 A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2451 base register must belong in order to be used in a base plus index
2452 register address. You should define this macro if base plus index
2453 addresses have different requirements than other base register uses.
2454 @end defmac
2455
2456 @defmac MODE_CODE_BASE_REG_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2457 A C expression whose value is the register class to which a valid
2458 base register for a memory reference in mode @var{mode} to address
2459 space @var{address_space} must belong. @var{outer_code} and @var{index_code}
2460 define the context in which the base register occurs. @var{outer_code} is
2461 the code of the immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} for the top level
2462 of an address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2463 @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the corresponding
2464 index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS}; @code{SCRATCH} otherwise.
2465 @end defmac
2466
2467 @defmac INDEX_REG_CLASS
2468 A macro whose definition is the name of the class to which a valid
2469 index register must belong. An index register is one used in an
2470 address where its value is either multiplied by a scale factor or
2471 added to another register (as well as added to a displacement).
2472 @end defmac
2473
2474 @defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num})
2475 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2476 suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses.
2477 @end defmac
2478
2479 @defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2480 A C expression that is just like @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except that
2481 that expression may examine the mode of the memory reference in
2482 @var{mode}. You should define this macro if the mode of the memory
2483 reference affects whether a register may be used as a base register. If
2484 you define this macro, the compiler will use it instead of
2485 @code{REGNO_OK_FOR_BASE_P}. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for
2486 addresses that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an
2487 @code{address_operand}.
2488 @end defmac
2489
2490 @defmac REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_REG_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode})
2491 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is suitable for
2492 use as a base register in base plus index operand addresses, accessing
2493 memory in mode @var{mode}. It may be either a suitable hard register or a
2494 pseudo register that has been allocated such a hard register. You should
2495 define this macro if base plus index addresses have different requirements
2496 than other base register uses.
2497
2498 Use of this macro is deprecated; please use the more general
2499 @code{REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}.
2500 @end defmac
2501
2502 @defmac REGNO_MODE_CODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P (@var{num}, @var{mode}, @var{address_space}, @var{outer_code}, @var{index_code})
2503 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2504 suitable for use as a base register in operand addresses, accessing
2505 memory in mode @var{mode} in address space @var{address_space}.
2506 This is similar to @code{REGNO_MODE_OK_FOR_BASE_P}, except
2507 that that expression may examine the context in which the register
2508 appears in the memory reference. @var{outer_code} is the code of the
2509 immediately enclosing expression (@code{MEM} if at the top level of the
2510 address, @code{ADDRESS} for something that occurs in an
2511 @code{address_operand}). @var{index_code} is the code of the
2512 corresponding index expression if @var{outer_code} is @code{PLUS};
2513 @code{SCRATCH} otherwise. The mode may be @code{VOIDmode} for addresses
2514 that appear outside a @code{MEM}, i.e., as an @code{address_operand}.
2515 @end defmac
2516
2517 @defmac REGNO_OK_FOR_INDEX_P (@var{num})
2518 A C expression which is nonzero if register number @var{num} is
2519 suitable for use as an index register in operand addresses. It may be
2520 either a suitable hard register or a pseudo register that has been
2521 allocated such a hard register.
2522
2523 The difference between an index register and a base register is that
2524 the index register may be scaled. If an address involves the sum of
2525 two registers, neither one of them scaled, then either one may be
2526 labeled the ``base'' and the other the ``index''; but whichever
2527 labeling is used must fit the machine's constraints of which registers
2528 may serve in each capacity. The compiler will try both labelings,
2529 looking for one that is valid, and will reload one or both registers
2530 only if neither labeling works.
2531 @end defmac
2532
2533 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RENAME_CLASS (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2534 A target hook that places additional preference on the register class to use when it is necessary to rename a register in class @var{rclass} to another class, or perhaps @var{NO_REGS}, if no preferred register class is found or hook @code{preferred_rename_class} is not implemented. Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For example, on ARM, thumb-2 instructions using @code{LO_REGS} may be smaller than instructions using @code{GENERIC_REGS}. By returning @code{LO_REGS} from @code{preferred_rename_class}, code size can be reduced.
2535 @end deftypefn
2536
2537 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2538 A target hook that places additional restrictions on the register class
2539 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2540 @var{rclass}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{rclass}, or perhaps
2541 another, smaller class.
2542
2543 The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass} argument.
2544
2545 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2546 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2547 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2548 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{rclass} includes the data registers.
2549 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2550
2551 One case where @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2552 @var{rclass} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2553 loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2554 force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2555 immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2556 instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2557 register, so @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2558 @var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant can't be loaded
2559 into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2560 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2561 of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2562
2563 If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2564 through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2565 to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2566 reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2567 this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2568 the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2569 @end deftypefn
2570
2571 @defmac PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{x}, @var{class})
2572 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2573 to use when it is necessary to copy value @var{x} into a register in class
2574 @var{class}. The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps
2575 another, smaller class. On many machines, the following definition is
2576 safe:
2577
2578 @smallexample
2579 #define PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS(X,CLASS) CLASS
2580 @end smallexample
2581
2582 Sometimes returning a more restrictive class makes better code. For
2583 example, on the 68000, when @var{x} is an integer constant that is in range
2584 for a @samp{moveq} instruction, the value of this macro is always
2585 @code{DATA_REGS} as long as @var{class} includes the data registers.
2586 Requiring a data register guarantees that a @samp{moveq} will be used.
2587
2588 One case where @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} must not return
2589 @var{class} is if @var{x} is a legitimate constant which cannot be
2590 loaded into some register class. By returning @code{NO_REGS} you can
2591 force @var{x} into a memory location. For example, rs6000 can load
2592 immediate values into general-purpose registers, but does not have an
2593 instruction for loading an immediate value into a floating-point
2594 register, so @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS} returns @code{NO_REGS} when
2595 @var{x} is a floating-point constant. If the constant cannot be loaded
2596 into any kind of register, code generation will be better if
2597 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P} makes the constant illegitimate instead
2598 of using @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2599
2600 If an insn has pseudos in it after register allocation, reload will go
2601 through the alternatives and call repeatedly @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}
2602 to find the best one. Returning @code{NO_REGS}, in this case, makes
2603 reload add a @code{!} in front of the constraint: the x86 back-end uses
2604 this feature to discourage usage of 387 registers when math is done in
2605 the SSE registers (and vice versa).
2606 @end defmac
2607
2608 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2609 Like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, but for output reloads instead of
2610 input reloads.
2611
2612 The default version of this hook always returns value of @code{rclass}
2613 argument.
2614
2615 You can also use @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to discourage
2616 reload from using some alternatives, like @code{TARGET_PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}.
2617 @end deftypefn
2618
2619 @defmac LIMIT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{mode}, @var{class})
2620 A C expression that places additional restrictions on the register class
2621 to use when it is necessary to be able to hold a value of mode
2622 @var{mode} in a reload register for which class @var{class} would
2623 ordinarily be used.
2624
2625 Unlike @code{PREFERRED_RELOAD_CLASS}, this macro should be used when
2626 there are certain modes that simply cannot go in certain reload classes.
2627
2628 The value is a register class; perhaps @var{class}, or perhaps another,
2629 smaller class.
2630
2631 Don't define this macro unless the target machine has limitations which
2632 require the macro to do something nontrivial.
2633 @end defmac
2634
2635 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD (bool @var{in_p}, rtx @var{x}, reg_class_t @var{reload_class}, machine_mode @var{reload_mode}, secondary_reload_info *@var{sri})
2636 Many machines have some registers that cannot be copied directly to or
2637 from memory or even from other types of registers. An example is the
2638 @samp{MQ} register, which on most machines, can only be copied to or
2639 from general registers, but not memory. Below, we shall be using the
2640 term 'intermediate register' when a move operation cannot be performed
2641 directly, but has to be done by copying the source into the intermediate
2642 register first, and then copying the intermediate register to the
2643 destination. An intermediate register always has the same mode as
2644 source and destination. Since it holds the actual value being copied,
2645 reload might apply optimizations to re-use an intermediate register
2646 and eliding the copy from the source when it can determine that the
2647 intermediate register still holds the required value.
2648
2649 Another kind of secondary reload is required on some machines which
2650 allow copying all registers to and from memory, but require a scratch
2651 register for stores to some memory locations (e.g., those with symbolic
2652 address on the RT, and those with certain symbolic address on the SPARC
2653 when compiling PIC)@. Scratch registers need not have the same mode
2654 as the value being copied, and usually hold a different value than
2655 that being copied. Special patterns in the md file are needed to
2656 describe how the copy is performed with the help of the scratch register;
2657 these patterns also describe the number, register class(es) and mode(s)
2658 of the scratch register(s).
2659
2660 In some cases, both an intermediate and a scratch register are required.
2661
2662 For input reloads, this target hook is called with nonzero @var{in_p},
2663 and @var{x} is an rtx that needs to be copied to a register of class
2664 @var{reload_class} in @var{reload_mode}. For output reloads, this target
2665 hook is called with zero @var{in_p}, and a register of class @var{reload_class}
2666 needs to be copied to rtx @var{x} in @var{reload_mode}.
2667
2668 If copying a register of @var{reload_class} from/to @var{x} requires
2669 an intermediate register, the hook @code{secondary_reload} should
2670 return the register class required for this intermediate register.
2671 If no intermediate register is required, it should return NO_REGS.
2672 If more than one intermediate register is required, describe the one
2673 that is closest in the copy chain to the reload register.
2674
2675 If scratch registers are needed, you also have to describe how to
2676 perform the copy from/to the reload register to/from this
2677 closest intermediate register. Or if no intermediate register is
2678 required, but still a scratch register is needed, describe the
2679 copy from/to the reload register to/from the reload operand @var{x}.
2680
2681 You do this by setting @code{sri->icode} to the instruction code of a pattern
2682 in the md file which performs the move. Operands 0 and 1 are the output
2683 and input of this copy, respectively. Operands from operand 2 onward are
2684 for scratch operands. These scratch operands must have a mode, and a
2685 single-register-class
2686 @c [later: or memory]
2687 output constraint.
2688
2689 When an intermediate register is used, the @code{secondary_reload}
2690 hook will be called again to determine how to copy the intermediate
2691 register to/from the reload operand @var{x}, so your hook must also
2692 have code to handle the register class of the intermediate operand.
2693
2694 @c [For later: maybe we'll allow multi-alternative reload patterns -
2695 @c the port maintainer could name a mov<mode> pattern that has clobbers -
2696 @c and match the constraints of input and output to determine the required
2697 @c alternative. A restriction would be that constraints used to match
2698 @c against reloads registers would have to be written as register class
2699 @c constraints, or we need a new target macro / hook that tells us if an
2700 @c arbitrary constraint can match an unknown register of a given class.
2701 @c Such a macro / hook would also be useful in other places.]
2702
2703
2704 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2705 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2706 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2707 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2708
2709 Scratch operands in memory (constraint @code{"=m"} / @code{"=&m"}) are
2710 currently not supported. For the time being, you will have to continue
2711 to use @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} for that purpose.
2712
2713 @code{copy_cost} also uses this target hook to find out how values are
2714 copied. If you want it to include some extra cost for the need to allocate
2715 (a) scratch register(s), set @code{sri->extra_cost} to the additional cost.
2716 Or if two dependent moves are supposed to have a lower cost than the sum
2717 of the individual moves due to expected fortuitous scheduling and/or special
2718 forwarding logic, you can set @code{sri->extra_cost} to a negative amount.
2719 @end deftypefn
2720
2721 @defmac SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2722 @defmacx SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2723 @defmacx SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS (@var{class}, @var{mode}, @var{x})
2724 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
2725 @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD} instead.
2726
2727 These are obsolete macros, replaced by the @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_RELOAD}
2728 target hook. Older ports still define these macros to indicate to the
2729 reload phase that it may
2730 need to allocate at least one register for a reload in addition to the
2731 register to contain the data. Specifically, if copying @var{x} to a
2732 register @var{class} in @var{mode} requires an intermediate register,
2733 you were supposed to define @code{SECONDARY_INPUT_RELOAD_CLASS} to return the
2734 largest register class all of whose registers can be used as
2735 intermediate registers or scratch registers.
2736
2737 If copying a register @var{class} in @var{mode} to @var{x} requires an
2738 intermediate or scratch register, @code{SECONDARY_OUTPUT_RELOAD_CLASS}
2739 was supposed to be defined be defined to return the largest register
2740 class required. If the
2741 requirements for input and output reloads were the same, the macro
2742 @code{SECONDARY_RELOAD_CLASS} should have been used instead of defining both
2743 macros identically.
2744
2745 The values returned by these macros are often @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
2746 Return @code{NO_REGS} if no spare register is needed; i.e., if @var{x}
2747 can be directly copied to or from a register of @var{class} in
2748 @var{mode} without requiring a scratch register. Do not define this
2749 macro if it would always return @code{NO_REGS}.
2750
2751 If a scratch register is required (either with or without an
2752 intermediate register), you were supposed to define patterns for
2753 @samp{reload_in@var{m}} or @samp{reload_out@var{m}}, as required
2754 (@pxref{Standard Names}. These patterns, which were normally
2755 implemented with a @code{define_expand}, should be similar to the
2756 @samp{mov@var{m}} patterns, except that operand 2 is the scratch
2757 register.
2758
2759 These patterns need constraints for the reload register and scratch
2760 register that
2761 contain a single register class. If the original reload register (whose
2762 class is @var{class}) can meet the constraint given in the pattern, the
2763 value returned by these macros is used for the class of the scratch
2764 register. Otherwise, two additional reload registers are required.
2765 Their classes are obtained from the constraints in the insn pattern.
2766
2767 @var{x} might be a pseudo-register or a @code{subreg} of a
2768 pseudo-register, which could either be in a hard register or in memory.
2769 Use @code{true_regnum} to find out; it will return @minus{}1 if the pseudo is
2770 in memory and the hard register number if it is in a register.
2771
2772 These macros should not be used in the case where a particular class of
2773 registers can only be copied to memory and not to another class of
2774 registers. In that case, secondary reload registers are not needed and
2775 would not be helpful. Instead, a stack location must be used to perform
2776 the copy and the @code{mov@var{m}} pattern should use memory as an
2777 intermediate storage. This case often occurs between floating-point and
2778 general registers.
2779 @end defmac
2780
2781 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED (machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{class1}, reg_class_t @var{class2})
2782 Certain machines have the property that some registers cannot be copied
2783 to some other registers without using memory. Define this hook on
2784 those machines to return true if objects of mode @var{m} in registers
2785 of @var{class1} can only be copied to registers of class @var{class2} by
2786 storing a register of @var{class1} into memory and loading that memory
2787 location into a register of @var{class2}. The default definition returns
2788 false for all inputs.
2789 @end deftypefn
2790
2791 @defmac SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_RTX (@var{mode})
2792 Normally when @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} is defined, the compiler
2793 allocates a stack slot for a memory location needed for register copies.
2794 If this macro is defined, the compiler instead uses the memory location
2795 defined by this macro.
2796
2797 Do not define this macro if you do not define
2798 @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED}.
2799 @end defmac
2800
2801 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode})
2802 If @code{TARGET_SECONDARY_MEMORY_NEEDED} tells the compiler to use memory
2803 when moving between two particular registers of mode @var{mode},
2804 this hook specifies the mode that the memory should have.
2805
2806 The default depends on @code{TARGET_LRA_P}. Without LRA, the default
2807 is to use a word-sized mode for integral modes that are smaller than a
2808 a word. This is right thing to do on most machines because it ensures
2809 that all bits of the register are copied and prevents accesses to the
2810 registers in a narrower mode, which some machines prohibit for
2811 floating-point registers.
2812
2813 However, this default behavior is not correct on some machines, such as
2814 the DEC Alpha, that store short integers in floating-point registers
2815 differently than in integer registers. On those machines, the default
2816 widening will not work correctly and you must define this hook to
2817 suppress that widening in some cases. See the file @file{alpha.c} for
2818 details.
2819
2820 With LRA, the default is to use @var{mode} unmodified.
2821 @end deftypefn
2822
2823 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SELECT_EARLY_REMAT_MODES (sbitmap @var{modes})
2824 On some targets, certain modes cannot be held in registers around a
2825 standard ABI call and are relatively expensive to spill to the stack.
2826 The early rematerialization pass can help in such cases by aggressively
2827 recomputing values after calls, so that they don't need to be spilled.
2828
2829 This hook returns the set of such modes by setting the associated bits
2830 in @var{modes}. The default implementation selects no modes, which has
2831 the effect of disabling the early rematerialization pass.
2832 @end deftypefn
2833
2834 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CLASS_LIKELY_SPILLED_P (reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2835 A target hook which returns @code{true} if pseudos that have been assigned
2836 to registers of class @var{rclass} would likely be spilled because
2837 registers of @var{rclass} are needed for spill registers.
2838
2839 The default version of this target hook returns @code{true} if @var{rclass}
2840 has exactly one register and @code{false} otherwise. On most machines, this
2841 default should be used. For generally register-starved machines, such as
2842 i386, or machines with right register constraints, such as SH, this hook
2843 can be used to avoid excessive spilling.
2844
2845 This hook is also used by some of the global intra-procedural code
2846 transformations to throtle code motion, to avoid increasing register
2847 pressure.
2848 @end deftypefn
2849
2850 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (reg_class_t @var{rclass}, machine_mode @var{mode})
2851 A target hook returns the maximum number of consecutive registers
2852 of class @var{rclass} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2853
2854 This is closely related to the macro @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_NREGS}.
2855 In fact, the value returned by @code{TARGET_CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{rclass},
2856 @var{mode})} target hook should be the maximum value of
2857 @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno}, @var{mode})} for all @var{regno}
2858 values in the class @var{rclass}.
2859
2860 This target hook helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2861 in the reload pass.
2862
2863 The default version of this target hook returns the size of @var{mode}
2864 in words.
2865 @end deftypefn
2866
2867 @defmac CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})
2868 A C expression for the maximum number of consecutive registers
2869 of class @var{class} needed to hold a value of mode @var{mode}.
2870
2871 This is closely related to the macro @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_NREGS}. In fact,
2872 the value of the macro @code{CLASS_MAX_NREGS (@var{class}, @var{mode})}
2873 should be the maximum value of @code{TARGET_HARD_REGNO_NREGS (@var{regno},
2874 @var{mode})} for all @var{regno} values in the class @var{class}.
2875
2876 This macro helps control the handling of multiple-word values
2877 in the reload pass.
2878 @end defmac
2879
2880 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS (machine_mode @var{from}, machine_mode @var{to}, reg_class_t @var{rclass})
2881 This hook returns true if it is possible to bitcast values held in
2882 registers of class @var{rclass} from mode @var{from} to mode @var{to}
2883 and if doing so preserves the low-order bits that are common to both modes.
2884 The result is only meaningful if @var{rclass} has registers that can hold
2885 both @code{from} and @code{to}. The default implementation returns true.
2886
2887 As an example of when such bitcasting is invalid, loading 32-bit integer or
2888 floating-point objects into floating-point registers on Alpha extends them
2889 to 64 bits. Therefore loading a 64-bit object and then storing it as a
2890 32-bit object does not store the low-order 32 bits, as would be the case
2891 for a normal register. Therefore, @file{alpha.h} defines
2892 @code{TARGET_CAN_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} to return:
2893
2894 @smallexample
2895 (GET_MODE_SIZE (from) == GET_MODE_SIZE (to)
2896 || !reg_classes_intersect_p (FLOAT_REGS, rclass))
2897 @end smallexample
2898
2899 Even if storing from a register in mode @var{to} would be valid,
2900 if both @var{from} and @code{raw_reg_mode} for @var{rclass} are wider
2901 than @code{word_mode}, then we must prevent @var{to} narrowing the
2902 mode. This happens when the middle-end assumes that it can load
2903 or store pieces of an @var{N}-word pseudo, and that the pseudo will
2904 eventually be allocated to @var{N} @code{word_mode} hard registers.
2905 Failure to prevent this kind of mode change will result in the
2906 entire @code{raw_reg_mode} being modified instead of the partial
2907 value that the middle-end intended.
2908 @end deftypefn
2909
2910 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_IRA_CHANGE_PSEUDO_ALLOCNO_CLASS (int, @var{reg_class_t}, @var{reg_class_t})
2911 A target hook which can change allocno class for given pseudo from
2912 allocno and best class calculated by IRA.
2913
2914 The default version of this target hook always returns given class.
2915 @end deftypefn
2916
2917 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LRA_P (void)
2918 A target hook which returns true if we use LRA instead of reload pass. The default version of this target hook returns true. New ports should use LRA, and existing ports are encouraged to convert.
2919 @end deftypefn
2920
2921 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_PRIORITY (int)
2922 A target hook which returns the register priority number to which the register @var{hard_regno} belongs to. The bigger the number, the more preferable the hard register usage (when all other conditions are the same). This hook can be used to prefer some hard register over others in LRA. For example, some x86-64 register usage needs additional prefix which makes instructions longer. The hook can return lower priority number for such registers make them less favorable and as result making the generated code smaller. The default version of this target hook returns always zero.
2923 @end deftypefn
2924
2925 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_REGISTER_USAGE_LEVELING_P (void)
2926 A target hook which returns true if we need register usage leveling. That means if a few hard registers are equally good for the assignment, we choose the least used hard register. The register usage leveling may be profitable for some targets. Don't use the usage leveling for targets with conditional execution or targets with big register files as it hurts if-conversion and cross-jumping optimizations. The default version of this target hook returns always false.
2927 @end deftypefn
2928
2929 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DIFFERENT_ADDR_DISPLACEMENT_P (void)
2930 A target hook which returns true if an address with the same structure can have different maximal legitimate displacement. For example, the displacement can depend on memory mode or on operand combinations in the insn. The default version of this target hook returns always false.
2931 @end deftypefn
2932
2933 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_SUBSTITUTE_MEM_EQUIV_P (rtx @var{subst})
2934 A target hook which returns @code{true} if @var{subst} can't
2935 substitute safely pseudos with equivalent memory values during
2936 register allocation.
2937 The default version of this target hook returns @code{false}.
2938 On most machines, this default should be used. For generally
2939 machines with non orthogonal register usage for addressing, such
2940 as SH, this hook can be used to avoid excessive spilling.
2941 @end deftypefn
2942
2943 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS_DISPLACEMENT (rtx *@var{offset1}, rtx *@var{offset2}, poly_int64 @var{orig_offset}, machine_mode @var{mode})
2944 This hook tries to split address offset @var{orig_offset} into
2945 two parts: one that should be added to the base address to create
2946 a local anchor point, and an additional offset that can be applied
2947 to the anchor to address a value of mode @var{mode}. The idea is that
2948 the local anchor could be shared by other accesses to nearby locations.
2949
2950 The hook returns true if it succeeds, storing the offset of the
2951 anchor from the base in @var{offset1} and the offset of the final address
2952 from the anchor in @var{offset2}. The default implementation returns false.
2953 @end deftypefn
2954
2955 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_SPILL_CLASS (reg_class_t, @var{machine_mode})
2956 This hook defines a class of registers which could be used for spilling pseudos of the given mode and class, or @code{NO_REGS} if only memory should be used. Not defining this hook is equivalent to returning @code{NO_REGS} for all inputs.
2957 @end deftypefn
2958
2959 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDITIONAL_ALLOCNO_CLASS_P (reg_class_t)
2960 This hook should return @code{true} if given class of registers should be an allocno class in any way. Usually RA uses only one register class from all classes containing the same register set. In some complicated cases, you need to have two or more such classes as allocno ones for RA correct work. Not defining this hook is equivalent to returning @code{false} for all inputs.
2961 @end deftypefn
2962
2963 @deftypefn {Target Hook} scalar_int_mode TARGET_CSTORE_MODE (enum insn_code @var{icode})
2964 This hook defines the machine mode to use for the boolean result of conditional store patterns. The ICODE argument is the instruction code for the cstore being performed. Not definiting this hook is the same as accepting the mode encoded into operand 0 of the cstore expander patterns.
2965 @end deftypefn
2966
2967 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMPUTE_PRESSURE_CLASSES (enum reg_class *@var{pressure_classes})
2968 A target hook which lets a backend compute the set of pressure classes to be used by those optimization passes which take register pressure into account, as opposed to letting IRA compute them. It returns the number of register classes stored in the array @var{pressure_classes}.
2969 @end deftypefn
2970
2971 @node Stack and Calling
2972 @section Stack Layout and Calling Conventions
2973 @cindex calling conventions
2974
2975 @c prevent bad page break with this line
2976 This describes the stack layout and calling conventions.
2977
2978 @menu
2979 * Frame Layout::
2980 * Exception Handling::
2981 * Stack Checking::
2982 * Frame Registers::
2983 * Elimination::
2984 * Stack Arguments::
2985 * Register Arguments::
2986 * Scalar Return::
2987 * Aggregate Return::
2988 * Caller Saves::
2989 * Function Entry::
2990 * Profiling::
2991 * Tail Calls::
2992 * Shrink-wrapping separate components::
2993 * Stack Smashing Protection::
2994 * Miscellaneous Register Hooks::
2995 @end menu
2996
2997 @node Frame Layout
2998 @subsection Basic Stack Layout
2999 @cindex stack frame layout
3000 @cindex frame layout
3001
3002 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3003 Here is the basic stack layout.
3004
3005 @defmac STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3006 Define this macro to be true if pushing a word onto the stack moves the stack
3007 pointer to a smaller address, and false otherwise.
3008 @end defmac
3009
3010 @defmac STACK_PUSH_CODE
3011 This macro defines the operation used when something is pushed
3012 on the stack. In RTL, a push operation will be
3013 @code{(set (mem (STACK_PUSH_CODE (reg sp))) @dots{})}
3014
3015 The choices are @code{PRE_DEC}, @code{POST_DEC}, @code{PRE_INC},
3016 and @code{POST_INC}. Which of these is correct depends on
3017 the stack direction and on whether the stack pointer points
3018 to the last item on the stack or whether it points to the
3019 space for the next item on the stack.
3020
3021 The default is @code{PRE_DEC} when @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is
3022 true, which is almost always right, and @code{PRE_INC} otherwise,
3023 which is often wrong.
3024 @end defmac
3025
3026 @defmac FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD
3027 Define this macro to nonzero value if the addresses of local variable slots
3028 are at negative offsets from the frame pointer.
3029 @end defmac
3030
3031 @defmac ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD
3032 Define this macro if successive arguments to a function occupy decreasing
3033 addresses on the stack.
3034 @end defmac
3035
3036 @deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET (void)
3037 This hook returns the offset from the frame pointer to the first local
3038 variable slot to be allocated. If @code{FRAME_GROWS_DOWNWARD}, it is the
3039 offset to @emph{end} of the first slot allocated, otherwise it is the
3040 offset to @emph{beginning} of the first slot allocated. The default
3041 implementation returns 0.
3042 @end deftypefn
3043
3044 @defmac STACK_ALIGNMENT_NEEDED
3045 Define to zero to disable final alignment of the stack during reload.
3046 The nonzero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
3047
3048 On ports where @code{TARGET_STARTING_FRAME_OFFSET} is nonzero or where there
3049 is a register save block following the local block that doesn't require
3050 alignment to @code{STACK_BOUNDARY}, it may be beneficial to disable
3051 stack alignment and do it in the backend.
3052 @end defmac
3053
3054 @defmac STACK_POINTER_OFFSET
3055 Offset from the stack pointer register to the first location at which
3056 outgoing arguments are placed. If not specified, the default value of
3057 zero is used. This is the proper value for most machines.
3058
3059 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3060 the first location at which outgoing arguments are placed.
3061 @end defmac
3062
3063 @defmac FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3064 Offset from the argument pointer register to the first argument's
3065 address. On some machines it may depend on the data type of the
3066 function.
3067
3068 If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, this is the offset to the location above
3069 the first argument's address.
3070 @end defmac
3071
3072 @defmac STACK_DYNAMIC_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3073 Offset from the stack pointer register to an item dynamically allocated
3074 on the stack, e.g., by @code{alloca}.
3075
3076 The default value for this macro is @code{STACK_POINTER_OFFSET} plus the
3077 length of the outgoing arguments. The default is correct for most
3078 machines. See @file{function.c} for details.
3079 @end defmac
3080
3081 @defmac INITIAL_FRAME_ADDRESS_RTX
3082 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address of the initial
3083 stack frame. This address is passed to @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and
3084 @code{DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS}. If you don't define this macro, a reasonable
3085 default value will be used. Define this macro in order to make frame pointer
3086 elimination work in the presence of @code{__builtin_frame_address (count)} and
3087 @code{__builtin_return_address (count)} for @code{count} not equal to zero.
3088 @end defmac
3089
3090 @defmac DYNAMIC_CHAIN_ADDRESS (@var{frameaddr})
3091 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the address in a stack
3092 frame where the pointer to the caller's frame is stored. Assume that
3093 @var{frameaddr} is an RTL expression for the address of the stack frame
3094 itself.
3095
3096 If you don't define this macro, the default is to return the value
3097 of @var{frameaddr}---that is, the stack frame address is also the
3098 address of the stack word that points to the previous frame.
3099 @end defmac
3100
3101 @defmac SETUP_FRAME_ADDRESSES
3102 A C expression that produces the machine-specific code to
3103 setup the stack so that arbitrary frames can be accessed. For example,
3104 on the SPARC, we must flush all of the register windows to the stack
3105 before we can access arbitrary stack frames. You will seldom need to
3106 define this macro. The default is to do nothing.
3107 @end defmac
3108
3109 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_BUILTIN_SETJMP_FRAME_VALUE (void)
3110 This target hook should return an rtx that is used to store
3111 the address of the current frame into the built in @code{setjmp} buffer.
3112 The default value, @code{virtual_stack_vars_rtx}, is correct for most
3113 machines. One reason you may need to define this target hook is if
3114 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} is the appropriate value on your machine.
3115 @end deftypefn
3116
3117 @defmac FRAME_ADDR_RTX (@var{frameaddr})
3118 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the frame
3119 address for the current frame. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer
3120 of the current frame. This is used for __builtin_frame_address.
3121 You need only define this macro if the frame address is not the same
3122 as the frame pointer. Most machines do not need to define it.
3123 @end defmac
3124
3125 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_RTX (@var{count}, @var{frameaddr})
3126 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the value of the return
3127 address for the frame @var{count} steps up from the current frame, after
3128 the prologue. @var{frameaddr} is the frame pointer of the @var{count}
3129 frame, or the frame pointer of the @var{count} @minus{} 1 frame if
3130 @code{RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME} is nonzero.
3131
3132 The value of the expression must always be the correct address when
3133 @var{count} is zero, but may be @code{NULL_RTX} if there is no way to
3134 determine the return address of other frames.
3135 @end defmac
3136
3137 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_IN_PREVIOUS_FRAME
3138 Define this macro to nonzero value if the return address of a particular
3139 stack frame is accessed from the frame pointer of the previous stack
3140 frame. The zero default for this macro is suitable for most ports.
3141 @end defmac
3142
3143 @defmac INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX
3144 A C expression whose value is RTL representing the location of the
3145 incoming return address at the beginning of any function, before the
3146 prologue. This RTL is either a @code{REG}, indicating that the return
3147 value is saved in @samp{REG}, or a @code{MEM} representing a location in
3148 the stack.
3149
3150 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3151 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3152
3153 If this RTL is a @code{REG}, you should also define
3154 @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (REGNO)}.
3155 @end defmac
3156
3157 @defmac DWARF_ALT_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN
3158 A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 column
3159 number that may be used as an alternative return column. The column
3160 must not correspond to any gcc hard register (that is, it must not
3161 be in the range of @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM}).
3162
3163 This macro can be useful if @code{DWARF_FRAME_RETURN_COLUMN} is set to a
3164 general register, but an alternative column needs to be used for signal
3165 frames. Some targets have also used different frame return columns
3166 over time.
3167 @end defmac
3168
3169 @defmac DWARF_ZERO_REG
3170 A C expression whose value is an integer giving a DWARF 2 register
3171 number that is considered to always have the value zero. This should
3172 only be defined if the target has an architected zero register, and
3173 someone decided it was a good idea to use that register number to
3174 terminate the stack backtrace. New ports should avoid this.
3175 @end defmac
3176
3177 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_DWARF_HANDLE_FRAME_UNSPEC (const char *@var{label}, rtx @var{pattern}, int @var{index})
3178 This target hook allows the backend to emit frame-related insns that
3179 contain UNSPECs or UNSPEC_VOLATILEs. The DWARF 2 call frame debugging
3180 info engine will invoke it on insns of the form
3181 @smallexample
3182 (set (reg) (unspec [@dots{}] UNSPEC_INDEX))
3183 @end smallexample
3184 and
3185 @smallexample
3186 (set (reg) (unspec_volatile [@dots{}] UNSPECV_INDEX)).
3187 @end smallexample
3188 to let the backend emit the call frame instructions. @var{label} is
3189 the CFI label attached to the insn, @var{pattern} is the pattern of
3190 the insn and @var{index} is @code{UNSPEC_INDEX} or @code{UNSPECV_INDEX}.
3191 @end deftypefn
3192
3193 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_DWARF_POLY_INDETERMINATE_VALUE (unsigned int @var{i}, unsigned int *@var{factor}, int *@var{offset})
3194 Express the value of @code{poly_int} indeterminate @var{i} as a DWARF
3195 expression, with @var{i} counting from 1. Return the number of a DWARF
3196 register @var{R} and set @samp{*@var{factor}} and @samp{*@var{offset}} such
3197 that the value of the indeterminate is:
3198 @smallexample
3199 value_of(@var{R}) / @var{factor} - @var{offset}
3200 @end smallexample
3201
3202 A target only needs to define this hook if it sets
3203 @samp{NUM_POLY_INT_COEFFS} to a value greater than 1.
3204 @end deftypefn
3205
3206 @defmac INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
3207 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3208 from the value of the stack pointer register to the top of the stack
3209 frame at the beginning of any function, before the prologue. The top of
3210 the frame is defined to be the value of the stack pointer in the
3211 previous frame, just before the call instruction.
3212
3213 You only need to define this macro if you want to support call frame
3214 debugging information like that provided by DWARF 2.
3215 @end defmac
3216
3217 @defmac DEFAULT_INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET
3218 Like @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}, but must be the same for all
3219 functions of the same ABI, and when using GAS @code{.cfi_*} directives
3220 must also agree with the default CFI GAS emits. Define this macro
3221 only if @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET} can have different values
3222 between different functions of the same ABI or when
3223 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET} does not agree with GAS default CFI.
3224 @end defmac
3225
3226 @defmac ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3227 A C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset, in bytes,
3228 from the argument pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa). The
3229 final value should coincide with that calculated by
3230 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}. Which is unfortunately not usable
3231 during virtual register instantiation.
3232
3233 The default value for this macro is
3234 @code{FIRST_PARM_OFFSET (fundecl) + crtl->args.pretend_args_size},
3235 which is correct for most machines; in general, the arguments are found
3236 immediately before the stack frame. Note that this is not the case on
3237 some targets that save registers into the caller's frame, such as SPARC
3238 and rs6000, and so such targets need to define this macro.
3239
3240 You only need to define this macro if the default is incorrect, and you
3241 want to support call frame debugging information like that provided by
3242 DWARF 2.
3243 @end defmac
3244
3245 @defmac FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3246 If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3247 in bytes from the frame pointer to the canonical frame address (cfa).
3248 The final value should coincide with that calculated by
3249 @code{INCOMING_FRAME_SP_OFFSET}.
3250
3251 Normally the CFA is calculated as an offset from the argument pointer,
3252 via @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}, but if the argument pointer is
3253 variable due to the ABI, this may not be possible. If this macro is
3254 defined, it implies that the virtual register instantiation should be
3255 based on the frame pointer instead of the argument pointer. Only one
3256 of @code{FRAME_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET} and @code{ARG_POINTER_CFA_OFFSET}
3257 should be defined.
3258 @end defmac
3259
3260 @defmac CFA_FRAME_BASE_OFFSET (@var{fundecl})
3261 If defined, a C expression whose value is an integer giving the offset
3262 in bytes from the canonical frame address (cfa) to the frame base used
3263 in DWARF 2 debug information. The default is zero. A different value
3264 may reduce the size of debug information on some ports.
3265 @end defmac
3266
3267 @node Exception Handling
3268 @subsection Exception Handling Support
3269 @cindex exception handling
3270
3271 @defmac EH_RETURN_DATA_REGNO (@var{N})
3272 A C expression whose value is the @var{N}th register number used for
3273 data by exception handlers, or @code{INVALID_REGNUM} if fewer than
3274 @var{N} registers are usable.
3275
3276 The exception handling library routines communicate with the exception
3277 handlers via a set of agreed upon registers. Ideally these registers
3278 should be call-clobbered; it is possible to use call-saved registers,
3279 but may negatively impact code size. The target must support at least
3280 2 data registers, but should define 4 if there are enough free registers.
3281
3282 You must define this macro if you want to support call frame exception
3283 handling like that provided by DWARF 2.
3284 @end defmac
3285
3286 @defmac EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX
3287 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3288 to store a stack adjustment to be applied before function return.
3289 This is used to unwind the stack to an exception handler's call frame.
3290 It will be assigned zero on code paths that return normally.
3291
3292 Typically this is a call-clobbered hard register that is otherwise
3293 untouched by the epilogue, but could also be a stack slot.
3294
3295 Do not define this macro if the stack pointer is saved and restored
3296 by the regular prolog and epilog code in the call frame itself; in
3297 this case, the exception handling library routines will update the
3298 stack location to be restored in place. Otherwise, you must define
3299 this macro if you want to support call frame exception handling like
3300 that provided by DWARF 2.
3301 @end defmac
3302
3303 @defmac EH_RETURN_HANDLER_RTX
3304 A C expression whose value is RTL representing a location in which
3305 to store the address of an exception handler to which we should
3306 return. It will not be assigned on code paths that return normally.
3307
3308 Typically this is the location in the call frame at which the normal
3309 return address is stored. For targets that return by popping an
3310 address off the stack, this might be a memory address just below
3311 the @emph{target} call frame rather than inside the current call
3312 frame. If defined, @code{EH_RETURN_STACKADJ_RTX} will have already
3313 been assigned, so it may be used to calculate the location of the
3314 target call frame.
3315
3316 Some targets have more complex requirements than storing to an
3317 address calculable during initial code generation. In that case
3318 the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern should be used instead.
3319
3320 If you want to support call frame exception handling, you must
3321 define either this macro or the @code{eh_return} instruction pattern.
3322 @end defmac
3323
3324 @defmac RETURN_ADDR_OFFSET
3325 If defined, an integer-valued C expression for which rtl will be generated
3326 to add it to the exception handler address before it is searched in the
3327 exception handling tables, and to subtract it again from the address before
3328 using it to return to the exception handler.
3329 @end defmac
3330
3331 @defmac ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT (@var{code}, @var{global})
3332 This macro chooses the encoding of pointers embedded in the exception
3333 handling sections. If at all possible, this should be defined such
3334 that the exception handling section will not require dynamic relocations,
3335 and so may be read-only.
3336
3337 @var{code} is 0 for data, 1 for code labels, 2 for function pointers.
3338 @var{global} is true if the symbol may be affected by dynamic relocations.
3339 The macro should return a combination of the @code{DW_EH_PE_*} defines
3340 as found in @file{dwarf2.h}.
3341
3342 If this macro is not defined, pointers will not be encoded but
3343 represented directly.
3344 @end defmac
3345
3346 @defmac ASM_MAYBE_OUTPUT_ENCODED_ADDR_RTX (@var{file}, @var{encoding}, @var{size}, @var{addr}, @var{done})
3347 This macro allows the target to emit whatever special magic is required
3348 to represent the encoding chosen by @code{ASM_PREFERRED_EH_DATA_FORMAT}.
3349 Generic code takes care of pc-relative and indirect encodings; this must
3350 be defined if the target uses text-relative or data-relative encodings.
3351
3352 This is a C statement that branches to @var{done} if the format was
3353 handled. @var{encoding} is the format chosen, @var{size} is the number
3354 of bytes that the format occupies, @var{addr} is the @code{SYMBOL_REF}
3355 to be emitted.
3356 @end defmac
3357
3358 @defmac MD_FALLBACK_FRAME_STATE_FOR (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3359 This macro allows the target to add CPU and operating system specific
3360 code to the call-frame unwinder for use when there is no unwind data
3361 available. The most common reason to implement this macro is to unwind
3362 through signal frames.
3363
3364 This macro is called from @code{uw_frame_state_for} in
3365 @file{unwind-dw2.c}, @file{unwind-dw2-xtensa.c} and
3366 @file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3367 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{context->ra}
3368 for the address of the code being executed and @code{context->cfa} for
3369 the stack pointer value. If the frame can be decoded, the register
3370 save addresses should be updated in @var{fs} and the macro should
3371 evaluate to @code{_URC_NO_REASON}. If the frame cannot be decoded,
3372 the macro should evaluate to @code{_URC_END_OF_STACK}.
3373
3374 For proper signal handling in Java this macro is accompanied by
3375 @code{MAKE_THROW_FRAME}, defined in @file{libjava/include/*-signal.h} headers.
3376 @end defmac
3377
3378 @defmac MD_HANDLE_UNWABI (@var{context}, @var{fs})
3379 This macro allows the target to add operating system specific code to the
3380 call-frame unwinder to handle the IA-64 @code{.unwabi} unwinding directive,
3381 usually used for signal or interrupt frames.
3382
3383 This macro is called from @code{uw_update_context} in libgcc's
3384 @file{unwind-ia64.c}. @var{context} is an @code{_Unwind_Context};
3385 @var{fs} is an @code{_Unwind_FrameState}. Examine @code{fs->unwabi}
3386 for the abi and context in the @code{.unwabi} directive. If the
3387 @code{.unwabi} directive can be handled, the register save addresses should
3388 be updated in @var{fs}.
3389 @end defmac
3390
3391 @defmac TARGET_USES_WEAK_UNWIND_INFO
3392 A C expression that evaluates to true if the target requires unwind
3393 info to be given comdat linkage. Define it to be @code{1} if comdat
3394 linkage is necessary. The default is @code{0}.
3395 @end defmac
3396
3397 @node Stack Checking
3398 @subsection Specifying How Stack Checking is Done
3399
3400 GCC will check that stack references are within the boundaries of the
3401 stack, if the option @option{-fstack-check} is specified, in one of
3402 three ways:
3403
3404 @enumerate
3405 @item
3406 If the value of the @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC
3407 will assume that you have arranged for full stack checking to be done
3408 at appropriate places in the configuration files. GCC will not do
3409 other special processing.
3410
3411 @item
3412 If @code{STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN} is zero and the value of the
3413 @code{STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN} macro is nonzero, GCC will assume
3414 that you have arranged for static stack checking (checking of the
3415 static stack frame of functions) to be done at appropriate places
3416 in the configuration files. GCC will only emit code to do dynamic
3417 stack checking (checking on dynamic stack allocations) using the third
3418 approach below.
3419
3420 @item
3421 If neither of the above are true, GCC will generate code to periodically
3422 ``probe'' the stack pointer using the values of the macros defined below.
3423 @end enumerate
3424
3425 If neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined,
3426 GCC will change its allocation strategy for large objects if the option
3427 @option{-fstack-check} is specified: they will always be allocated
3428 dynamically if their size exceeds @code{STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE} bytes.
3429
3430 @defmac STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3431 A nonzero value if stack checking is done by the configuration files in a
3432 machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if stack checking
3433 is required by the ABI of your machine or if you would like to do stack
3434 checking in some more efficient way than the generic approach. The default
3435 value of this macro is zero.
3436 @end defmac
3437
3438 @defmac STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN
3439 A nonzero value if static stack checking is done by the configuration files
3440 in a machine-dependent manner. You should define this macro if you would
3441 like to do static stack checking in some more efficient way than the generic
3442 approach. The default value of this macro is zero.
3443 @end defmac
3444
3445 @defmac STACK_CHECK_PROBE_INTERVAL_EXP
3446 An integer specifying the interval at which GCC must generate stack probe
3447 instructions, defined as 2 raised to this integer. You will normally
3448 define this macro so that the interval be no larger than the size of
3449 the ``guard pages'' at the end of a stack area. The default value
3450 of 12 (4096-byte interval) is suitable for most systems.
3451 @end defmac
3452
3453 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MOVING_SP
3454 An integer which is nonzero if GCC should move the stack pointer page by page
3455 when doing probes. This can be necessary on systems where the stack pointer
3456 contains the bottom address of the memory area accessible to the executing
3457 thread at any point in time. In this situation an alternate signal stack
3458 is required in order to be able to recover from a stack overflow. The
3459 default value of this macro is zero.
3460 @end defmac
3461
3462 @defmac STACK_CHECK_PROTECT
3463 The number of bytes of stack needed to recover from a stack overflow, for
3464 languages where such a recovery is supported. The default value of 4KB/8KB
3465 with the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism and
3466 8KB/12KB with other exception handling mechanisms should be adequate for most
3467 architectures and operating systems.
3468 @end defmac
3469
3470 The following macros are relevant only if neither STACK_CHECK_BUILTIN
3471 nor STACK_CHECK_STATIC_BUILTIN is defined; you can omit them altogether
3472 in the opposite case.
3473
3474 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_FRAME_SIZE
3475 The maximum size of a stack frame, in bytes. GCC will generate probe
3476 instructions in non-leaf functions to ensure at least this many bytes of
3477 stack are available. If a stack frame is larger than this size, stack
3478 checking will not be reliable and GCC will issue a warning. The
3479 default is chosen so that GCC only generates one instruction on most
3480 systems. You should normally not change the default value of this macro.
3481 @end defmac
3482
3483 @defmac STACK_CHECK_FIXED_FRAME_SIZE
3484 GCC uses this value to generate the above warning message. It
3485 represents the amount of fixed frame used by a function, not including
3486 space for any callee-saved registers, temporaries and user variables.
3487 You need only specify an upper bound for this amount and will normally
3488 use the default of four words.
3489 @end defmac
3490
3491 @defmac STACK_CHECK_MAX_VAR_SIZE
3492 The maximum size, in bytes, of an object that GCC will place in the
3493 fixed area of the stack frame when the user specifies
3494 @option{-fstack-check}.
3495 GCC computed the default from the values of the above macros and you will
3496 normally not need to override that default.
3497 @end defmac
3498
3499 @deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_STACK_CLASH_PROTECTION_ALLOCA_PROBE_RANGE (void)
3500 Some targets have an ABI defined interval for which no probing needs to be done.
3501 When a probe does need to be done this same interval is used as the probe distance up when doing stack clash protection for alloca.
3502 On such targets this value can be set to override the default probing up interval.
3503 Define this variable to return nonzero if such a probe range is required or zero otherwise. Defining this hook also requires your functions which make use of alloca to have at least 8 byesof outgoing arguments. If this is not the case the stack will be corrupted.
3504 You need not define this macro if it would always have the value zero.
3505 @end deftypefn
3506
3507 @need 2000
3508 @node Frame Registers
3509 @subsection Registers That Address the Stack Frame
3510
3511 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3512 This discusses registers that address the stack frame.
3513
3514 @defmac STACK_POINTER_REGNUM
3515 The register number of the stack pointer register, which must also be a
3516 fixed register according to @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}. On most machines,
3517 the hardware determines which register this is.
3518 @end defmac
3519
3520 @defmac FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3521 The register number of the frame pointer register, which is used to
3522 access automatic variables in the stack frame. On some machines, the
3523 hardware determines which register this is. On other machines, you can
3524 choose any register you wish for this purpose.
3525 @end defmac
3526
3527 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3528 On some machines the offset between the frame pointer and starting
3529 offset of the automatic variables is not known until after register
3530 allocation has been done (for example, because the saved registers are
3531 between these two locations). On those machines, define
3532 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} the number of a special, fixed register to
3533 be used internally until the offset is known, and define
3534 @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} to be the actual hard register number
3535 used for the frame pointer.
3536
3537 You should define this macro only in the very rare circumstances when it
3538 is not possible to calculate the offset between the frame pointer and
3539 the automatic variables until after register allocation has been
3540 completed. When this macro is defined, you must also indicate in your
3541 definition of @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} how to eliminate
3542 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM} into either @code{HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}
3543 or @code{STACK_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3544
3545 Do not define this macro if it would be the same as
3546 @code{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM}.
3547 @end defmac
3548
3549 @defmac ARG_POINTER_REGNUM
3550 The register number of the arg pointer register, which is used to access
3551 the function's argument list. On some machines, this is the same as the
3552 frame pointer register. On some machines, the hardware determines which
3553 register this is. On other machines, you can choose any register you
3554 wish for this purpose. If this is not the same register as the frame
3555 pointer register, then you must mark it as a fixed register according to
3556 @code{FIXED_REGISTERS}, or arrange to be able to eliminate it
3557 (@pxref{Elimination}).
3558 @end defmac
3559
3560 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_FRAME_POINTER
3561 Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3562 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{frame_pointer_rtx} should be
3563 the same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM
3564 == FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3565 definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3566 @end defmac
3567
3568 @defmac HARD_FRAME_POINTER_IS_ARG_POINTER
3569 Define this to a preprocessor constant that is nonzero if
3570 @code{hard_frame_pointer_rtx} and @code{arg_pointer_rtx} should be the
3571 same. The default definition is @samp{(HARD_FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM ==
3572 ARG_POINTER_REGNUM)}; you only need to define this macro if that
3573 definition is not suitable for use in preprocessor conditionals.
3574 @end defmac
3575
3576 @defmac RETURN_ADDRESS_POINTER_REGNUM
3577 The register number of the return address pointer register, which is used to
3578 access the current function's return address from the stack. On some
3579 machines, the return address is not at a fixed offset from the frame
3580 pointer or stack pointer or argument pointer. This register can be defined
3581 to point to the return address on the stack, and then be converted by
3582 @code{ELIMINABLE_REGS} into either the frame pointer or stack pointer.
3583
3584 Do not define this macro unless there is no other way to get the return
3585 address from the stack.
3586 @end defmac
3587
3588 @defmac STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM
3589 @defmacx STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM
3590 Register numbers used for passing a function's static chain pointer. If
3591 register windows are used, the register number as seen by the called
3592 function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM}, while the register
3593 number as seen by the calling function is @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM}. If
3594 these registers are the same, @code{STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM} need
3595 not be defined.
3596
3597 The static chain register need not be a fixed register.
3598
3599 If the static chain is passed in memory, these macros should not be
3600 defined; instead, the @code{TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN} hook should be used.
3601 @end defmac
3602
3603 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STATIC_CHAIN (const_tree @var{fndecl_or_type}, bool @var{incoming_p})
3604 This hook replaces the use of @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al for
3605 targets that may use different static chain locations for different
3606 nested functions. This may be required if the target has function
3607 attributes that affect the calling conventions of the function and
3608 those calling conventions use different static chain locations.
3609
3610 The default version of this hook uses @code{STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM} et al.
3611
3612 If the static chain is passed in memory, this hook should be used to
3613 provide rtx giving @code{mem} expressions that denote where they are stored.
3614 Often the @code{mem} expression as seen by the caller will be at an offset
3615 from the stack pointer and the @code{mem} expression as seen by the callee
3616 will be at an offset from the frame pointer.
3617 @findex stack_pointer_rtx
3618 @findex frame_pointer_rtx
3619 @findex arg_pointer_rtx
3620 The variables @code{stack_pointer_rtx}, @code{frame_pointer_rtx}, and
3621 @code{arg_pointer_rtx} will have been initialized and should be used
3622 to refer to those items.
3623 @end deftypefn
3624
3625 @defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3626 This macro specifies the maximum number of hard registers that can be
3627 saved in a call frame. This is used to size data structures used in
3628 DWARF2 exception handling.
3629
3630 Prior to GCC 3.0, this macro was needed in order to establish a stable
3631 exception handling ABI in the face of adding new hard registers for ISA
3632 extensions. In GCC 3.0 and later, the EH ABI is insulated from changes
3633 in the number of hard registers. Nevertheless, this macro can still be
3634 used to reduce the runtime memory requirements of the exception handling
3635 routines, which can be substantial if the ISA contains a lot of
3636 registers that are not call-saved.
3637
3638 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3639 @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER}.
3640 @end defmac
3641
3642 @defmac PRE_GCC3_DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS
3643
3644 This macro is similar to @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}, but is provided
3645 for backward compatibility in pre GCC 3.0 compiled code.
3646
3647 If this macro is not defined, it defaults to
3648 @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGISTERS}.
3649 @end defmac
3650
3651 @defmac DWARF_REG_TO_UNWIND_COLUMN (@var{regno})
3652
3653 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3654 is different than the internal representation for unwind column.
3655 Given a dwarf register, this macro should return the internal unwind
3656 column number to use instead.
3657 @end defmac
3658
3659 @defmac DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM (@var{regno})
3660
3661 Define this macro if the target's representation for dwarf registers
3662 used in .eh_frame or .debug_frame is different from that used in other
3663 debug info sections. Given a GCC hard register number, this macro
3664 should return the .eh_frame register number. The default is
3665 @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})}.
3666
3667 @end defmac
3668
3669 @defmac DWARF2_FRAME_REG_OUT (@var{regno}, @var{for_eh})
3670
3671 Define this macro to map register numbers held in the call frame info
3672 that GCC has collected using @code{DWARF_FRAME_REGNUM} to those that
3673 should be output in .debug_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is zero) and
3674 .eh_frame (@code{@var{for_eh}} is nonzero). The default is to
3675 return @code{@var{regno}}.
3676
3677 @end defmac
3678
3679 @defmac REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3680
3681 Define this macro if the target stores register values as
3682 @code{_Unwind_Word} type in unwind context. It should be defined if
3683 target register size is larger than the size of @code{void *}. The
3684 default is to store register values as @code{void *} type.
3685
3686 @end defmac
3687
3688 @defmac ASSUME_EXTENDED_UNWIND_CONTEXT
3689
3690 Define this macro to be 1 if the target always uses extended unwind
3691 context with version, args_size and by_value fields. If it is undefined,
3692 it will be defined to 1 when @code{REG_VALUE_IN_UNWIND_CONTEXT} is
3693 defined and 0 otherwise.
3694
3695 @end defmac
3696
3697 @defmac DWARF_LAZY_REGISTER_VALUE (@var{regno}, @var{value})
3698 Define this macro if the target has pseudo DWARF registers whose
3699 values need to be computed lazily on demand by the unwinder (such as when
3700 referenced in a CFA expression). The macro returns true if @var{regno}
3701 is such a register and stores its value in @samp{*@var{value}} if so.
3702 @end defmac
3703
3704 @node Elimination
3705 @subsection Eliminating Frame Pointer and Arg Pointer
3706
3707 @c prevent bad page break with this line
3708 This is about eliminating the frame pointer and arg pointer.
3709
3710 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FRAME_POINTER_REQUIRED (void)
3711 This target hook should return @code{true} if a function must have and use
3712 a frame pointer. This target hook is called in the reload pass. If its return
3713 value is @code{true} the function will have a frame pointer.
3714
3715 This target hook can in principle examine the current function and decide
3716 according to the facts, but on most machines the constant @code{false} or the
3717 constant @code{true} suffices. Use @code{false} when the machine allows code
3718 to be generated with no frame pointer, and doing so saves some time or space.
3719 Use @code{true} when there is no possible advantage to avoiding a frame
3720 pointer.
3721
3722 In certain cases, the compiler does not know how to produce valid code
3723 without a frame pointer. The compiler recognizes those cases and
3724 automatically gives the function a frame pointer regardless of what
3725 @code{targetm.frame_pointer_required} returns. You don't need to worry about
3726 them.
3727
3728 In a function that does not require a frame pointer, the frame pointer
3729 register can be allocated for ordinary usage, unless you mark it as a
3730 fixed register. See @code{FIXED_REGISTERS} for more information.
3731
3732 Default return value is @code{false}.
3733 @end deftypefn
3734
3735 @defmac ELIMINABLE_REGS
3736 This macro specifies a table of register pairs used to eliminate
3737 unneeded registers that point into the stack frame.
3738
3739 The definition of this macro is a list of structure initializations, each
3740 of which specifies an original and replacement register.
3741
3742 On some machines, the position of the argument pointer is not known until
3743 the compilation is completed. In such a case, a separate hard register
3744 must be used for the argument pointer. This register can be eliminated by
3745 replacing it with either the frame pointer or the argument pointer,
3746 depending on whether or not the frame pointer has been eliminated.
3747
3748 In this case, you might specify:
3749 @smallexample
3750 #define ELIMINABLE_REGS \
3751 @{@{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3752 @{ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM@}, \
3753 @{FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, STACK_POINTER_REGNUM@}@}
3754 @end smallexample
3755
3756 Note that the elimination of the argument pointer with the stack pointer is
3757 specified first since that is the preferred elimination.
3758 @end defmac
3759
3760 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_ELIMINATE (const int @var{from_reg}, const int @var{to_reg})
3761 This target hook should return @code{true} if the compiler is allowed to
3762 try to replace register number @var{from_reg} with register number
3763 @var{to_reg}. This target hook will usually be @code{true}, since most of the
3764 cases preventing register elimination are things that the compiler already
3765 knows about.
3766
3767 Default return value is @code{true}.
3768 @end deftypefn
3769
3770 @defmac INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET (@var{from-reg}, @var{to-reg}, @var{offset-var})
3771 This macro returns the initial difference between the specified pair
3772 of registers. The value would be computed from information
3773 such as the result of @code{get_frame_size ()} and the tables of
3774 registers @code{df_regs_ever_live_p} and @code{call_used_regs}.
3775 @end defmac
3776
3777 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_COMPUTE_FRAME_LAYOUT (void)
3778 This target hook is called once each time the frame layout needs to be
3779 recalculated. The calculations can be cached by the target and can then
3780 be used by @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET} instead of re-computing the
3781 layout on every invocation of that hook. This is particularly useful
3782 for targets that have an expensive frame layout function. Implementing
3783 this callback is optional.
3784 @end deftypefn
3785
3786 @node Stack Arguments
3787 @subsection Passing Function Arguments on the Stack
3788 @cindex arguments on stack
3789 @cindex stack arguments
3790
3791 The macros in this section control how arguments are passed
3792 on the stack. See the following section for other macros that
3793 control passing certain arguments in registers.
3794
3795 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROMOTE_PROTOTYPES (const_tree @var{fntype})
3796 This target hook returns @code{true} if an argument declared in a
3797 prototype as an integral type smaller than @code{int} should actually be
3798 passed as an @code{int}. In addition to avoiding errors in certain
3799 cases of mismatch, it also makes for better code on certain machines.
3800 The default is to not promote prototypes.
3801 @end deftypefn
3802
3803 @defmac PUSH_ARGS
3804 A C expression. If nonzero, push insns will be used to pass
3805 outgoing arguments.
3806 If the target machine does not have a push instruction, set it to zero.
3807 That directs GCC to use an alternate strategy: to
3808 allocate the entire argument block and then store the arguments into
3809 it. When @code{PUSH_ARGS} is nonzero, @code{PUSH_ROUNDING} must be defined too.
3810 @end defmac
3811
3812 @defmac PUSH_ARGS_REVERSED
3813 A C expression. If nonzero, function arguments will be evaluated from
3814 last to first, rather than from first to last. If this macro is not
3815 defined, it defaults to @code{PUSH_ARGS} on targets where the stack
3816 and args grow in opposite directions, and 0 otherwise.
3817 @end defmac
3818
3819 @defmac PUSH_ROUNDING (@var{npushed})
3820 A C expression that is the number of bytes actually pushed onto the
3821 stack when an instruction attempts to push @var{npushed} bytes.
3822
3823 On some machines, the definition
3824
3825 @smallexample
3826 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (BYTES)
3827 @end smallexample
3828
3829 @noindent
3830 will suffice. But on other machines, instructions that appear
3831 to push one byte actually push two bytes in an attempt to maintain
3832 alignment. Then the definition should be
3833
3834 @smallexample
3835 #define PUSH_ROUNDING(BYTES) (((BYTES) + 1) & ~1)
3836 @end smallexample
3837
3838 If the value of this macro has a type, it should be an unsigned type.
3839 @end defmac
3840
3841 @findex outgoing_args_size
3842 @findex crtl->outgoing_args_size
3843 @defmac ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS
3844 A C expression. If nonzero, the maximum amount of space required for outgoing arguments
3845 will be computed and placed into
3846 @code{crtl->outgoing_args_size}. No space will be pushed
3847 onto the stack for each call; instead, the function prologue should
3848 increase the stack frame size by this amount.
3849
3850 Setting both @code{PUSH_ARGS} and @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS}
3851 is not proper.
3852 @end defmac
3853
3854 @defmac REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3855 Define this macro if functions should assume that stack space has been
3856 allocated for arguments even when their values are passed in
3857 registers.
3858
3859 The value of this macro is the size, in bytes, of the area reserved for
3860 arguments passed in registers for the function represented by @var{fndecl},
3861 which can be zero if GCC is calling a library function.
3862 The argument @var{fndecl} can be the FUNCTION_DECL, or the type itself
3863 of the function.
3864
3865 This space can be allocated by the caller, or be a part of the
3866 machine-dependent stack frame: @code{OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} says
3867 which.
3868 @end defmac
3869 @c above is overfull. not sure what to do. --mew 5feb93 did
3870 @c something, not sure if it looks good. --mew 10feb93
3871
3872 @defmac INCOMING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fndecl})
3873 Like @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, but for incoming register arguments.
3874 Define this macro if space guaranteed when compiling a function body
3875 is different to space required when making a call, a situation that
3876 can arise with K&R style function definitions.
3877 @end defmac
3878
3879 @defmac OUTGOING_REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE (@var{fntype})
3880 Define this to a nonzero value if it is the responsibility of the
3881 caller to allocate the area reserved for arguments passed in registers
3882 when calling a function of @var{fntype}. @var{fntype} may be NULL
3883 if the function called is a library function.
3884
3885 If @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, this macro controls
3886 whether the space for these arguments counts in the value of
3887 @code{crtl->outgoing_args_size}.
3888 @end defmac
3889
3890 @defmac STACK_PARMS_IN_REG_PARM_AREA
3891 Define this macro if @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is defined, but the
3892 stack parameters don't skip the area specified by it.
3893 @c i changed this, makes more sens and it should have taken care of the
3894 @c overfull.. not as specific, tho. --mew 5feb93
3895
3896 Normally, when a parameter is not passed in registers, it is placed on the
3897 stack beyond the @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} area. Defining this macro
3898 suppresses this behavior and causes the parameter to be passed on the
3899 stack in its natural location.
3900 @end defmac
3901
3902 @deftypefn {Target Hook} poly_int64 TARGET_RETURN_POPS_ARGS (tree @var{fundecl}, tree @var{funtype}, poly_int64 @var{size})
3903 This target hook returns the number of bytes of its own arguments that
3904 a function pops on returning, or 0 if the function pops no arguments
3905 and the caller must therefore pop them all after the function returns.
3906
3907 @var{fundecl} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that describes
3908 the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3909 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} that describes the declaration of the function.
3910 From this you can obtain the @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of the function.
3911
3912 @var{funtype} is a C variable whose value is a tree node that
3913 describes the function in question. Normally it is a node of type
3914 @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} that describes the data type of the function.
3915 From this it is possible to obtain the data types of the value and
3916 arguments (if known).
3917
3918 When a call to a library function is being considered, @var{fundecl}
3919 will contain an identifier node for the library function. Thus, if
3920 you need to distinguish among various library functions, you can do so
3921 by their names. Note that ``library function'' in this context means
3922 a function used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known specially
3923 in the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being compiled.
3924
3925 @var{size} is the number of bytes of arguments passed on the
3926 stack. If a variable number of bytes is passed, it is zero, and
3927 argument popping will always be the responsibility of the calling function.
3928
3929 On the VAX, all functions always pop their arguments, so the definition
3930 of this macro is @var{size}. On the 68000, using the standard
3931 calling convention, no functions pop their arguments, so the value of
3932 the macro is always 0 in this case. But an alternative calling
3933 convention is available in which functions that take a fixed number of
3934 arguments pop them but other functions (such as @code{printf}) pop
3935 nothing (the caller pops all). When this convention is in use,
3936 @var{funtype} is examined to determine whether a function takes a fixed
3937 number of arguments.
3938 @end deftypefn
3939
3940 @defmac CALL_POPS_ARGS (@var{cum})
3941 A C expression that should indicate the number of bytes a call sequence
3942 pops off the stack. It is added to the value of @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS}
3943 when compiling a function call.
3944
3945 @var{cum} is the variable in which all arguments to the called function
3946 have been accumulated.
3947
3948 On certain architectures, such as the SH5, a call trampoline is used
3949 that pops certain registers off the stack, depending on the arguments
3950 that have been passed to the function. Since this is a property of the
3951 call site, not of the called function, @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} is not
3952 appropriate.
3953 @end defmac
3954
3955 @node Register Arguments
3956 @subsection Passing Arguments in Registers
3957 @cindex arguments in registers
3958 @cindex registers arguments
3959
3960 This section describes the macros which let you control how various
3961 types of arguments are passed in registers or how they are arranged in
3962 the stack.
3963
3964 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
3965 Return an RTX indicating whether a function argument is passed in a
3966 register and if so, which register.
3967
3968 The arguments are @var{ca}, which summarizes all the previous
3969 arguments; @var{mode}, the machine mode of the argument; @var{type},
3970 the data type of the argument as a tree node or 0 if that is not known
3971 (which happens for C support library functions); and @var{named},
3972 which is @code{true} for an ordinary argument and @code{false} for
3973 nameless arguments that correspond to @samp{@dots{}} in the called
3974 function's prototype. @var{type} can be an incomplete type if a
3975 syntax error has previously occurred.
3976
3977 The return value is usually either a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3978 register in which to pass the argument, or zero to pass the argument
3979 on the stack.
3980
3981 The return value can be a @code{const_int} which means argument is
3982 passed in a target specific slot with specified number. Target hooks
3983 should be used to store or load argument in such case. See
3984 @code{TARGET_STORE_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG} and @code{TARGET_LOAD_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG}
3985 for more information.
3986
3987 The value of the expression can also be a @code{parallel} RTX@. This is
3988 used when an argument is passed in multiple locations. The mode of the
3989 @code{parallel} should be the mode of the entire argument. The
3990 @code{parallel} holds any number of @code{expr_list} pairs; each one
3991 describes where part of the argument is passed. In each
3992 @code{expr_list} the first operand must be a @code{reg} RTX for the hard
3993 register in which to pass this part of the argument, and the mode of the
3994 register RTX indicates how large this part of the argument is. The
3995 second operand of the @code{expr_list} is a @code{const_int} which gives
3996 the offset in bytes into the entire argument of where this part starts.
3997 As a special exception the first @code{expr_list} in the @code{parallel}
3998 RTX may have a first operand of zero. This indicates that the entire
3999 argument is also stored on the stack.
4000
4001 The last time this hook is called, it is called with @code{MODE ==
4002 VOIDmode}, and its result is passed to the @code{call} or @code{call_value}
4003 pattern as operands 2 and 3 respectively.
4004
4005 @cindex @file{stdarg.h} and register arguments
4006 The usual way to make the ISO library @file{stdarg.h} work on a
4007 machine where some arguments are usually passed in registers, is to
4008 cause nameless arguments to be passed on the stack instead. This is
4009 done by making @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} return 0 whenever
4010 @var{named} is @code{false}.
4011
4012 @cindex @code{TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
4013 @cindex @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}, and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
4014 You may use the hook @code{targetm.calls.must_pass_in_stack}
4015 in the definition of this macro to determine if this argument is of a
4016 type that must be passed in the stack. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE}
4017 is not defined and @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} returns nonzero for such an
4018 argument, the compiler will abort. If @code{REG_PARM_STACK_SPACE} is
4019 defined, the argument will be computed in the stack and then loaded into
4020 a register.
4021 @end deftypefn
4022
4023 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MUST_PASS_IN_STACK (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4024 This target hook should return @code{true} if we should not pass @var{type}
4025 solely in registers. The file @file{expr.h} defines a
4026 definition that is usually appropriate, refer to @file{expr.h} for additional
4027 documentation.
4028 @end deftypefn
4029
4030 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4031 Define this hook if the caller and callee on the target have different
4032 views of where arguments are passed. Also define this hook if there are
4033 functions that are never directly called, but are invoked by the hardware
4034 and which have nonstandard calling conventions.
4035
4036 In this case @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} computes the register in
4037 which the caller passes the value, and
4038 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} should be defined in a similar
4039 fashion to tell the function being called where the arguments will
4040 arrive.
4041
4042 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} can also return arbitrary address
4043 computation using hard register, which can be forced into a register,
4044 so that it can be used to pass special arguments.
4045
4046 If @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG} is not defined,
4047 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} serves both purposes.
4048 @end deftypefn
4049
4050 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_PSEUDO_PIC_REG (void)
4051 This hook should return 1 in case pseudo register should be created
4052 for pic_offset_table_rtx during function expand.
4053 @end deftypefn
4054
4055 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_PIC_REG (void)
4056 Perform a target dependent initialization of pic_offset_table_rtx.
4057 This hook is called at the start of register allocation.
4058 @end deftypefn
4059
4060 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ARG_PARTIAL_BYTES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4061 This target hook returns the number of bytes at the beginning of an
4062 argument that must be put in registers. The value must be zero for
4063 arguments that are passed entirely in registers or that are entirely
4064 pushed on the stack.
4065
4066 On some machines, certain arguments must be passed partially in
4067 registers and partially in memory. On these machines, typically the
4068 first few words of arguments are passed in registers, and the rest
4069 on the stack. If a multi-word argument (a @code{double} or a
4070 structure) crosses that boundary, its first few words must be passed
4071 in registers and the rest must be pushed. This macro tells the
4072 compiler when this occurs, and how many bytes should go in registers.
4073
4074 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for these arguments should return the first
4075 register to be used by the caller for this argument; likewise
4076 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_INCOMING_ARG}, for the called function.
4077 @end deftypefn
4078
4079 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PASS_BY_REFERENCE (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4080 This target hook should return @code{true} if an argument at the
4081 position indicated by @var{cum} should be passed by reference. This
4082 predicate is queried after target independent reasons for being
4083 passed by reference, such as @code{TREE_ADDRESSABLE (type)}.
4084
4085 If the hook returns true, a copy of that argument is made in memory and a
4086 pointer to the argument is passed instead of the argument itself.
4087 The pointer is passed in whatever way is appropriate for passing a pointer
4088 to that type.
4089 @end deftypefn
4090
4091 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CALLEE_COPIES (cumulative_args_t @var{cum}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4092 The function argument described by the parameters to this hook is
4093 known to be passed by reference. The hook should return true if the
4094 function argument should be copied by the callee instead of copied
4095 by the caller.
4096
4097 For any argument for which the hook returns true, if it can be
4098 determined that the argument is not modified, then a copy need
4099 not be generated.
4100
4101 The default version of this hook always returns false.
4102 @end deftypefn
4103
4104 @defmac CUMULATIVE_ARGS
4105 A C type for declaring a variable that is used as the first argument
4106 of @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} and other related values. For some
4107 target machines, the type @code{int} suffices and can hold the number
4108 of bytes of argument so far.
4109
4110 There is no need to record in @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} anything about the
4111 arguments that have been passed on the stack. The compiler has other
4112 variables to keep track of that. For target machines on which all
4113 arguments are passed on the stack, there is no need to store anything in
4114 @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}; however, the data structure must exist and
4115 should not be empty, so use @code{int}.
4116 @end defmac
4117
4118 @defmac OVERRIDE_ABI_FORMAT (@var{fndecl})
4119 If defined, this macro is called before generating any code for a
4120 function, but after the @var{cfun} descriptor for the function has been
4121 created. The back end may use this macro to update @var{cfun} to
4122 reflect an ABI other than that which would normally be used by default.
4123 If the compiler is generating code for a compiler-generated function,
4124 @var{fndecl} may be @code{NULL}.
4125 @end defmac
4126
4127 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname}, @var{fndecl}, @var{n_named_args})
4128 A C statement (sans semicolon) for initializing the variable
4129 @var{cum} for the state at the beginning of the argument list. The
4130 variable has type @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS}. The value of @var{fntype}
4131 is the tree node for the data type of the function which will receive
4132 the args, or 0 if the args are to a compiler support library function.
4133 For direct calls that are not libcalls, @var{fndecl} contain the
4134 declaration node of the function. @var{fndecl} is also set when
4135 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used to find arguments for the function
4136 being compiled. @var{n_named_args} is set to the number of named
4137 arguments, including a structure return address if it is passed as a
4138 parameter, when making a call. When processing incoming arguments,
4139 @var{n_named_args} is set to @minus{}1.
4140
4141 When processing a call to a compiler support library function,
4142 @var{libname} identifies which one. It is a @code{symbol_ref} rtx which
4143 contains the name of the function, as a string. @var{libname} is 0 when
4144 an ordinary C function call is being processed. Thus, each time this
4145 macro is called, either @var{libname} or @var{fntype} is nonzero, but
4146 never both of them at once.
4147 @end defmac
4148
4149 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_LIBCALL_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{mode}, @var{libname})
4150 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but only used for outgoing libcalls,
4151 it gets a @code{MODE} argument instead of @var{fntype}, that would be
4152 @code{NULL}. @var{indirect} would always be zero, too. If this macro
4153 is not defined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS (cum, NULL_RTX, libname,
4154 0)} is used instead.
4155 @end defmac
4156
4157 @defmac INIT_CUMULATIVE_INCOMING_ARGS (@var{cum}, @var{fntype}, @var{libname})
4158 Like @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} but overrides it for the purposes of
4159 finding the arguments for the function being compiled. If this macro is
4160 undefined, @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS} is used instead.
4161
4162 The value passed for @var{libname} is always 0, since library routines
4163 with special calling conventions are never compiled with GCC@. The
4164 argument @var{libname} exists for symmetry with
4165 @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}.
4166 @c could use "this macro" in place of @code{INIT_CUMULATIVE_ARGS}, maybe.
4167 @c --mew 5feb93 i switched the order of the sentences. --mew 10feb93
4168 @end defmac
4169
4170 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ADVANCE (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{named})
4171 This hook updates the summarizer variable pointed to by @var{ca} to
4172 advance past an argument in the argument list. The values @var{mode},
4173 @var{type} and @var{named} describe that argument. Once this is done,
4174 the variable @var{cum} is suitable for analyzing the @emph{following}
4175 argument with @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}, etc.
4176
4177 This hook need not do anything if the argument in question was passed
4178 on the stack. The compiler knows how to track the amount of stack space
4179 used for arguments without any special help.
4180 @end deftypefn
4181
4182 @deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_OFFSET (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4183 This hook returns the number of bytes to add to the offset of an
4184 argument of type @var{type} and mode @var{mode} when passed in memory.
4185 This is needed for the SPU, which passes @code{char} and @code{short}
4186 arguments in the preferred slot that is in the middle of the quad word
4187 instead of starting at the top. The default implementation returns 0.
4188 @end deftypefn
4189
4190 @deftypefn {Target Hook} pad_direction TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_PADDING (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4191 This hook determines whether, and in which direction, to pad out
4192 an argument of mode @var{mode} and type @var{type}. It returns
4193 @code{PAD_UPWARD} to insert padding above the argument, @code{PAD_DOWNWARD}
4194 to insert padding below the argument, or @code{PAD_NONE} to inhibit padding.
4195
4196 The @emph{amount} of padding is not controlled by this hook, but by
4197 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY}. It is always just enough
4198 to reach the next multiple of that boundary.
4199
4200 This hook has a default definition that is right for most systems.
4201 For little-endian machines, the default is to pad upward. For
4202 big-endian machines, the default is to pad downward for an argument of
4203 constant size shorter than an @code{int}, and upward otherwise.
4204 @end deftypefn
4205
4206 @defmac PAD_VARARGS_DOWN
4207 If defined, a C expression which determines whether the default
4208 implementation of va_arg will attempt to pad down before reading the
4209 next argument, if that argument is smaller than its aligned space as
4210 controlled by @code{PARM_BOUNDARY}. If this macro is not defined, all such
4211 arguments are padded down if @code{BYTES_BIG_ENDIAN} is true.
4212 @end defmac
4213
4214 @defmac BLOCK_REG_PADDING (@var{mode}, @var{type}, @var{first})
4215 Specify padding for the last element of a block move between registers and
4216 memory. @var{first} is nonzero if this is the only element. Defining this
4217 macro allows better control of register function parameters on big-endian
4218 machines, without using @code{PARALLEL} rtl. In particular,
4219 @code{MUST_PASS_IN_STACK} need not test padding and mode of types in
4220 registers, as there is no longer a "wrong" part of a register; For example,
4221 a three byte aggregate may be passed in the high part of a register if so
4222 required.
4223 @end defmac
4224
4225 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_BOUNDARY (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4226 This hook returns the alignment boundary, in bits, of an argument
4227 with the specified mode and type. The default hook returns
4228 @code{PARM_BOUNDARY} for all arguments.
4229 @end deftypefn
4230
4231 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG_ROUND_BOUNDARY (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type})
4232 Normally, the size of an argument is rounded up to @code{PARM_BOUNDARY},
4233 which is the default value for this hook. You can define this hook to
4234 return a different value if an argument size must be rounded to a larger
4235 value.
4236 @end deftypefn
4237
4238 @defmac FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4239 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4240 register in which function arguments are sometimes passed. This does
4241 @emph{not} include implicit arguments such as the static chain and
4242 the structure-value address. On many machines, no registers can be
4243 used for this purpose since all function arguments are pushed on the
4244 stack.
4245 @end defmac
4246
4247 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SPLIT_COMPLEX_ARG (const_tree @var{type})
4248 This hook should return true if parameter of type @var{type} are passed
4249 as two scalar parameters. By default, GCC will attempt to pack complex
4250 arguments into the target's word size. Some ABIs require complex arguments
4251 to be split and treated as their individual components. For example, on
4252 AIX64, complex floats should be passed in a pair of floating point
4253 registers, even though a complex float would fit in one 64-bit floating
4254 point register.
4255
4256 The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which is treated as always
4257 false.
4258 @end deftypefn
4259
4260 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILD_BUILTIN_VA_LIST (void)
4261 This hook returns a type node for @code{va_list} for the target.
4262 The default version of the hook returns @code{void*}.
4263 @end deftypefn
4264
4265 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ENUM_VA_LIST_P (int @var{idx}, const char **@var{pname}, tree *@var{ptree})
4266 This target hook is used in function @code{c_common_nodes_and_builtins}
4267 to iterate through the target specific builtin types for va_list. The
4268 variable @var{idx} is used as iterator. @var{pname} has to be a pointer
4269 to a @code{const char *} and @var{ptree} a pointer to a @code{tree} typed
4270 variable.
4271 The arguments @var{pname} and @var{ptree} are used to store the result of
4272 this macro and are set to the name of the va_list builtin type and its
4273 internal type.
4274 If the return value of this macro is zero, then there is no more element.
4275 Otherwise the @var{IDX} should be increased for the next call of this
4276 macro to iterate through all types.
4277 @end deftypefn
4278
4279 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FN_ABI_VA_LIST (tree @var{fndecl})
4280 This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by
4281 @var{fndecl}.
4282 The default version of this hook returns @code{va_list_type_node}.
4283 @end deftypefn
4284
4285 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CANONICAL_VA_LIST_TYPE (tree @var{type})
4286 This hook returns the va_list type of the calling convention specified by the
4287 type of @var{type}. If @var{type} is not a valid va_list type, it returns
4288 @code{NULL_TREE}.
4289 @end deftypefn
4290
4291 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GIMPLIFY_VA_ARG_EXPR (tree @var{valist}, tree @var{type}, gimple_seq *@var{pre_p}, gimple_seq *@var{post_p})
4292 This hook performs target-specific gimplification of
4293 @code{VA_ARG_EXPR}. The first two parameters correspond to the
4294 arguments to @code{va_arg}; the latter two are as in
4295 @code{gimplify.c:gimplify_expr}.
4296 @end deftypefn
4297
4298 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE (scalar_int_mode @var{mode})
4299 Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
4300 with machine mode @var{mode}. The default version of this
4301 hook returns true for both @code{ptr_mode} and @code{Pmode}.
4302 @end deftypefn
4303
4304 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_REF_MAY_ALIAS_ERRNO (struct ao_ref *@var{ref})
4305 Define this to return nonzero if the memory reference @var{ref} may alias with the system C library errno location. The default version of this hook assumes the system C library errno location is either a declaration of type int or accessed by dereferencing a pointer to int.
4306 @end deftypefn
4307
4308 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_TRANSLATE_MODE_ATTRIBUTE (machine_mode @var{mode})
4309 Define this hook if during mode attribute processing, the port should
4310 translate machine_mode @var{mode} to another mode. For example, rs6000's
4311 @code{KFmode}, when it is the same as @code{TFmode}.
4312
4313 The default version of the hook returns that mode that was passed in.
4314 @end deftypefn
4315
4316 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (scalar_mode @var{mode})
4317 Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4318 insns involving scalar mode @var{mode}. For a scalar mode to be
4319 considered supported, all the basic arithmetic and comparisons
4320 must work.
4321
4322 The default version of this hook returns true for any mode
4323 required to handle the basic C types (as defined by the port).
4324 Included here are the double-word arithmetic supported by the
4325 code in @file{optabs.c}.
4326 @end deftypefn
4327
4328 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTOR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (machine_mode @var{mode})
4329 Define this to return nonzero if the port is prepared to handle
4330 insns involving vector mode @var{mode}. At the very least, it
4331 must have move patterns for this mode.
4332 @end deftypefn
4333
4334 @deftypefn {Target Hook} opt_machine_mode TARGET_ARRAY_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{nelems})
4335 Return the mode that GCC should use for an array that has
4336 @var{nelems} elements, with each element having mode @var{mode}.
4337 Return no mode if the target has no special requirements. In the
4338 latter case, GCC looks for an integer mode of the appropriate size
4339 if available and uses BLKmode otherwise. Usually the search for the
4340 integer mode is limited to @code{MAX_FIXED_MODE_SIZE}, but the
4341 @code{TARGET_ARRAY_MODE_SUPPORTED_P} hook allows a larger mode to be
4342 used in specific cases.
4343
4344 The main use of this hook is to specify that an array of vectors should
4345 also have a vector mode. The default implementation returns no mode.
4346 @end deftypefn
4347
4348 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARRAY_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{nelems})
4349 Return true if GCC should try to use a scalar mode to store an array
4350 of @var{nelems} elements, given that each element has mode @var{mode}.
4351 Returning true here overrides the usual @code{MAX_FIXED_MODE} limit
4352 and allows GCC to use any defined integer mode.
4353
4354 One use of this hook is to support vector load and store operations
4355 that operate on several homogeneous vectors. For example, ARM NEON
4356 has operations like:
4357
4358 @smallexample
4359 int8x8x3_t vld3_s8 (const int8_t *)
4360 @end smallexample
4361
4362 where the return type is defined as:
4363
4364 @smallexample
4365 typedef struct int8x8x3_t
4366 @{
4367 int8x8_t val[3];
4368 @} int8x8x3_t;
4369 @end smallexample
4370
4371 If this hook allows @code{val} to have a scalar mode, then
4372 @code{int8x8x3_t} can have the same mode. GCC can then store
4373 @code{int8x8x3_t}s in registers rather than forcing them onto the stack.
4374 @end deftypefn
4375
4376 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBGCC_FLOATING_MODE_SUPPORTED_P (scalar_float_mode @var{mode})
4377 Define this to return nonzero if libgcc provides support for the
4378 floating-point mode @var{mode}, which is known to pass
4379 @code{TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P}. The default version of this
4380 hook returns true for all of @code{SFmode}, @code{DFmode},
4381 @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode}, if such modes exist.
4382 @end deftypefn
4383
4384 @deftypefn {Target Hook} opt_scalar_float_mode TARGET_FLOATN_MODE (int @var{n}, bool @var{extended})
4385 Define this to return the machine mode to use for the type
4386 @code{_Float@var{n}}, if @var{extended} is false, or the type
4387 @code{_Float@var{n}x}, if @var{extended} is true. If such a type is not
4388 supported, return @code{opt_scalar_float_mode ()}. The default version of
4389 this hook returns @code{SFmode} for @code{_Float32}, @code{DFmode} for
4390 @code{_Float64} and @code{_Float32x} and @code{TFmode} for
4391 @code{_Float128}, if those modes exist and satisfy the requirements for
4392 those types and pass @code{TARGET_SCALAR_MODE_SUPPORTED_P} and
4393 @code{TARGET_LIBGCC_FLOATING_MODE_SUPPORTED_P}; for @code{_Float64x}, it
4394 returns the first of @code{XFmode} and @code{TFmode} that exists and
4395 satisfies the same requirements; for other types, it returns
4396 @code{opt_scalar_float_mode ()}. The hook is only called for values
4397 of @var{n} and @var{extended} that are valid according to
4398 ISO/IEC TS 18661-3:2015; that is, @var{n} is one of 32, 64, 128, or,
4399 if @var{extended} is false, 16 or greater than 128 and a multiple of 32.
4400 @end deftypefn
4401
4402 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FLOATN_BUILTIN_P (int @var{func})
4403 Define this to return true if the @code{_Float@var{n}} and
4404 @code{_Float@var{n}x} built-in functions should implicitly enable the
4405 built-in function without the @code{__builtin_} prefix in addition to the
4406 normal built-in function with the @code{__builtin_} prefix. The default is
4407 to only enable built-in functions without the @code{__builtin_} prefix for
4408 the GNU C langauge. In strict ANSI/ISO mode, the built-in function without
4409 the @code{__builtin_} prefix is not enabled. The argument @code{FUNC} is the
4410 @code{enum built_in_function} id of the function to be enabled.
4411 @end deftypefn
4412
4413 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SMALL_REGISTER_CLASSES_FOR_MODE_P (machine_mode @var{mode})
4414 Define this to return nonzero for machine modes for which the port has
4415 small register classes. If this target hook returns nonzero for a given
4416 @var{mode}, the compiler will try to minimize the lifetime of registers
4417 in @var{mode}. The hook may be called with @code{VOIDmode} as argument.
4418 In this case, the hook is expected to return nonzero if it returns nonzero
4419 for any mode.
4420
4421 On some machines, it is risky to let hard registers live across arbitrary
4422 insns. Typically, these machines have instructions that require values
4423 to be in specific registers (like an accumulator), and reload will fail
4424 if the required hard register is used for another purpose across such an
4425 insn.
4426
4427 Passes before reload do not know which hard registers will be used
4428 in an instruction, but the machine modes of the registers set or used in
4429 the instruction are already known. And for some machines, register
4430 classes are small for, say, integer registers but not for floating point
4431 registers. For example, the AMD x86-64 architecture requires specific
4432 registers for the legacy x86 integer instructions, but there are many
4433 SSE registers for floating point operations. On such targets, a good
4434 strategy may be to return nonzero from this hook for @code{INTEGRAL_MODE_P}
4435 machine modes but zero for the SSE register classes.
4436
4437 The default version of this hook returns false for any mode. It is always
4438 safe to redefine this hook to return with a nonzero value. But if you
4439 unnecessarily define it, you will reduce the amount of optimizations
4440 that can be performed in some cases. If you do not define this hook
4441 to return a nonzero value when it is required, the compiler will run out
4442 of spill registers and print a fatal error message.
4443 @end deftypefn
4444
4445 @node Scalar Return
4446 @subsection How Scalar Function Values Are Returned
4447 @cindex return values in registers
4448 @cindex values, returned by functions
4449 @cindex scalars, returned as values
4450
4451 This section discusses the macros that control returning scalars as
4452 values---values that can fit in registers.
4453
4454 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE (const_tree @var{ret_type}, const_tree @var{fn_decl_or_type}, bool @var{outgoing})
4455
4456 Define this to return an RTX representing the place where a function
4457 returns or receives a value of data type @var{ret_type}, a tree node
4458 representing a data type. @var{fn_decl_or_type} is a tree node
4459 representing @code{FUNCTION_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_TYPE} of a
4460 function being called. If @var{outgoing} is false, the hook should
4461 compute the register in which the caller will see the return value.
4462 Otherwise, the hook should return an RTX representing the place where
4463 a function returns a value.
4464
4465 On many machines, only @code{TYPE_MODE (@var{ret_type})} is relevant.
4466 (Actually, on most machines, scalar values are returned in the same
4467 place regardless of mode.) The value of the expression is usually a
4468 @code{reg} RTX for the hard register where the return value is stored.
4469 The value can also be a @code{parallel} RTX, if the return value is in
4470 multiple places. See @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} for an explanation of the
4471 @code{parallel} form. Note that the callee will populate every
4472 location specified in the @code{parallel}, but if the first element of
4473 the @code{parallel} contains the whole return value, callers will use
4474 that element as the canonical location and ignore the others. The m68k
4475 port uses this type of @code{parallel} to return pointers in both
4476 @samp{%a0} (the canonical location) and @samp{%d0}.
4477
4478 If @code{TARGET_PROMOTE_FUNCTION_RETURN} returns true, you must apply
4479 the same promotion rules specified in @code{PROMOTE_MODE} if
4480 @var{valtype} is a scalar type.
4481
4482 If the precise function being called is known, @var{func} is a tree
4483 node (@code{FUNCTION_DECL}) for it; otherwise, @var{func} is a null
4484 pointer. This makes it possible to use a different value-returning
4485 convention for specific functions when all their calls are
4486 known.
4487
4488 Some target machines have ``register windows'' so that the register in
4489 which a function returns its value is not the same as the one in which
4490 the caller sees the value. For such machines, you should return
4491 different RTX depending on @var{outgoing}.
4492
4493 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} is not used for return values with
4494 aggregate data types, because these are returned in another way. See
4495 @code{TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX} and related macros, below.
4496 @end deftypefn
4497
4498 @defmac FUNCTION_VALUE (@var{valtype}, @var{func})
4499 This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} for
4500 a new target instead.
4501 @end defmac
4502
4503 @defmac LIBCALL_VALUE (@var{mode})
4504 A C expression to create an RTX representing the place where a library
4505 function returns a value of mode @var{mode}.
4506
4507 Note that ``library function'' in this context means a compiler
4508 support routine, used to perform arithmetic, whose name is known
4509 specially by the compiler and was not mentioned in the C code being
4510 compiled.
4511 @end defmac
4512
4513 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LIBCALL_VALUE (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{fun})
4514 Define this hook if the back-end needs to know the name of the libcall
4515 function in order to determine where the result should be returned.
4516
4517 The mode of the result is given by @var{mode} and the name of the called
4518 library function is given by @var{fun}. The hook should return an RTX
4519 representing the place where the library function result will be returned.
4520
4521 If this hook is not defined, then LIBCALL_VALUE will be used.
4522 @end deftypefn
4523
4524 @defmac FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (@var{regno})
4525 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4526 register in which the values of called function may come back.
4527
4528 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4529 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4530 recognized by this macro. So for most machines, this definition
4531 suffices:
4532
4533 @smallexample
4534 #define FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P(N) ((N) == 0)
4535 @end smallexample
4536
4537 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4538 function use different registers for the return value, this macro
4539 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4540
4541 This macro has been deprecated. Use @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P}
4542 for a new target instead.
4543 @end defmac
4544
4545 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P (const unsigned int @var{regno})
4546 A target hook that return @code{true} if @var{regno} is the number of a hard
4547 register in which the values of called function may come back.
4548
4549 A register whose use for returning values is limited to serving as the
4550 second of a pair (for a value of type @code{double}, say) need not be
4551 recognized by this target hook.
4552
4553 If the machine has register windows, so that the caller and the called
4554 function use different registers for the return value, this target hook
4555 should recognize only the caller's register numbers.
4556
4557 If this hook is not defined, then FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P will be used.
4558 @end deftypefn
4559
4560 @defmac APPLY_RESULT_SIZE
4561 Define this macro if @samp{untyped_call} and @samp{untyped_return}
4562 need more space than is implied by @code{FUNCTION_VALUE_REGNO_P} for
4563 saving and restoring an arbitrary return value.
4564 @end defmac
4565
4566 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OMIT_STRUCT_RETURN_REG
4567 Normally, when a function returns a structure by memory, the address
4568 is passed as an invisible pointer argument, but the compiler also
4569 arranges to return the address from the function like it would a normal
4570 pointer return value. Define this to true if that behavior is
4571 undesirable on your target.
4572 @end deftypevr
4573
4574 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MSB (const_tree @var{type})
4575 This hook should return true if values of type @var{type} are returned
4576 at the most significant end of a register (in other words, if they are
4577 padded at the least significant end). You can assume that @var{type}
4578 is returned in a register; the caller is required to check this.
4579
4580 Note that the register provided by @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} must
4581 be able to hold the complete return value. For example, if a 1-, 2-
4582 or 3-byte structure is returned at the most significant end of a
4583 4-byte register, @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} should provide an
4584 @code{SImode} rtx.
4585 @end deftypefn
4586
4587 @node Aggregate Return
4588 @subsection How Large Values Are Returned
4589 @cindex aggregates as return values
4590 @cindex large return values
4591 @cindex returning aggregate values
4592 @cindex structure value address
4593
4594 When a function value's mode is @code{BLKmode} (and in some other
4595 cases), the value is not returned according to
4596 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_VALUE} (@pxref{Scalar Return}). Instead, the
4597 caller passes the address of a block of memory in which the value
4598 should be stored. This address is called the @dfn{structure value
4599 address}.
4600
4601 This section describes how to control returning structure values in
4602 memory.
4603
4604 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY (const_tree @var{type}, const_tree @var{fntype})
4605 This target hook should return a nonzero value to say to return the
4606 function value in memory, just as large structures are always returned.
4607 Here @var{type} will be the data type of the value, and @var{fntype}
4608 will be the type of the function doing the returning, or @code{NULL} for
4609 libcalls.
4610
4611 Note that values of mode @code{BLKmode} must be explicitly handled
4612 by this function. Also, the option @option{-fpcc-struct-return}
4613 takes effect regardless of this macro. On most systems, it is
4614 possible to leave the hook undefined; this causes a default
4615 definition to be used, whose value is the constant 1 for @code{BLKmode}
4616 values, and 0 otherwise.
4617
4618 Do not use this hook to indicate that structures and unions should always
4619 be returned in memory. You should instead use @code{DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN}
4620 to indicate this.
4621 @end deftypefn
4622
4623 @defmac DEFAULT_PCC_STRUCT_RETURN
4624 Define this macro to be 1 if all structure and union return values must be
4625 in memory. Since this results in slower code, this should be defined
4626 only if needed for compatibility with other compilers or with an ABI@.
4627 If you define this macro to be 0, then the conventions used for structure
4628 and union return values are decided by the @code{TARGET_RETURN_IN_MEMORY}
4629 target hook.
4630
4631 If not defined, this defaults to the value 1.
4632 @end defmac
4633
4634 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{incoming})
4635 This target hook should return the location of the structure value
4636 address (normally a @code{mem} or @code{reg}), or 0 if the address is
4637 passed as an ``invisible'' first argument. Note that @var{fndecl} may
4638 be @code{NULL}, for libcalls. You do not need to define this target
4639 hook if the address is always passed as an ``invisible'' first
4640 argument.
4641
4642 On some architectures the place where the structure value address
4643 is found by the called function is not the same place that the
4644 caller put it. This can be due to register windows, or it could
4645 be because the function prologue moves it to a different place.
4646 @var{incoming} is @code{1} or @code{2} when the location is needed in
4647 the context of the called function, and @code{0} in the context of
4648 the caller.
4649
4650 If @var{incoming} is nonzero and the address is to be found on the
4651 stack, return a @code{mem} which refers to the frame pointer. If
4652 @var{incoming} is @code{2}, the result is being used to fetch the
4653 structure value address at the beginning of a function. If you need
4654 to emit adjusting code, you should do it at this point.
4655 @end deftypefn
4656
4657 @defmac PCC_STATIC_STRUCT_RETURN
4658 Define this macro if the usual system convention on the target machine
4659 for returning structures and unions is for the called function to return
4660 the address of a static variable containing the value.
4661
4662 Do not define this if the usual system convention is for the caller to
4663 pass an address to the subroutine.
4664
4665 This macro has effect in @option{-fpcc-struct-return} mode, but it does
4666 nothing when you use @option{-freg-struct-return} mode.
4667 @end defmac
4668
4669 @deftypefn {Target Hook} fixed_size_mode TARGET_GET_RAW_RESULT_MODE (int @var{regno})
4670 This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw return registers in @code{__builtin_return}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4671 @end deftypefn
4672
4673 @deftypefn {Target Hook} fixed_size_mode TARGET_GET_RAW_ARG_MODE (int @var{regno})
4674 This target hook returns the mode to be used when accessing raw argument registers in @code{__builtin_apply_args}. Define this macro if the value in @var{reg_raw_mode} is not correct.
4675 @end deftypefn
4676
4677 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMPTY_RECORD_P (const_tree @var{type})
4678 This target hook returns true if the type is an empty record. The default
4679 is to return @code{false}.
4680 @end deftypefn
4681
4682 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_WARN_PARAMETER_PASSING_ABI (cumulative_args_t @var{ca}, tree @var{type})
4683 This target hook warns about the change in empty class parameter passing
4684 ABI.
4685 @end deftypefn
4686
4687 @node Caller Saves
4688 @subsection Caller-Saves Register Allocation
4689
4690 If you enable it, GCC can save registers around function calls. This
4691 makes it possible to use call-clobbered registers to hold variables that
4692 must live across calls.
4693
4694 @defmac HARD_REGNO_CALLER_SAVE_MODE (@var{regno}, @var{nregs})
4695 A C expression specifying which mode is required for saving @var{nregs}
4696 of a pseudo-register in call-clobbered hard register @var{regno}. If
4697 @var{regno} is unsuitable for caller save, @code{VOIDmode} should be
4698 returned. For most machines this macro need not be defined since GCC
4699 will select the smallest suitable mode.
4700 @end defmac
4701
4702 @node Function Entry
4703 @subsection Function Entry and Exit
4704 @cindex function entry and exit
4705 @cindex prologue
4706 @cindex epilogue
4707
4708 This section describes the macros that output function entry
4709 (@dfn{prologue}) and exit (@dfn{epilogue}) code.
4710
4711 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_PRINT_PATCHABLE_FUNCTION_ENTRY (FILE *@var{file}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{patch_area_size}, bool @var{record_p})
4712 Generate a patchable area at the function start, consisting of
4713 @var{patch_area_size} NOP instructions. If the target supports named
4714 sections and if @var{record_p} is true, insert a pointer to the current
4715 location in the table of patchable functions. The default implementation
4716 of the hook places the table of pointers in the special section named
4717 @code{__patchable_function_entries}.
4718 @end deftypefn
4719
4720 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4721 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for entry to a
4722 function. The prologue is responsible for setting up the stack frame,
4723 initializing the frame pointer register, saving registers that must be
4724 saved, and allocating @var{size} additional bytes of storage for the
4725 local variables. @var{file} is a stdio stream to which the assembler
4726 code should be output.
4727
4728 The label for the beginning of the function need not be output by this
4729 macro. That has already been done when the macro is run.
4730
4731 @findex regs_ever_live
4732 To determine which registers to save, the macro can refer to the array
4733 @code{regs_ever_live}: element @var{r} is nonzero if hard register
4734 @var{r} is used anywhere within the function. This implies the function
4735 prologue should save register @var{r}, provided it is not one of the
4736 call-used registers. (@code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must likewise use
4737 @code{regs_ever_live}.)
4738
4739 On machines that have ``register windows'', the function entry code does
4740 not save on the stack the registers that are in the windows, even if
4741 they are supposed to be preserved by function calls; instead it takes
4742 appropriate steps to ``push'' the register stack, if any non-call-used
4743 registers are used in the function.
4744
4745 @findex frame_pointer_needed
4746 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4747 function entry code must vary accordingly; it must set up the frame
4748 pointer if one is wanted, and not otherwise. To determine whether a
4749 frame pointer is in wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4750 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 at run
4751 time in a function that needs a frame pointer. @xref{Elimination}.
4752
4753 The function entry code is responsible for allocating any stack space
4754 required for the function. This stack space consists of the regions
4755 listed below. In most cases, these regions are allocated in the
4756 order listed, with the last listed region closest to the top of the
4757 stack (the lowest address if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is defined, and
4758 the highest address if it is not defined). You can use a different order
4759 for a machine if doing so is more convenient or required for
4760 compatibility reasons. Except in cases where required by standard
4761 or by a debugger, there is no reason why the stack layout used by GCC
4762 need agree with that used by other compilers for a machine.
4763 @end deftypefn
4764
4765 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_END_PROLOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4766 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the end of a
4767 prologue. This should be used when the function prologue is being
4768 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4769 emitted. @xref{prologue instruction pattern}.
4770 @end deftypefn
4771
4772 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_BEGIN_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4773 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code at the start of an
4774 epilogue. This should be used when the function epilogue is being
4775 emitted as RTL, and you have some extra assembler that needs to be
4776 emitted. @xref{epilogue instruction pattern}.
4777 @end deftypefn
4778
4779 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE (FILE *@var{file})
4780 If defined, a function that outputs the assembler code for exit from a
4781 function. The epilogue is responsible for restoring the saved
4782 registers and stack pointer to their values when the function was
4783 called, and returning control to the caller. This macro takes the
4784 same argument as the macro @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}, and the
4785 registers to restore are determined from @code{regs_ever_live} and
4786 @code{CALL_USED_REGISTERS} in the same way.
4787
4788 On some machines, there is a single instruction that does all the work
4789 of returning from the function. On these machines, give that
4790 instruction the name @samp{return} and do not define the macro
4791 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} at all.
4792
4793 Do not define a pattern named @samp{return} if you want the
4794 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} to be used. If you want the target
4795 switches to control whether return instructions or epilogues are used,
4796 define a @samp{return} pattern with a validity condition that tests the
4797 target switches appropriately. If the @samp{return} pattern's validity
4798 condition is false, epilogues will be used.
4799
4800 On machines where functions may or may not have frame-pointers, the
4801 function exit code must vary accordingly. Sometimes the code for these
4802 two cases is completely different. To determine whether a frame pointer
4803 is wanted, the macro can refer to the variable
4804 @code{frame_pointer_needed}. The variable's value will be 1 when compiling
4805 a function that needs a frame pointer.
4806
4807 Normally, @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} and
4808 @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} must treat leaf functions specially.
4809 The C variable @code{current_function_is_leaf} is nonzero for such a
4810 function. @xref{Leaf Functions}.
4811
4812 On some machines, some functions pop their arguments on exit while
4813 others leave that for the caller to do. For example, the 68020 when
4814 given @option{-mrtd} pops arguments in functions that take a fixed
4815 number of arguments.
4816
4817 @findex pops_args
4818 @findex crtl->args.pops_args
4819 Your definition of the macro @code{RETURN_POPS_ARGS} decides which
4820 functions pop their own arguments. @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE}
4821 needs to know what was decided. The number of bytes of the current
4822 function's arguments that this function should pop is available in
4823 @code{crtl->args.pops_args}. @xref{Scalar Return}.
4824 @end deftypefn
4825
4826 @itemize @bullet
4827 @item
4828 @findex pretend_args_size
4829 @findex crtl->args.pretend_args_size
4830 A region of @code{crtl->args.pretend_args_size} bytes of
4831 uninitialized space just underneath the first argument arriving on the
4832 stack. (This may not be at the very start of the allocated stack region
4833 if the calling sequence has pushed anything else since pushing the stack
4834 arguments. But usually, on such machines, nothing else has been pushed
4835 yet, because the function prologue itself does all the pushing.) This
4836 region is used on machines where an argument may be passed partly in
4837 registers and partly in memory, and, in some cases to support the
4838 features in @code{<stdarg.h>}.
4839
4840 @item
4841 An area of memory used to save certain registers used by the function.
4842 The size of this area, which may also include space for such things as
4843 the return address and pointers to previous stack frames, is
4844 machine-specific and usually depends on which registers have been used
4845 in the function. Machines with register windows often do not require
4846 a save area.
4847
4848 @item
4849 A region of at least @var{size} bytes, possibly rounded up to an allocation
4850 boundary, to contain the local variables of the function. On some machines,
4851 this region and the save area may occur in the opposite order, with the
4852 save area closer to the top of the stack.
4853
4854 @item
4855 @cindex @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} and stack frames
4856 Optionally, when @code{ACCUMULATE_OUTGOING_ARGS} is defined, a region of
4857 @code{crtl->outgoing_args_size} bytes to be used for outgoing
4858 argument lists of the function. @xref{Stack Arguments}.
4859 @end itemize
4860
4861 @defmac EXIT_IGNORE_STACK
4862 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if the return
4863 instruction or the function epilogue ignores the value of the stack
4864 pointer; in other words, if it is safe to delete an instruction to
4865 adjust the stack pointer before a return from the function. The
4866 default is 0.
4867
4868 Note that this macro's value is relevant only for functions for which
4869 frame pointers are maintained. It is never safe to delete a final
4870 stack adjustment in a function that has no frame pointer, and the
4871 compiler knows this regardless of @code{EXIT_IGNORE_STACK}.
4872 @end defmac
4873
4874 @defmac EPILOGUE_USES (@var{regno})
4875 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4876 used by the epilogue or the @samp{return} pattern. The stack and frame
4877 pointer registers are already assumed to be used as needed.
4878 @end defmac
4879
4880 @defmac EH_USES (@var{regno})
4881 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero for registers that are
4882 used by the exception handling mechanism, and so should be considered live
4883 on entry to an exception edge.
4884 @end defmac
4885
4886 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, tree @var{function})
4887 A function that outputs the assembler code for a thunk
4888 function, used to implement C++ virtual function calls with multiple
4889 inheritance. The thunk acts as a wrapper around a virtual function,
4890 adjusting the implicit object parameter before handing control off to
4891 the real function.
4892
4893 First, emit code to add the integer @var{delta} to the location that
4894 contains the incoming first argument. Assume that this argument
4895 contains a pointer, and is the one used to pass the @code{this} pointer
4896 in C++. This is the incoming argument @emph{before} the function prologue,
4897 e.g.@: @samp{%o0} on a sparc. The addition must preserve the values of
4898 all other incoming arguments.
4899
4900 Then, if @var{vcall_offset} is nonzero, an additional adjustment should be
4901 made after adding @code{delta}. In particular, if @var{p} is the
4902 adjusted pointer, the following adjustment should be made:
4903
4904 @smallexample
4905 p += (*((ptrdiff_t **)p))[vcall_offset/sizeof(ptrdiff_t)]
4906 @end smallexample
4907
4908 After the additions, emit code to jump to @var{function}, which is a
4909 @code{FUNCTION_DECL}. This is a direct pure jump, not a call, and does
4910 not touch the return address. Hence returning from @var{FUNCTION} will
4911 return to whoever called the current @samp{thunk}.
4912
4913 The effect must be as if @var{function} had been called directly with
4914 the adjusted first argument. This macro is responsible for emitting all
4915 of the code for a thunk function; @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE}
4916 and @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_EPILOGUE} are not invoked.
4917
4918 The @var{thunk_fndecl} is redundant. (@var{delta} and @var{function}
4919 have already been extracted from it.) It might possibly be useful on
4920 some targets, but probably not.
4921
4922 If you do not define this macro, the target-independent code in the C++
4923 front end will generate a less efficient heavyweight thunk that calls
4924 @var{function} instead of jumping to it. The generic approach does
4925 not support varargs.
4926 @end deftypefn
4927
4928 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_CAN_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK (const_tree @var{thunk_fndecl}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{delta}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{vcall_offset}, const_tree @var{function})
4929 A function that returns true if TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_MI_THUNK would be able
4930 to output the assembler code for the thunk function specified by the
4931 arguments it is passed, and false otherwise. In the latter case, the
4932 generic approach will be used by the C++ front end, with the limitations
4933 previously exposed.
4934 @end deftypefn
4935
4936 @node Profiling
4937 @subsection Generating Code for Profiling
4938 @cindex profiling, code generation
4939
4940 These macros will help you generate code for profiling.
4941
4942 @defmac FUNCTION_PROFILER (@var{file}, @var{labelno})
4943 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some
4944 assembler code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount}.
4945
4946 @findex mcount
4947 The details of how @code{mcount} expects to be called are determined by
4948 your operating system environment, not by GCC@. To figure them out,
4949 compile a small program for profiling using the system's installed C
4950 compiler and look at the assembler code that results.
4951
4952 Older implementations of @code{mcount} expect the address of a counter
4953 variable to be loaded into some register. The name of this variable is
4954 @samp{LP} followed by the number @var{labelno}, so you would generate
4955 the name using @samp{LP%d} in a @code{fprintf}.
4956 @end defmac
4957
4958 @defmac PROFILE_HOOK
4959 A C statement or compound statement to output to @var{file} some assembly
4960 code to call the profiling subroutine @code{mcount} even the target does
4961 not support profiling.
4962 @end defmac
4963
4964 @defmac NO_PROFILE_COUNTERS
4965 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if the
4966 @code{mcount} subroutine on your system does not need a counter variable
4967 allocated for each function. This is true for almost all modern
4968 implementations. If you define this macro, you must not use the
4969 @var{labelno} argument to @code{FUNCTION_PROFILER}.
4970 @end defmac
4971
4972 @defmac PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE
4973 Define this macro if the code for function profiling should come before
4974 the function prologue. Normally, the profiling code comes after.
4975 @end defmac
4976
4977 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_KEEP_LEAF_WHEN_PROFILED (void)
4978 This target hook returns true if the target wants the leaf flag for the current function to stay true even if it calls mcount. This might make sense for targets using the leaf flag only to determine whether a stack frame needs to be generated or not and for which the call to mcount is generated before the function prologue.
4979 @end deftypefn
4980
4981 @node Tail Calls
4982 @subsection Permitting tail calls
4983 @cindex tail calls
4984
4985 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_OK_FOR_SIBCALL (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{exp})
4986 True if it is OK to do sibling call optimization for the specified
4987 call expression @var{exp}. @var{decl} will be the called function,
4988 or @code{NULL} if this is an indirect call.
4989
4990 It is not uncommon for limitations of calling conventions to prevent
4991 tail calls to functions outside the current unit of translation, or
4992 during PIC compilation. The hook is used to enforce these restrictions,
4993 as the @code{sibcall} md pattern cannot fail, or fall over to a
4994 ``normal'' call. The criteria for successful sibling call optimization
4995 may vary greatly between different architectures.
4996 @end deftypefn
4997
4998 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXTRA_LIVE_ON_ENTRY (bitmap @var{regs})
4999 Add any hard registers to @var{regs} that are live on entry to the
5000 function. This hook only needs to be defined to provide registers that
5001 cannot be found by examination of FUNCTION_ARG_REGNO_P, the callee saved
5002 registers, STATIC_CHAIN_INCOMING_REGNUM, STATIC_CHAIN_REGNUM,
5003 TARGET_STRUCT_VALUE_RTX, FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, EH_USES,
5004 FRAME_POINTER_REGNUM, ARG_POINTER_REGNUM, and the PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM.
5005 @end deftypefn
5006
5007 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_UP_BY_PROLOGUE (struct hard_reg_set_container *@var{})
5008 This hook should add additional registers that are computed by the prologue to the hard regset for shrink-wrapping optimization purposes.
5009 @end deftypefn
5010
5011 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WARN_FUNC_RETURN (tree)
5012 True if a function's return statements should be checked for matching the function's return type. This includes checking for falling off the end of a non-void function. Return false if no such check should be made.
5013 @end deftypefn
5014
5015 @node Shrink-wrapping separate components
5016 @subsection Shrink-wrapping separate components
5017 @cindex shrink-wrapping separate components
5018
5019 The prologue may perform a variety of target dependent tasks such as
5020 saving callee-saved registers, saving the return address, aligning the
5021 stack, creating a stack frame, initializing the PIC register, setting
5022 up the static chain, etc.
5023
5024 On some targets some of these tasks may be independent of others and
5025 thus may be shrink-wrapped separately. These independent tasks are
5026 referred to as components and are handled generically by the target
5027 independent parts of GCC.
5028
5029 Using the following hooks those prologue or epilogue components can be
5030 shrink-wrapped separately, so that the initialization (and possibly
5031 teardown) those components do is not done as frequently on execution
5032 paths where this would unnecessary.
5033
5034 What exactly those components are is up to the target code; the generic
5035 code treats them abstractly, as a bit in an @code{sbitmap}. These
5036 @code{sbitmap}s are allocated by the @code{shrink_wrap.get_separate_components}
5037 and @code{shrink_wrap.components_for_bb} hooks, and deallocated by the
5038 generic code.
5039
5040 @deftypefn {Target Hook} sbitmap TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_GET_SEPARATE_COMPONENTS (void)
5041 This hook should return an @code{sbitmap} with the bits set for those
5042 components that can be separately shrink-wrapped in the current function.
5043 Return @code{NULL} if the current function should not get any separate
5044 shrink-wrapping.
5045 Don't define this hook if it would always return @code{NULL}.
5046 If it is defined, the other hooks in this group have to be defined as well.
5047 @end deftypefn
5048
5049 @deftypefn {Target Hook} sbitmap TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_COMPONENTS_FOR_BB (basic_block)
5050 This hook should return an @code{sbitmap} with the bits set for those
5051 components where either the prologue component has to be executed before
5052 the @code{basic_block}, or the epilogue component after it, or both.
5053 @end deftypefn
5054
5055 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_DISQUALIFY_COMPONENTS (sbitmap @var{components}, edge @var{e}, sbitmap @var{edge_components}, bool @var{is_prologue})
5056 This hook should clear the bits in the @var{components} bitmap for those
5057 components in @var{edge_components} that the target cannot handle on edge
5058 @var{e}, where @var{is_prologue} says if this is for a prologue or an
5059 epilogue instead.
5060 @end deftypefn
5061
5062 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_EMIT_PROLOGUE_COMPONENTS (sbitmap)
5063 Emit prologue insns for the components indicated by the parameter.
5064 @end deftypefn
5065
5066 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_EMIT_EPILOGUE_COMPONENTS (sbitmap)
5067 Emit epilogue insns for the components indicated by the parameter.
5068 @end deftypefn
5069
5070 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SHRINK_WRAP_SET_HANDLED_COMPONENTS (sbitmap)
5071 Mark the components in the parameter as handled, so that the
5072 @code{prologue} and @code{epilogue} named patterns know to ignore those
5073 components. The target code should not hang on to the @code{sbitmap}, it
5074 will be deleted after this call.
5075 @end deftypefn
5076
5077 @node Stack Smashing Protection
5078 @subsection Stack smashing protection
5079 @cindex stack smashing protection
5080
5081 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_GUARD (void)
5082 This hook returns a @code{DECL} node for the external variable to use
5083 for the stack protection guard. This variable is initialized by the
5084 runtime to some random value and is used to initialize the guard value
5085 that is placed at the top of the local stack frame. The type of this
5086 variable must be @code{ptr_type_node}.
5087
5088 The default version of this hook creates a variable called
5089 @samp{__stack_chk_guard}, which is normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
5090 @end deftypefn
5091
5092 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_FAIL (void)
5093 This hook returns a @code{CALL_EXPR} that alerts the runtime that the
5094 stack protect guard variable has been modified. This expression should
5095 involve a call to a @code{noreturn} function.
5096
5097 The default version of this hook invokes a function called
5098 @samp{__stack_chk_fail}, taking no arguments. This function is
5099 normally defined in @file{libgcc2.c}.
5100 @end deftypefn
5101
5102 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_STACK_PROTECT_RUNTIME_ENABLED_P (void)
5103 Returns true if the target wants GCC's default stack protect runtime support, otherwise return false. The default implementation always returns true.
5104 @end deftypefn
5105
5106 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_SUPPORTS_SPLIT_STACK (bool @var{report}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
5107 Whether this target supports splitting the stack when the options described in @var{opts} have been passed. This is called after options have been parsed, so the target may reject splitting the stack in some configurations. The default version of this hook returns false. If @var{report} is true, this function may issue a warning or error; if @var{report} is false, it must simply return a value
5108 @end deftypefn
5109
5110 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} {vec<const char *>} TARGET_GET_VALID_OPTION_VALUES (int @var{option_code}, const char *@var{prefix})
5111 The hook is used for options that have a non-trivial list of possible option values. OPTION_CODE is option code of opt_code enum type. PREFIX is used for bash completion and allows an implementation to return more specific completion based on the prefix. All string values should be allocated from heap memory and consumers should release them. The result will be pruned to cases with PREFIX if not NULL.
5112 @end deftypefn
5113
5114 @node Miscellaneous Register Hooks
5115 @subsection Miscellaneous register hooks
5116 @cindex miscellaneous register hooks
5117
5118 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CALL_FUSAGE_CONTAINS_NON_CALLEE_CLOBBERS
5119 Set to true if each call that binds to a local definition explicitly
5120 clobbers or sets all non-fixed registers modified by performing the call.
5121 That is, by the call pattern itself, or by code that might be inserted by the
5122 linker (e.g.@: stubs, veneers, branch islands), but not including those
5123 modifiable by the callee. The affected registers may be mentioned explicitly
5124 in the call pattern, or included as clobbers in CALL_INSN_FUNCTION_USAGE.
5125 The default version of this hook is set to false. The purpose of this hook
5126 is to enable the fipa-ra optimization.
5127 @end deftypevr
5128
5129 @node Varargs
5130 @section Implementing the Varargs Macros
5131 @cindex varargs implementation
5132
5133 GCC comes with an implementation of @code{<varargs.h>} and
5134 @code{<stdarg.h>} that work without change on machines that pass arguments
5135 on the stack. Other machines require their own implementations of
5136 varargs, and the two machine independent header files must have
5137 conditionals to include it.
5138
5139 ISO @code{<stdarg.h>} differs from traditional @code{<varargs.h>} mainly in
5140 the calling convention for @code{va_start}. The traditional
5141 implementation takes just one argument, which is the variable in which
5142 to store the argument pointer. The ISO implementation of
5143 @code{va_start} takes an additional second argument. The user is
5144 supposed to write the last named argument of the function here.
5145
5146 However, @code{va_start} should not use this argument. The way to find
5147 the end of the named arguments is with the built-in functions described
5148 below.
5149
5150 @defmac __builtin_saveregs ()
5151 Use this built-in function to save the argument registers in memory so
5152 that the varargs mechanism can access them. Both ISO and traditional
5153 versions of @code{va_start} must use @code{__builtin_saveregs}, unless
5154 you use @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} (see below) instead.
5155
5156 On some machines, @code{__builtin_saveregs} is open-coded under the
5157 control of the target hook @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. On
5158 other machines, it calls a routine written in assembler language,
5159 found in @file{libgcc2.c}.
5160
5161 Code generated for the call to @code{__builtin_saveregs} appears at the
5162 beginning of the function, as opposed to where the call to
5163 @code{__builtin_saveregs} is written, regardless of what the code is.
5164 This is because the registers must be saved before the function starts
5165 to use them for its own purposes.
5166 @c i rewrote the first sentence above to fix an overfull hbox. --mew
5167 @c 10feb93
5168 @end defmac
5169
5170 @defmac __builtin_next_arg (@var{lastarg})
5171 This builtin returns the address of the first anonymous stack
5172 argument, as type @code{void *}. If @code{ARGS_GROW_DOWNWARD}, it
5173 returns the address of the location above the first anonymous stack
5174 argument. Use it in @code{va_start} to initialize the pointer for
5175 fetching arguments from the stack. Also use it in @code{va_start} to
5176 verify that the second parameter @var{lastarg} is the last named argument
5177 of the current function.
5178 @end defmac
5179
5180 @defmac __builtin_classify_type (@var{object})
5181 Since each machine has its own conventions for which data types are
5182 passed in which kind of register, your implementation of @code{va_arg}
5183 has to embody these conventions. The easiest way to categorize the
5184 specified data type is to use @code{__builtin_classify_type} together
5185 with @code{sizeof} and @code{__alignof__}.
5186
5187 @code{__builtin_classify_type} ignores the value of @var{object},
5188 considering only its data type. It returns an integer describing what
5189 kind of type that is---integer, floating, pointer, structure, and so on.
5190
5191 The file @file{typeclass.h} defines an enumeration that you can use to
5192 interpret the values of @code{__builtin_classify_type}.
5193 @end defmac
5194
5195 These machine description macros help implement varargs:
5196
5197 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS (void)
5198 If defined, this hook produces the machine-specific code for a call to
5199 @code{__builtin_saveregs}. This code will be moved to the very
5200 beginning of the function, before any parameter access are made. The
5201 return value of this function should be an RTX that contains the value
5202 to use as the return of @code{__builtin_saveregs}.
5203 @end deftypefn
5204
5205 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS (cumulative_args_t @var{args_so_far}, machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, int *@var{pretend_args_size}, int @var{second_time})
5206 This target hook offers an alternative to using
5207 @code{__builtin_saveregs} and defining the hook
5208 @code{TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN_SAVEREGS}. Use it to store the anonymous
5209 register arguments into the stack so that all the arguments appear to
5210 have been passed consecutively on the stack. Once this is done, you can
5211 use the standard implementation of varargs that works for machines that
5212 pass all their arguments on the stack.
5213
5214 The argument @var{args_so_far} points to the @code{CUMULATIVE_ARGS} data
5215 structure, containing the values that are obtained after processing the
5216 named arguments. The arguments @var{mode} and @var{type} describe the
5217 last named argument---its machine mode and its data type as a tree node.
5218
5219 The target hook should do two things: first, push onto the stack all the
5220 argument registers @emph{not} used for the named arguments, and second,
5221 store the size of the data thus pushed into the @code{int}-valued
5222 variable pointed to by @var{pretend_args_size}. The value that you
5223 store here will serve as additional offset for setting up the stack
5224 frame.
5225
5226 Because you must generate code to push the anonymous arguments at
5227 compile time without knowing their data types,
5228 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is only useful on machines that
5229 have just a single category of argument register and use it uniformly
5230 for all data types.
5231
5232 If the argument @var{second_time} is nonzero, it means that the
5233 arguments of the function are being analyzed for the second time. This
5234 happens for an inline function, which is not actually compiled until the
5235 end of the source file. The hook @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} should
5236 not generate any instructions in this case.
5237 @end deftypefn
5238
5239 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING (cumulative_args_t @var{ca})
5240 Define this hook to return @code{true} if the location where a function
5241 argument is passed depends on whether or not it is a named argument.
5242
5243 This hook controls how the @var{named} argument to @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG}
5244 is set for varargs and stdarg functions. If this hook returns
5245 @code{true}, the @var{named} argument is always true for named
5246 arguments, and false for unnamed arguments. If it returns @code{false},
5247 but @code{TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED} returns @code{true},
5248 then all arguments are treated as named. Otherwise, all named arguments
5249 except the last are treated as named.
5250
5251 You need not define this hook if it always returns @code{false}.
5252 @end deftypefn
5253
5254 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CALL_ARGS (rtx, @var{tree})
5255 While generating RTL for a function call, this target hook is invoked once
5256 for each argument passed to the function, either a register returned by
5257 @code{TARGET_FUNCTION_ARG} or a memory location. It is called just
5258 before the point where argument registers are stored. The type of the
5259 function to be called is also passed as the second argument; it is
5260 @code{NULL_TREE} for libcalls. The @code{TARGET_END_CALL_ARGS} hook is
5261 invoked just after the code to copy the return reg has been emitted.
5262 This functionality can be used to perform special setup of call argument
5263 registers if a target needs it.
5264 For functions without arguments, the hook is called once with @code{pc_rtx}
5265 passed instead of an argument register.
5266 Most ports do not need to implement anything for this hook.
5267 @end deftypefn
5268
5269 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_END_CALL_ARGS (void)
5270 This target hook is invoked while generating RTL for a function call,
5271 just after the point where the return reg is copied into a pseudo. It
5272 signals that all the call argument and return registers for the just
5273 emitted call are now no longer in use.
5274 Most ports do not need to implement anything for this hook.
5275 @end deftypefn
5276
5277 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PRETEND_OUTGOING_VARARGS_NAMED (cumulative_args_t @var{ca})
5278 If you need to conditionally change ABIs so that one works with
5279 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}, but the other works like neither
5280 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} nor @code{TARGET_STRICT_ARGUMENT_NAMING} was
5281 defined, then define this hook to return @code{true} if
5282 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS} is used, @code{false} otherwise.
5283 Otherwise, you should not define this hook.
5284 @end deftypefn
5285
5286 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LOAD_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG (rtx @var{slot}, rtx @var{arg}, rtx @var{slot_no})
5287 This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to load bounds of
5288 @var{arg} passed in @var{slot}. Expand pass uses this hook in case
5289 bounds of @var{arg} are not passed in register. If @var{slot} is a
5290 memory, then bounds are loaded as for regular pointer loaded from
5291 memory. If @var{slot} is not a memory then @var{slot_no} is an integer
5292 constant holding number of the target dependent special slot which
5293 should be used to obtain bounds. Hook returns RTX holding loaded bounds.
5294 @end deftypefn
5295
5296 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_STORE_BOUNDS_FOR_ARG (rtx @var{arg}, rtx @var{slot}, rtx @var{bounds}, rtx @var{slot_no})
5297 This hook is used by expand pass to emit insns to store @var{bounds} of
5298 @var{arg} passed in @var{slot}. Expand pass uses this hook in case
5299 @var{bounds} of @var{arg} are not passed in register. If @var{slot} is a
5300 memory, then @var{bounds} are stored as for regular pointer stored in
5301 memory. If @var{slot} is not a memory then @var{slot_no} is an integer
5302 constant holding number of the target dependent special slot which
5303 should be used to store @var{bounds}.
5304 @end deftypefn
5305
5306 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LOAD_RETURNED_BOUNDS (rtx @var{slot})
5307 This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to load bounds
5308 returned by function call in @var{slot}. Hook returns RTX holding
5309 loaded bounds.
5310 @end deftypefn
5311
5312 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_STORE_RETURNED_BOUNDS (rtx @var{slot}, rtx @var{bounds})
5313 This hook is used by expand pass to emit insn to store @var{bounds}
5314 returned by function call into @var{slot}.
5315 @end deftypefn
5316
5317 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARG_BOUNDS (cumulative_args_t @var{args_so_far}, machine_mode @var{mode}, tree @var{type}, int *@var{pretend_args_size}, int @var{second_time})
5318 Use it to store bounds for anonymous register arguments stored
5319 into the stack. Arguments meaning is similar to
5320 @code{TARGET_SETUP_INCOMING_VARARGS}.
5321 @end deftypefn
5322
5323 @node Trampolines
5324 @section Support for Nested Functions
5325 @cindex support for nested functions
5326 @cindex trampolines for nested functions
5327 @cindex descriptors for nested functions
5328 @cindex nested functions, support for
5329
5330 Taking the address of a nested function requires special compiler
5331 handling to ensure that the static chain register is loaded when
5332 the function is invoked via an indirect call.
5333
5334 GCC has traditionally supported nested functions by creating an
5335 executable @dfn{trampoline} at run time when the address of a nested
5336 function is taken. This is a small piece of code which normally
5337 resides on the stack, in the stack frame of the containing function.
5338 The trampoline loads the static chain register and then jumps to the
5339 real address of the nested function.
5340
5341 The use of trampolines requires an executable stack, which is a
5342 security risk. To avoid this problem, GCC also supports another
5343 strategy: using descriptors for nested functions. Under this model,
5344 taking the address of a nested function results in a pointer to a
5345 non-executable function descriptor object. Initializing the static chain
5346 from the descriptor is handled at indirect call sites.
5347
5348 On some targets, including HPPA and IA-64, function descriptors may be
5349 mandated by the ABI or be otherwise handled in a target-specific way
5350 by the back end in its code generation strategy for indirect calls.
5351 GCC also provides its own generic descriptor implementation to support the
5352 @option{-fno-trampolines} option. In this case runtime detection of
5353 function descriptors at indirect call sites relies on descriptor
5354 pointers being tagged with a bit that is never set in bare function
5355 addresses. Since GCC's generic function descriptors are
5356 not ABI-compliant, this option is typically used only on a
5357 per-language basis (notably by Ada) or when it can otherwise be
5358 applied to the whole program.
5359
5360 Define the following hook if your backend either implements ABI-specified
5361 descriptor support, or can use GCC's generic descriptor implementation
5362 for nested functions.
5363
5364 @deftypevr {Target Hook} int TARGET_CUSTOM_FUNCTION_DESCRIPTORS
5365 If the target can use GCC's generic descriptor mechanism for nested
5366 functions, define this hook to a power of 2 representing an unused bit
5367 in function pointers which can be used to differentiate descriptors at
5368 run time. This value gives the number of bytes by which descriptor
5369 pointers are misaligned compared to function pointers. For example, on
5370 targets that require functions to be aligned to a 4-byte boundary, a
5371 value of either 1 or 2 is appropriate unless the architecture already
5372 reserves the bit for another purpose, such as on ARM.
5373
5374 Define this hook to 0 if the target implements ABI support for
5375 function descriptors in its standard calling sequence, like for example
5376 HPPA or IA-64.
5377
5378 Using descriptors for nested functions
5379 eliminates the need for trampolines that reside on the stack and require
5380 it to be made executable.
5381 @end deftypevr
5382
5383 The following macros tell GCC how to generate code to allocate and
5384 initialize an executable trampoline. You can also use this interface
5385 if your back end needs to create ABI-specified non-executable descriptors; in
5386 this case the "trampoline" created is the descriptor containing data only.
5387
5388 The instructions in an executable trampoline must do two things: load
5389 a constant address into the static chain register, and jump to the real
5390 address of the nested function. On CISC machines such as the m68k,
5391 this requires two instructions, a move immediate and a jump. Then the
5392 two addresses exist in the trampoline as word-long immediate operands.
5393 On RISC machines, it is often necessary to load each address into a
5394 register in two parts. Then pieces of each address form separate
5395 immediate operands.
5396
5397 The code generated to initialize the trampoline must store the variable
5398 parts---the static chain value and the function address---into the
5399 immediate operands of the instructions. On a CISC machine, this is
5400 simply a matter of copying each address to a memory reference at the
5401 proper offset from the start of the trampoline. On a RISC machine, it
5402 may be necessary to take out pieces of the address and store them
5403 separately.
5404
5405 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE (FILE *@var{f})
5406 This hook is called by @code{assemble_trampoline_template} to output,
5407 on the stream @var{f}, assembler code for a block of data that contains
5408 the constant parts of a trampoline. This code should not include a
5409 label---the label is taken care of automatically.
5410
5411 If you do not define this hook, it means no template is needed
5412 for the target. Do not define this hook on systems where the block move
5413 code to copy the trampoline into place would be larger than the code
5414 to generate it on the spot.
5415 @end deftypefn
5416
5417 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_SECTION
5418 Return the section into which the trampoline template is to be placed
5419 (@pxref{Sections}). The default value is @code{readonly_data_section}.
5420 @end defmac
5421
5422 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_SIZE
5423 A C expression for the size in bytes of the trampoline, as an integer.
5424 @end defmac
5425
5426 @defmac TRAMPOLINE_ALIGNMENT
5427 Alignment required for trampolines, in bits.
5428
5429 If you don't define this macro, the value of @code{FUNCTION_ALIGNMENT}
5430 is used for aligning trampolines.
5431 @end defmac
5432
5433 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT (rtx @var{m_tramp}, tree @var{fndecl}, rtx @var{static_chain})
5434 This hook is called to initialize a trampoline.
5435 @var{m_tramp} is an RTX for the memory block for the trampoline; @var{fndecl}
5436 is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} for the nested function; @var{static_chain} is an
5437 RTX for the static chain value that should be passed to the function
5438 when it is called.
5439
5440 If the target defines @code{TARGET_ASM_TRAMPOLINE_TEMPLATE}, then the
5441 first thing this hook should do is emit a block move into @var{m_tramp}
5442 from the memory block returned by @code{assemble_trampoline_template}.
5443 Note that the block move need only cover the constant parts of the
5444 trampoline. If the target isolates the variable parts of the trampoline
5445 to the end, not all @code{TRAMPOLINE_SIZE} bytes need be copied.
5446
5447 If the target requires any other actions, such as flushing caches or
5448 enabling stack execution, these actions should be performed after
5449 initializing the trampoline proper.
5450 @end deftypefn
5451
5452 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_ADJUST_ADDRESS (rtx @var{addr})
5453 This hook should perform any machine-specific adjustment in
5454 the address of the trampoline. Its argument contains the address of the
5455 memory block that was passed to @code{TARGET_TRAMPOLINE_INIT}. In case
5456 the address to be used for a function call should be different from the
5457 address at which the template was stored, the different address should
5458 be returned; otherwise @var{addr} should be returned unchanged.
5459 If this hook is not defined, @var{addr} will be used for function calls.
5460 @end deftypefn
5461
5462 Implementing trampolines is difficult on many machines because they have
5463 separate instruction and data caches. Writing into a stack location
5464 fails to clear the memory in the instruction cache, so when the program
5465 jumps to that location, it executes the old contents.
5466
5467 Here are two possible solutions. One is to clear the relevant parts of
5468 the instruction cache whenever a trampoline is set up. The other is to
5469 make all trampolines identical, by having them jump to a standard
5470 subroutine. The former technique makes trampoline execution faster; the
5471 latter makes initialization faster.
5472
5473 To clear the instruction cache when a trampoline is initialized, define
5474 the following macro.
5475
5476 @defmac CLEAR_INSN_CACHE (@var{beg}, @var{end})
5477 If defined, expands to a C expression clearing the @emph{instruction
5478 cache} in the specified interval. The definition of this macro would
5479 typically be a series of @code{asm} statements. Both @var{beg} and
5480 @var{end} are both pointer expressions.
5481 @end defmac
5482
5483 To use a standard subroutine, define the following macro. In addition,
5484 you must make sure that the instructions in a trampoline fill an entire
5485 cache line with identical instructions, or else ensure that the
5486 beginning of the trampoline code is always aligned at the same point in
5487 its cache line. Look in @file{m68k.h} as a guide.
5488
5489 @defmac TRANSFER_FROM_TRAMPOLINE
5490 Define this macro if trampolines need a special subroutine to do their
5491 work. The macro should expand to a series of @code{asm} statements
5492 which will be compiled with GCC@. They go in a library function named
5493 @code{__transfer_from_trampoline}.
5494
5495 If you need to avoid executing the ordinary prologue code of a compiled
5496 C function when you jump to the subroutine, you can do so by placing a
5497 special label of your own in the assembler code. Use one @code{asm}
5498 statement to generate an assembler label, and another to make the label
5499 global. Then trampolines can use that label to jump directly to your
5500 special assembler code.
5501 @end defmac
5502
5503 @node Library Calls
5504 @section Implicit Calls to Library Routines
5505 @cindex library subroutine names
5506 @cindex @file{libgcc.a}
5507
5508 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5509 Here is an explanation of implicit calls to library routines.
5510
5511 @defmac DECLARE_LIBRARY_RENAMES
5512 This macro, if defined, should expand to a piece of C code that will get
5513 expanded when compiling functions for libgcc.a. It can be used to
5514 provide alternate names for GCC's internal library functions if there
5515 are ABI-mandated names that the compiler should provide.
5516 @end defmac
5517
5518 @findex set_optab_libfunc
5519 @findex init_one_libfunc
5520 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_LIBFUNCS (void)
5521 This hook should declare additional library routines or rename
5522 existing ones, using the functions @code{set_optab_libfunc} and
5523 @code{init_one_libfunc} defined in @file{optabs.c}.
5524 @code{init_optabs} calls this macro after initializing all the normal
5525 library routines.
5526
5527 The default is to do nothing. Most ports don't need to define this hook.
5528 @end deftypefn
5529
5530 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBFUNC_GNU_PREFIX
5531 If false (the default), internal library routines start with two
5532 underscores. If set to true, these routines start with @code{__gnu_}
5533 instead. E.g., @code{__muldi3} changes to @code{__gnu_muldi3}. This
5534 currently only affects functions defined in @file{libgcc2.c}. If this
5535 is set to true, the @file{tm.h} file must also
5536 @code{#define LIBGCC2_GNU_PREFIX}.
5537 @end deftypevr
5538
5539 @defmac FLOAT_LIB_COMPARE_RETURNS_BOOL (@var{mode}, @var{comparison})
5540 This macro should return @code{true} if the library routine that
5541 implements the floating point comparison operator @var{comparison} in
5542 mode @var{mode} will return a boolean, and @var{false} if it will
5543 return a tristate.
5544
5545 GCC's own floating point libraries return tristates from the
5546 comparison operators, so the default returns false always. Most ports
5547 don't need to define this macro.
5548 @end defmac
5549
5550 @defmac TARGET_LIB_INT_CMP_BIASED
5551 This macro should evaluate to @code{true} if the integer comparison
5552 functions (like @code{__cmpdi2}) return 0 to indicate that the first
5553 operand is smaller than the second, 1 to indicate that they are equal,
5554 and 2 to indicate that the first operand is greater than the second.
5555 If this macro evaluates to @code{false} the comparison functions return
5556 @minus{}1, 0, and 1 instead of 0, 1, and 2. If the target uses the routines
5557 in @file{libgcc.a}, you do not need to define this macro.
5558 @end defmac
5559
5560 @defmac TARGET_HAS_NO_HW_DIVIDE
5561 This macro should be defined if the target has no hardware divide
5562 instructions. If this macro is defined, GCC will use an algorithm which
5563 make use of simple logical and arithmetic operations for 64-bit
5564 division. If the macro is not defined, GCC will use an algorithm which
5565 make use of a 64-bit by 32-bit divide primitive.
5566 @end defmac
5567
5568 @cindex @code{EDOM}, implicit usage
5569 @findex matherr
5570 @defmac TARGET_EDOM
5571 The value of @code{EDOM} on the target machine, as a C integer constant
5572 expression. If you don't define this macro, GCC does not attempt to
5573 deposit the value of @code{EDOM} into @code{errno} directly. Look in
5574 @file{/usr/include/errno.h} to find the value of @code{EDOM} on your
5575 system.
5576
5577 If you do not define @code{TARGET_EDOM}, then compiled code reports
5578 domain errors by calling the library function and letting it report the
5579 error. If mathematical functions on your system use @code{matherr} when
5580 there is an error, then you should leave @code{TARGET_EDOM} undefined so
5581 that @code{matherr} is used normally.
5582 @end defmac
5583
5584 @cindex @code{errno}, implicit usage
5585 @defmac GEN_ERRNO_RTX
5586 Define this macro as a C expression to create an rtl expression that
5587 refers to the global ``variable'' @code{errno}. (On certain systems,
5588 @code{errno} may not actually be a variable.) If you don't define this
5589 macro, a reasonable default is used.
5590 @end defmac
5591
5592 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LIBC_HAS_FUNCTION (enum function_class @var{fn_class})
5593 This hook determines whether a function from a class of functions
5594 @var{fn_class} is present at the runtime.
5595 @end deftypefn
5596
5597 @defmac NEXT_OBJC_RUNTIME
5598 Set this macro to 1 to use the "NeXT" Objective-C message sending conventions
5599 by default. This calling convention involves passing the object, the selector
5600 and the method arguments all at once to the method-lookup library function.
5601 This is the usual setting when targeting Darwin/Mac OS X systems, which have
5602 the NeXT runtime installed.
5603
5604 If the macro is set to 0, the "GNU" Objective-C message sending convention
5605 will be used by default. This convention passes just the object and the
5606 selector to the method-lookup function, which returns a pointer to the method.
5607
5608 In either case, it remains possible to select code-generation for the alternate
5609 scheme, by means of compiler command line switches.
5610 @end defmac
5611
5612 @node Addressing Modes
5613 @section Addressing Modes
5614 @cindex addressing modes
5615
5616 @c prevent bad page break with this line
5617 This is about addressing modes.
5618
5619 @defmac HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT
5620 @defmacx HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT
5621 @defmacx HAVE_POST_INCREMENT
5622 @defmacx HAVE_POST_DECREMENT
5623 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre-increment,
5624 pre-decrement, post-increment, or post-decrement addressing respectively.
5625 @end defmac
5626
5627 @defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_DISP
5628 @defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_DISP
5629 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5630 post-address side-effect generation involving constants other than
5631 the size of the memory operand.
5632 @end defmac
5633
5634 @defmac HAVE_PRE_MODIFY_REG
5635 @defmacx HAVE_POST_MODIFY_REG
5636 A C expression that is nonzero if the machine supports pre- or
5637 post-address side-effect generation involving a register displacement.
5638 @end defmac
5639
5640 @defmac CONSTANT_ADDRESS_P (@var{x})
5641 A C expression that is 1 if the RTX @var{x} is a constant which
5642 is a valid address. On most machines the default definition of
5643 @code{(CONSTANT_P (@var{x}) && GET_CODE (@var{x}) != CONST_DOUBLE)}
5644 is acceptable, but a few machines are more restrictive as to which
5645 constant addresses are supported.
5646 @end defmac
5647
5648 @defmac CONSTANT_P (@var{x})
5649 @code{CONSTANT_P}, which is defined by target-independent code,
5650 accepts integer-values expressions whose values are not explicitly
5651 known, such as @code{symbol_ref}, @code{label_ref}, and @code{high}
5652 expressions and @code{const} arithmetic expressions, in addition to
5653 @code{const_int} and @code{const_double} expressions.
5654 @end defmac
5655
5656 @defmac MAX_REGS_PER_ADDRESS
5657 A number, the maximum number of registers that can appear in a valid
5658 memory address. Note that it is up to you to specify a value equal to
5659 the maximum number that @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} would ever
5660 accept.
5661 @end defmac
5662
5663 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, bool @var{strict})
5664 A function that returns whether @var{x} (an RTX) is a legitimate memory
5665 address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5666
5667 Legitimate addresses are defined in two variants: a strict variant and a
5668 non-strict one. The @var{strict} parameter chooses which variant is
5669 desired by the caller.
5670
5671 The strict variant is used in the reload pass. It must be defined so
5672 that any pseudo-register that has not been allocated a hard register is
5673 considered a memory reference. This is because in contexts where some
5674 kind of register is required, a pseudo-register with no hard register
5675 must be rejected. For non-hard registers, the strict variant should look
5676 up the @code{reg_renumber} array; it should then proceed using the hard
5677 register number in the array, or treat the pseudo as a memory reference
5678 if the array holds @code{-1}.
5679
5680 The non-strict variant is used in other passes. It must be defined to
5681 accept all pseudo-registers in every context where some kind of
5682 register is required.
5683
5684 Normally, constant addresses which are the sum of a @code{symbol_ref}
5685 and an integer are stored inside a @code{const} RTX to mark them as
5686 constant. Therefore, there is no need to recognize such sums
5687 specifically as legitimate addresses. Normally you would simply
5688 recognize any @code{const} as legitimate.
5689
5690 Usually @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS} is not prepared to handle constant
5691 sums that are not marked with @code{const}. It assumes that a naked
5692 @code{plus} indicates indexing. If so, then you @emph{must} reject such
5693 naked constant sums as illegitimate addresses, so that none of them will
5694 be given to @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}.
5695
5696 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} and address validation
5697 On some machines, whether a symbolic address is legitimate depends on
5698 the section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the
5699 target hook @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information
5700 into the @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. When you see a
5701 @code{const}, you will have to look inside it to find the
5702 @code{symbol_ref} in order to determine the section. @xref{Assembler
5703 Format}.
5704
5705 @cindex @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS}
5706 Some ports are still using a deprecated legacy substitute for
5707 this hook, the @code{GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS} macro. This macro
5708 has this syntax:
5709
5710 @example
5711 #define GO_IF_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS (@var{mode}, @var{x}, @var{label})
5712 @end example
5713
5714 @noindent
5715 and should @code{goto @var{label}} if the address @var{x} is a valid
5716 address on the target machine for a memory operand of mode @var{mode}.
5717
5718 @findex REG_OK_STRICT
5719 Compiler source files that want to use the strict variant of this
5720 macro define the macro @code{REG_OK_STRICT}. You should use an
5721 @code{#ifdef REG_OK_STRICT} conditional to define the strict variant in
5722 that case and the non-strict variant otherwise.
5723
5724 Using the hook is usually simpler because it limits the number of
5725 files that are recompiled when changes are made.
5726 @end deftypefn
5727
5728 @defmac TARGET_MEM_CONSTRAINT
5729 A single character to be used instead of the default @code{'m'}
5730 character for general memory addresses. This defines the constraint
5731 letter which matches the memory addresses accepted by
5732 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P}. Define this macro if you want to
5733 support new address formats in your back end without changing the
5734 semantics of the @code{'m'} constraint. This is necessary in order to
5735 preserve functionality of inline assembly constructs using the
5736 @code{'m'} constraint.
5737 @end defmac
5738
5739 @defmac FIND_BASE_TERM (@var{x})
5740 A C expression to determine the base term of address @var{x},
5741 or to provide a simplified version of @var{x} from which @file{alias.c}
5742 can easily find the base term. This macro is used in only two places:
5743 @code{find_base_value} and @code{find_base_term} in @file{alias.c}.
5744
5745 It is always safe for this macro to not be defined. It exists so
5746 that alias analysis can understand machine-dependent addresses.
5747
5748 The typical use of this macro is to handle addresses containing
5749 a label_ref or symbol_ref within an UNSPEC@.
5750 @end defmac
5751
5752 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, machine_mode @var{mode})
5753 This hook is given an invalid memory address @var{x} for an
5754 operand of mode @var{mode} and should try to return a valid memory
5755 address.
5756
5757 @findex break_out_memory_refs
5758 @var{x} will always be the result of a call to @code{break_out_memory_refs},
5759 and @var{oldx} will be the operand that was given to that function to produce
5760 @var{x}.
5761
5762 The code of the hook should not alter the substructure of
5763 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5764 should return the new @var{x}.
5765
5766 It is not necessary for this hook to come up with a legitimate address,
5767 with the exception of native TLS addresses (@pxref{Emulated TLS}).
5768 The compiler has standard ways of doing so in all cases. In fact, if
5769 the target supports only emulated TLS, it
5770 is safe to omit this hook or make it return @var{x} if it cannot find
5771 a valid way to legitimize the address. But often a machine-dependent
5772 strategy can generate better code.
5773 @end deftypefn
5774
5775 @defmac LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS (@var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{opnum}, @var{type}, @var{ind_levels}, @var{win})
5776 A C compound statement that attempts to replace @var{x}, which is an address
5777 that needs reloading, with a valid memory address for an operand of mode
5778 @var{mode}. @var{win} will be a C statement label elsewhere in the code.
5779 It is not necessary to define this macro, but it might be useful for
5780 performance reasons.
5781
5782 For example, on the i386, it is sometimes possible to use a single
5783 reload register instead of two by reloading a sum of two pseudo
5784 registers into a register. On the other hand, for number of RISC
5785 processors offsets are limited so that often an intermediate address
5786 needs to be generated in order to address a stack slot. By defining
5787 @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} appropriately, the intermediate addresses
5788 generated for adjacent some stack slots can be made identical, and thus
5789 be shared.
5790
5791 @emph{Note}: This macro should be used with caution. It is necessary
5792 to know something of how reload works in order to effectively use this,
5793 and it is quite easy to produce macros that build in too much knowledge
5794 of reload internals.
5795
5796 @emph{Note}: This macro must be able to reload an address created by a
5797 previous invocation of this macro. If it fails to handle such addresses
5798 then the compiler may generate incorrect code or abort.
5799
5800 @findex push_reload
5801 The macro definition should use @code{push_reload} to indicate parts that
5802 need reloading; @var{opnum}, @var{type} and @var{ind_levels} are usually
5803 suitable to be passed unaltered to @code{push_reload}.
5804
5805 The code generated by this macro must not alter the substructure of
5806 @var{x}. If it transforms @var{x} into a more legitimate form, it
5807 should assign @var{x} (which will always be a C variable) a new value.
5808 This also applies to parts that you change indirectly by calling
5809 @code{push_reload}.
5810
5811 @findex strict_memory_address_p
5812 The macro definition may use @code{strict_memory_address_p} to test if
5813 the address has become legitimate.
5814
5815 @findex copy_rtx
5816 If you want to change only a part of @var{x}, one standard way of doing
5817 this is to use @code{copy_rtx}. Note, however, that it unshares only a
5818 single level of rtl. Thus, if the part to be changed is not at the
5819 top level, you'll need to replace first the top level.
5820 It is not necessary for this macro to come up with a legitimate
5821 address; but often a machine-dependent strategy can generate better code.
5822 @end defmac
5823
5824 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_MODE_DEPENDENT_ADDRESS_P (const_rtx @var{addr}, addr_space_t @var{addrspace})
5825 This hook returns @code{true} if memory address @var{addr} in address
5826 space @var{addrspace} can have
5827 different meanings depending on the machine mode of the memory
5828 reference it is used for or if the address is valid for some modes
5829 but not others.
5830
5831 Autoincrement and autodecrement addresses typically have mode-dependent
5832 effects because the amount of the increment or decrement is the size
5833 of the operand being addressed. Some machines have other mode-dependent
5834 addresses. Many RISC machines have no mode-dependent addresses.
5835
5836 You may assume that @var{addr} is a valid address for the machine.
5837
5838 The default version of this hook returns @code{false}.
5839 @end deftypefn
5840
5841 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_CONSTANT_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
5842 This hook returns true if @var{x} is a legitimate constant for a
5843 @var{mode}-mode immediate operand on the target machine. You can assume that
5844 @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not check this.
5845
5846 The default definition returns true.
5847 @end deftypefn
5848
5849 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DELEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x})
5850 This hook is used to undo the possibly obfuscating effects of the
5851 @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} and @code{LEGITIMIZE_RELOAD_ADDRESS} target
5852 macros. Some backend implementations of these macros wrap symbol
5853 references inside an @code{UNSPEC} rtx to represent PIC or similar
5854 addressing modes. This target hook allows GCC's optimizers to understand
5855 the semantics of these opaque @code{UNSPEC}s by converting them back
5856 into their original form.
5857 @end deftypefn
5858
5859 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CONST_NOT_OK_FOR_DEBUG_P (rtx @var{x})
5860 This hook should return true if @var{x} should not be emitted into
5861 debug sections.
5862 @end deftypefn
5863
5864 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_FORCE_CONST_MEM (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x})
5865 This hook should return true if @var{x} is of a form that cannot (or
5866 should not) be spilled to the constant pool. @var{mode} is the mode
5867 of @var{x}.
5868
5869 The default version of this hook returns false.
5870
5871 The primary reason to define this hook is to prevent reload from
5872 deciding that a non-legitimate constant would be better reloaded
5873 from the constant pool instead of spilling and reloading a register
5874 holding the constant. This restriction is often true of addresses
5875 of TLS symbols for various targets.
5876 @end deftypefn
5877
5878 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_CONSTANT_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_rtx @var{x})
5879 This hook should return true if pool entries for constant @var{x} can
5880 be placed in an @code{object_block} structure. @var{mode} is the mode
5881 of @var{x}.
5882
5883 The default version returns false for all constants.
5884 @end deftypefn
5885
5886 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BLOCKS_FOR_DECL_P (const_tree @var{decl})
5887 This hook should return true if pool entries for @var{decl} should
5888 be placed in an @code{object_block} structure.
5889
5890 The default version returns true for all decls.
5891 @end deftypefn
5892
5893 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_RECIPROCAL (tree @var{fndecl})
5894 This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements the
5895 reciprocal of the machine-specific builtin function @var{fndecl}, or
5896 @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5897 @end deftypefn
5898
5899 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MASK_FOR_LOAD (void)
5900 This hook should return the DECL of a function @var{f} that given an
5901 address @var{addr} as an argument returns a mask @var{m} that can be
5902 used to extract from two vectors the relevant data that resides in
5903 @var{addr} in case @var{addr} is not properly aligned.
5904
5905 The autovectorizer, when vectorizing a load operation from an address
5906 @var{addr} that may be unaligned, will generate two vector loads from
5907 the two aligned addresses around @var{addr}. It then generates a
5908 @code{REALIGN_LOAD} operation to extract the relevant data from the
5909 two loaded vectors. The first two arguments to @code{REALIGN_LOAD},
5910 @var{v1} and @var{v2}, are the two vectors, each of size @var{VS}, and
5911 the third argument, @var{OFF}, defines how the data will be extracted
5912 from these two vectors: if @var{OFF} is 0, then the returned vector is
5913 @var{v2}; otherwise, the returned vector is composed from the last
5914 @var{VS}-@var{OFF} elements of @var{v1} concatenated to the first
5915 @var{OFF} elements of @var{v2}.
5916
5917 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will generate a call
5918 to @var{f} (using the DECL tree that this hook returns) and will
5919 use the return value of @var{f} as the argument @var{OFF} to
5920 @code{REALIGN_LOAD}. Therefore, the mask @var{m} returned by @var{f}
5921 should comply with the semantics expected by @code{REALIGN_LOAD}
5922 described above.
5923 If this hook is not defined, then @var{addr} will be used as
5924 the argument @var{OFF} to @code{REALIGN_LOAD}, in which case the low
5925 log2(@var{VS}) @minus{} 1 bits of @var{addr} will be considered.
5926 @end deftypefn
5927
5928 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZATION_COST (enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{type_of_cost}, tree @var{vectype}, int @var{misalign})
5929 Returns cost of different scalar or vector statements for vectorization cost model.
5930 For vector memory operations the cost may depend on type (@var{vectype}) and
5931 misalignment value (@var{misalign}).
5932 @end deftypefn
5933
5934 @deftypefn {Target Hook} poly_uint64 TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT (const_tree @var{type})
5935 This hook returns the preferred alignment in bits for accesses to
5936 vectors of type @var{type} in vectorized code. This might be less than
5937 or greater than the ABI-defined value returned by
5938 @code{TARGET_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT}. It can be equal to the alignment of
5939 a single element, in which case the vectorizer will not try to optimize
5940 for alignment.
5941
5942 The default hook returns @code{TYPE_ALIGN (@var{type})}, which is
5943 correct for most targets.
5944 @end deftypefn
5945
5946 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VECTOR_ALIGNMENT_REACHABLE (const_tree @var{type}, bool @var{is_packed})
5947 Return true if vector alignment is reachable (by peeling N iterations) for the given scalar type @var{type}. @var{is_packed} is false if the scalar access using @var{type} is known to be naturally aligned.
5948 @end deftypefn
5949
5950 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_VEC_PERM_CONST (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{output}, rtx @var{in0}, rtx @var{in1}, const vec_perm_indices @var{&sel})
5951 This hook is used to test whether the target can permute up to two
5952 vectors of mode @var{mode} using the permutation vector @code{sel}, and
5953 also to emit such a permutation. In the former case @var{in0}, @var{in1}
5954 and @var{out} are all null. In the latter case @var{in0} and @var{in1} are
5955 the source vectors and @var{out} is the destination vector; all three are
5956 registers of mode @var{mode}. @var{in1} is the same as @var{in0} if
5957 @var{sel} describes a permutation on one vector instead of two.
5958
5959 Return true if the operation is possible, emitting instructions for it
5960 if rtxes are provided.
5961
5962 @cindex @code{vec_perm@var{m}} instruction pattern
5963 If the hook returns false for a mode with multibyte elements, GCC will
5964 try the equivalent byte operation. If that also fails, it will try forcing
5965 the selector into a register and using the @var{vec_perm@var{mode}}
5966 instruction pattern. There is no need for the hook to handle these two
5967 implementation approaches itself.
5968 @end deftypefn
5969
5970 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION (unsigned @var{code}, tree @var{dest_type}, tree @var{src_type})
5971 This hook should return the DECL of a function that implements conversion of the
5972 input vector of type @var{src_type} to type @var{dest_type}.
5973 The value of @var{code} is one of the enumerators in @code{enum tree_code} and
5974 specifies how the conversion is to be applied
5975 (truncation, rounding, etc.).
5976
5977 If this hook is defined, the autovectorizer will use the
5978 @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_CONVERSION} target hook when vectorizing
5979 conversion. Otherwise, it will return @code{NULL_TREE}.
5980 @end deftypefn
5981
5982 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION (unsigned @var{code}, tree @var{vec_type_out}, tree @var{vec_type_in})
5983 This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5984 vectorized variant of the function with the @code{combined_fn} code
5985 @var{code} or @code{NULL_TREE} if such a function is not available.
5986 The return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5987 @var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5988 @end deftypefn
5989
5990 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_MD_VECTORIZED_FUNCTION (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{vec_type_out}, tree @var{vec_type_in})
5991 This hook should return the decl of a function that implements the
5992 vectorized variant of target built-in function @code{fndecl}. The
5993 return type of the vectorized function shall be of vector type
5994 @var{vec_type_out} and the argument types should be @var{vec_type_in}.
5995 @end deftypefn
5996
5997 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_SUPPORT_VECTOR_MISALIGNMENT (machine_mode @var{mode}, const_tree @var{type}, int @var{misalignment}, bool @var{is_packed})
5998 This hook should return true if the target supports misaligned vector
5999 store/load of a specific factor denoted in the @var{misalignment}
6000 parameter. The vector store/load should be of machine mode @var{mode} and
6001 the elements in the vectors should be of type @var{type}. @var{is_packed}
6002 parameter is true if the memory access is defined in a packed struct.
6003 @end deftypefn
6004
6005 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE (scalar_mode @var{mode})
6006 This hook should return the preferred mode for vectorizing scalar
6007 mode @var{mode}. The default is
6008 equal to @code{word_mode}, because the vectorizer can do some
6009 transformations even in absence of specialized @acronym{SIMD} hardware.
6010 @end deftypefn
6011
6012 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_VECTORIZE_SPLIT_REDUCTION (machine_mode)
6013 This hook should return the preferred mode to split the final reduction
6014 step on @var{mode} to. The reduction is then carried out reducing upper
6015 against lower halves of vectors recursively until the specified mode is
6016 reached. The default is @var{mode} which means no splitting.
6017 @end deftypefn
6018
6019 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_AUTOVECTORIZE_VECTOR_SIZES (vector_sizes *@var{sizes})
6020 If the mode returned by @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE} is not
6021 the only one that is worth considering, this hook should add all suitable
6022 vector sizes to @var{sizes}, in order of decreasing preference. The first
6023 one should be the size of @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE}.
6024
6025 The hook does not need to do anything if the vector returned by
6026 @code{TARGET_VECTORIZE_PREFERRED_SIMD_MODE} is the only one relevant
6027 for autovectorization. The default implementation does nothing.
6028 @end deftypefn
6029
6030 @deftypefn {Target Hook} opt_machine_mode TARGET_VECTORIZE_GET_MASK_MODE (poly_uint64 @var{nunits}, poly_uint64 @var{length})
6031 A vector mask is a value that holds one boolean result for every element
6032 in a vector. This hook returns the machine mode that should be used to
6033 represent such a mask when the vector in question is @var{length} bytes
6034 long and contains @var{nunits} elements. The hook returns an empty
6035 @code{opt_machine_mode} if no such mode exists.
6036
6037 The default implementation returns the mode of an integer vector that
6038 is @var{length} bytes long and that contains @var{nunits} elements,
6039 if such a mode exists.
6040 @end deftypefn
6041
6042 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VECTORIZE_EMPTY_MASK_IS_EXPENSIVE (unsigned @var{ifn})
6043 This hook returns true if masked internal function @var{ifn} (really of
6044 type @code{internal_fn}) should be considered expensive when the mask is
6045 all zeros. GCC can then try to branch around the instruction instead.
6046 @end deftypefn
6047
6048 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST (struct loop *@var{loop_info})
6049 This hook should initialize target-specific data structures in preparation for modeling the costs of vectorizing a loop or basic block. The default allocates three unsigned integers for accumulating costs for the prologue, body, and epilogue of the loop or basic block. If @var{loop_info} is non-NULL, it identifies the loop being vectorized; otherwise a single block is being vectorized.
6050 @end deftypefn
6051
6052 @deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_VECTORIZE_ADD_STMT_COST (void *@var{data}, int @var{count}, enum vect_cost_for_stmt @var{kind}, struct _stmt_vec_info *@var{stmt_info}, int @var{misalign}, enum vect_cost_model_location @var{where})
6053 This hook should update the target-specific @var{data} in response to adding @var{count} copies of the given @var{kind} of statement to a loop or basic block. The default adds the builtin vectorizer cost for the copies of the statement to the accumulator specified by @var{where}, (the prologue, body, or epilogue) and returns the amount added. The return value should be viewed as a tentative cost that may later be revised.
6054 @end deftypefn
6055
6056 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_FINISH_COST (void *@var{data}, unsigned *@var{prologue_cost}, unsigned *@var{body_cost}, unsigned *@var{epilogue_cost})
6057 This hook should complete calculations of the cost of vectorizing a loop or basic block based on @var{data}, and return the prologue, body, and epilogue costs as unsigned integers. The default returns the value of the three accumulators.
6058 @end deftypefn
6059
6060 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_VECTORIZE_DESTROY_COST_DATA (void *@var{data})
6061 This hook should release @var{data} and any related data structures allocated by TARGET_VECTORIZE_INIT_COST. The default releases the accumulator.
6062 @end deftypefn
6063
6064 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_GATHER (const_tree @var{mem_vectype}, const_tree @var{index_type}, int @var{scale})
6065 Target builtin that implements vector gather operation. @var{mem_vectype}
6066 is the vector type of the load and @var{index_type} is scalar type of
6067 the index, scaled by @var{scale}.
6068 The default is @code{NULL_TREE} which means to not vectorize gather
6069 loads.
6070 @end deftypefn
6071
6072 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_VECTORIZE_BUILTIN_SCATTER (const_tree @var{vectype}, const_tree @var{index_type}, int @var{scale})
6073 Target builtin that implements vector scatter operation. @var{vectype}
6074 is the vector type of the store and @var{index_type} is scalar type of
6075 the index, scaled by @var{scale}.
6076 The default is @code{NULL_TREE} which means to not vectorize scatter
6077 stores.
6078 @end deftypefn
6079
6080 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_COMPUTE_VECSIZE_AND_SIMDLEN (struct cgraph_node *@var{}, struct cgraph_simd_clone *@var{}, @var{tree}, @var{int})
6081 This hook should set @var{vecsize_mangle}, @var{vecsize_int}, @var{vecsize_float}
6082 fields in @var{simd_clone} structure pointed by @var{clone_info} argument and also
6083 @var{simdlen} field if it was previously 0.
6084 The hook should return 0 if SIMD clones shouldn't be emitted,
6085 or number of @var{vecsize_mangle} variants that should be emitted.
6086 @end deftypefn
6087
6088 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_ADJUST (struct cgraph_node *@var{})
6089 This hook should add implicit @code{attribute(target("..."))} attribute
6090 to SIMD clone @var{node} if needed.
6091 @end deftypefn
6092
6093 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SIMD_CLONE_USABLE (struct cgraph_node *@var{})
6094 This hook should return -1 if SIMD clone @var{node} shouldn't be used
6095 in vectorized loops in current function, or non-negative number if it is
6096 usable. In that case, the smaller the number is, the more desirable it is
6097 to use it.
6098 @end deftypefn
6099
6100 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SIMT_VF (void)
6101 Return number of threads in SIMT thread group on the target.
6102 @end deftypefn
6103
6104 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_GOACC_VALIDATE_DIMS (tree @var{decl}, int *@var{dims}, int @var{fn_level}, unsigned @var{used})
6105 This hook should check the launch dimensions provided for an OpenACC
6106 compute region, or routine. Defaulted values are represented as -1
6107 and non-constant values as 0. The @var{fn_level} is negative for the
6108 function corresponding to the compute region. For a routine is is the
6109 outermost level at which partitioned execution may be spawned. The hook
6110 should verify non-default values. If DECL is NULL, global defaults
6111 are being validated and unspecified defaults should be filled in.
6112 Diagnostics should be issued as appropriate. Return
6113 true, if changes have been made. You must override this hook to
6114 provide dimensions larger than 1.
6115 @end deftypefn
6116
6117 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_GOACC_DIM_LIMIT (int @var{axis})
6118 This hook should return the maximum size of a particular dimension,
6119 or zero if unbounded.
6120 @end deftypefn
6121
6122 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_GOACC_FORK_JOIN (gcall *@var{call}, const int *@var{dims}, bool @var{is_fork})
6123 This hook can be used to convert IFN_GOACC_FORK and IFN_GOACC_JOIN
6124 function calls to target-specific gimple, or indicate whether they
6125 should be retained. It is executed during the oacc_device_lower pass.
6126 It should return true, if the call should be retained. It should
6127 return false, if it is to be deleted (either because target-specific
6128 gimple has been inserted before it, or there is no need for it).
6129 The default hook returns false, if there are no RTL expanders for them.
6130 @end deftypefn
6131
6132 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_GOACC_REDUCTION (gcall *@var{call})
6133 This hook is used by the oacc_transform pass to expand calls to the
6134 @var{GOACC_REDUCTION} internal function, into a sequence of gimple
6135 instructions. @var{call} is gimple statement containing the call to
6136 the function. This hook removes statement @var{call} after the
6137 expanded sequence has been inserted. This hook is also responsible
6138 for allocating any storage for reductions when necessary.
6139 @end deftypefn
6140
6141 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_PREFERRED_ELSE_VALUE (unsigned @var{ifn}, tree @var{type}, unsigned @var{nops}, tree *@var{ops})
6142 This hook returns the target's preferred final argument for a call
6143 to conditional internal function @var{ifn} (really of type
6144 @code{internal_fn}). @var{type} specifies the return type of the
6145 function and @var{ops} are the operands to the conditional operation,
6146 of which there are @var{nops}.
6147
6148 For example, if @var{ifn} is @code{IFN_COND_ADD}, the hook returns
6149 a value of type @var{type} that should be used when @samp{@var{ops}[0]}
6150 and @samp{@var{ops}[1]} are conditionally added together.
6151
6152 This hook is only relevant if the target supports conditional patterns
6153 like @code{cond_add@var{m}}. The default implementation returns a zero
6154 constant of type @var{type}.
6155 @end deftypefn
6156
6157 @node Anchored Addresses
6158 @section Anchored Addresses
6159 @cindex anchored addresses
6160 @cindex @option{-fsection-anchors}
6161
6162 GCC usually addresses every static object as a separate entity.
6163 For example, if we have:
6164
6165 @smallexample
6166 static int a, b, c;
6167 int foo (void) @{ return a + b + c; @}
6168 @end smallexample
6169
6170 the code for @code{foo} will usually calculate three separate symbolic
6171 addresses: those of @code{a}, @code{b} and @code{c}. On some targets,
6172 it would be better to calculate just one symbolic address and access
6173 the three variables relative to it. The equivalent pseudocode would
6174 be something like:
6175
6176 @smallexample
6177 int foo (void)
6178 @{
6179 register int *xr = &x;
6180 return xr[&a - &x] + xr[&b - &x] + xr[&c - &x];
6181 @}
6182 @end smallexample
6183
6184 (which isn't valid C). We refer to shared addresses like @code{x} as
6185 ``section anchors''. Their use is controlled by @option{-fsection-anchors}.
6186
6187 The hooks below describe the target properties that GCC needs to know
6188 in order to make effective use of section anchors. It won't use
6189 section anchors at all unless either @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}
6190 or @code{TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET} is set to a nonzero value.
6191
6192 @deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET
6193 The minimum offset that should be applied to a section anchor.
6194 On most targets, it should be the smallest offset that can be
6195 applied to a base register while still giving a legitimate address
6196 for every mode. The default value is 0.
6197 @end deftypevr
6198
6199 @deftypevr {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_MAX_ANCHOR_OFFSET
6200 Like @code{TARGET_MIN_ANCHOR_OFFSET}, but the maximum (inclusive)
6201 offset that should be applied to section anchors. The default
6202 value is 0.
6203 @end deftypevr
6204
6205 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ANCHOR (rtx @var{x})
6206 Write the assembly code to define section anchor @var{x}, which is a
6207 @code{SYMBOL_REF} for which @samp{SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})} is true.
6208 The hook is called with the assembly output position set to the beginning
6209 of @code{SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK (@var{x})}.
6210
6211 If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is available, the hook's default definition uses
6212 it to define the symbol as @samp{. + SYMBOL_REF_BLOCK_OFFSET (@var{x})}.
6213 If @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} is not available, the hook's default definition
6214 is @code{NULL}, which disables the use of section anchors altogether.
6215 @end deftypefn
6216
6217 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_ANCHORS_FOR_SYMBOL_P (const_rtx @var{x})
6218 Return true if GCC should attempt to use anchors to access @code{SYMBOL_REF}
6219 @var{x}. You can assume @samp{SYMBOL_REF_HAS_BLOCK_INFO_P (@var{x})} and
6220 @samp{!SYMBOL_REF_ANCHOR_P (@var{x})}.
6221
6222 The default version is correct for most targets, but you might need to
6223 intercept this hook to handle things like target-specific attributes
6224 or target-specific sections.
6225 @end deftypefn
6226
6227 @node Condition Code
6228 @section Condition Code Status
6229 @cindex condition code status
6230
6231 The macros in this section can be split in two families, according to the
6232 two ways of representing condition codes in GCC.
6233
6234 The first representation is the so called @code{(cc0)} representation
6235 (@pxref{Jump Patterns}), where all instructions can have an implicit
6236 clobber of the condition codes. The second is the condition code
6237 register representation, which provides better schedulability for
6238 architectures that do have a condition code register, but on which
6239 most instructions do not affect it. The latter category includes
6240 most RISC machines.
6241
6242 The implicit clobbering poses a strong restriction on the placement of
6243 the definition and use of the condition code. In the past the definition
6244 and use were always adjacent. However, recent changes to support trapping
6245 arithmatic may result in the definition and user being in different blocks.
6246 Thus, there may be a @code{NOTE_INSN_BASIC_BLOCK} between them. Additionally,
6247 the definition may be the source of exception handling edges.
6248
6249 These restrictions can prevent important
6250 optimizations on some machines. For example, on the IBM RS/6000, there
6251 is a delay for taken branches unless the condition code register is set
6252 three instructions earlier than the conditional branch. The instruction
6253 scheduler cannot perform this optimization if it is not permitted to
6254 separate the definition and use of the condition code register.
6255
6256 For this reason, it is possible and suggested to use a register to
6257 represent the condition code for new ports. If there is a specific
6258 condition code register in the machine, use a hard register. If the
6259 condition code or comparison result can be placed in any general register,
6260 or if there are multiple condition registers, use a pseudo register.
6261 Registers used to store the condition code value will usually have a mode
6262 that is in class @code{MODE_CC}.
6263
6264 Alternatively, you can use @code{BImode} if the comparison operator is
6265 specified already in the compare instruction. In this case, you are not
6266 interested in most macros in this section.
6267
6268 @menu
6269 * CC0 Condition Codes:: Old style representation of condition codes.
6270 * MODE_CC Condition Codes:: Modern representation of condition codes.
6271 @end menu
6272
6273 @node CC0 Condition Codes
6274 @subsection Representation of condition codes using @code{(cc0)}
6275 @findex cc0
6276
6277 @findex cc_status
6278 The file @file{conditions.h} defines a variable @code{cc_status} to
6279 describe how the condition code was computed (in case the interpretation of
6280 the condition code depends on the instruction that it was set by). This
6281 variable contains the RTL expressions on which the condition code is
6282 currently based, and several standard flags.
6283
6284 Sometimes additional machine-specific flags must be defined in the machine
6285 description header file. It can also add additional machine-specific
6286 information by defining @code{CC_STATUS_MDEP}.
6287
6288 @defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP
6289 C code for a data type which is used for declaring the @code{mdep}
6290 component of @code{cc_status}. It defaults to @code{int}.
6291
6292 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
6293 @end defmac
6294
6295 @defmac CC_STATUS_MDEP_INIT
6296 A C expression to initialize the @code{mdep} field to ``empty''.
6297 The default definition does nothing, since most machines don't use
6298 the field anyway. If you want to use the field, you should probably
6299 define this macro to initialize it.
6300
6301 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
6302 @end defmac
6303
6304 @defmac NOTICE_UPDATE_CC (@var{exp}, @var{insn})
6305 A C compound statement to set the components of @code{cc_status}
6306 appropriately for an insn @var{insn} whose body is @var{exp}. It is
6307 this macro's responsibility to recognize insns that set the condition
6308 code as a byproduct of other activity as well as those that explicitly
6309 set @code{(cc0)}.
6310
6311 This macro is not used on machines that do not use @code{cc0}.
6312
6313 If there are insns that do not set the condition code but do alter
6314 other machine registers, this macro must check to see whether they
6315 invalidate the expressions that the condition code is recorded as
6316 reflecting. For example, on the 68000, insns that store in address
6317 registers do not set the condition code, which means that usually
6318 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} can leave @code{cc_status} unaltered for such
6319 insns. But suppose that the previous insn set the condition code
6320 based on location @samp{a4@@(102)} and the current insn stores a new
6321 value in @samp{a4}. Although the condition code is not changed by
6322 this, it will no longer be true that it reflects the contents of
6323 @samp{a4@@(102)}. Therefore, @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must alter
6324 @code{cc_status} in this case to say that nothing is known about the
6325 condition code value.
6326
6327 The definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} must be prepared to deal
6328 with the results of peephole optimization: insns whose patterns are
6329 @code{parallel} RTXs containing various @code{reg}, @code{mem} or
6330 constants which are just the operands. The RTL structure of these
6331 insns is not sufficient to indicate what the insns actually do. What
6332 @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} should do when it sees one is just to run
6333 @code{CC_STATUS_INIT}.
6334
6335 A possible definition of @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC} is to call a function
6336 that looks at an attribute (@pxref{Insn Attributes}) named, for example,
6337 @samp{cc}. This avoids having detailed information about patterns in
6338 two places, the @file{md} file and in @code{NOTICE_UPDATE_CC}.
6339 @end defmac
6340
6341 @node MODE_CC Condition Codes
6342 @subsection Representation of condition codes using registers
6343 @findex CCmode
6344 @findex MODE_CC
6345
6346 @defmac SELECT_CC_MODE (@var{op}, @var{x}, @var{y})
6347 On many machines, the condition code may be produced by other instructions
6348 than compares, for example the branch can use directly the condition
6349 code set by a subtract instruction. However, on some machines
6350 when the condition code is set this way some bits (such as the overflow
6351 bit) are not set in the same way as a test instruction, so that a different
6352 branch instruction must be used for some conditional branches. When
6353 this happens, use the machine mode of the condition code register to
6354 record different formats of the condition code register. Modes can
6355 also be used to record which compare instruction (e.g.@: a signed or an
6356 unsigned comparison) produced the condition codes.
6357
6358 If other modes than @code{CCmode} are required, add them to
6359 @file{@var{machine}-modes.def} and define @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} to choose
6360 a mode given an operand of a compare. This is needed because the modes
6361 have to be chosen not only during RTL generation but also, for example,
6362 by instruction combination. The result of @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} should
6363 be consistent with the mode used in the patterns; for example to support
6364 the case of the add on the SPARC discussed above, we have the pattern
6365
6366 @smallexample
6367 (define_insn ""
6368 [(set (reg:CCNZ 0)
6369 (compare:CCNZ
6370 (plus:SI (match_operand:SI 0 "register_operand" "%r")
6371 (match_operand:SI 1 "arith_operand" "rI"))
6372 (const_int 0)))]
6373 ""
6374 "@dots{}")
6375 @end smallexample
6376
6377 @noindent
6378 together with a @code{SELECT_CC_MODE} that returns @code{CCNZmode}
6379 for comparisons whose argument is a @code{plus}:
6380
6381 @smallexample
6382 #define SELECT_CC_MODE(OP,X,Y) \
6383 (GET_MODE_CLASS (GET_MODE (X)) == MODE_FLOAT \
6384 ? ((OP == LT || OP == LE || OP == GT || OP == GE) \
6385 ? CCFPEmode : CCFPmode) \
6386 : ((GET_CODE (X) == PLUS || GET_CODE (X) == MINUS \
6387 || GET_CODE (X) == NEG || GET_CODE (x) == ASHIFT) \
6388 ? CCNZmode : CCmode))
6389 @end smallexample
6390
6391 Another reason to use modes is to retain information on which operands
6392 were used by the comparison; see @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE} later in
6393 this section.
6394
6395 You should define this macro if and only if you define extra CC modes
6396 in @file{@var{machine}-modes.def}.
6397 @end defmac
6398
6399 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CANONICALIZE_COMPARISON (int *@var{code}, rtx *@var{op0}, rtx *@var{op1}, bool @var{op0_preserve_value})
6400 On some machines not all possible comparisons are defined, but you can
6401 convert an invalid comparison into a valid one. For example, the Alpha
6402 does not have a @code{GT} comparison, but you can use an @code{LT}
6403 comparison instead and swap the order of the operands.
6404
6405 On such machines, implement this hook to do any required conversions.
6406 @var{code} is the initial comparison code and @var{op0} and @var{op1}
6407 are the left and right operands of the comparison, respectively. If
6408 @var{op0_preserve_value} is @code{true} the implementation is not
6409 allowed to change the value of @var{op0} since the value might be used
6410 in RTXs which aren't comparisons. E.g. the implementation is not
6411 allowed to swap operands in that case.
6412
6413 GCC will not assume that the comparison resulting from this macro is
6414 valid but will see if the resulting insn matches a pattern in the
6415 @file{md} file.
6416
6417 You need not to implement this hook if it would never change the
6418 comparison code or operands.
6419 @end deftypefn
6420
6421 @defmac REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})
6422 A C expression whose value is one if it is always safe to reverse a
6423 comparison whose mode is @var{mode}. If @code{SELECT_CC_MODE}
6424 can ever return @var{mode} for a floating-point inequality comparison,
6425 then @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} must be zero.
6426
6427 You need not define this macro if it would always returns zero or if the
6428 floating-point format is anything other than @code{IEEE_FLOAT_FORMAT}.
6429 For example, here is the definition used on the SPARC, where floating-point
6430 inequality comparisons are given either @code{CCFPEmode} or @code{CCFPmode}:
6431
6432 @smallexample
6433 #define REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE(MODE) \
6434 ((MODE) != CCFPEmode && (MODE) != CCFPmode)
6435 @end smallexample
6436 @end defmac
6437
6438 @defmac REVERSE_CONDITION (@var{code}, @var{mode})
6439 A C expression whose value is reversed condition code of the @var{code} for
6440 comparison done in CC_MODE @var{mode}. The macro is used only in case
6441 @code{REVERSIBLE_CC_MODE (@var{mode})} is nonzero. Define this macro in case
6442 machine has some non-standard way how to reverse certain conditionals. For
6443 instance in case all floating point conditions are non-trapping, compiler may
6444 freely convert unordered compares to ordered ones. Then definition may look
6445 like:
6446
6447 @smallexample
6448 #define REVERSE_CONDITION(CODE, MODE) \
6449 ((MODE) != CCFPmode ? reverse_condition (CODE) \
6450 : reverse_condition_maybe_unordered (CODE))
6451 @end smallexample
6452 @end defmac
6453
6454 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FIXED_CONDITION_CODE_REGS (unsigned int *@var{p1}, unsigned int *@var{p2})
6455 On targets which do not use @code{(cc0)}, and which use a hard
6456 register rather than a pseudo-register to hold condition codes, the
6457 regular CSE passes are often not able to identify cases in which the
6458 hard register is set to a common value. Use this hook to enable a
6459 small pass which optimizes such cases. This hook should return true
6460 to enable this pass, and it should set the integers to which its
6461 arguments point to the hard register numbers used for condition codes.
6462 When there is only one such register, as is true on most systems, the
6463 integer pointed to by @var{p2} should be set to
6464 @code{INVALID_REGNUM}.
6465
6466 The default version of this hook returns false.
6467 @end deftypefn
6468
6469 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_CC_MODES_COMPATIBLE (machine_mode @var{m1}, machine_mode @var{m2})
6470 On targets which use multiple condition code modes in class
6471 @code{MODE_CC}, it is sometimes the case that a comparison can be
6472 validly done in more than one mode. On such a system, define this
6473 target hook to take two mode arguments and to return a mode in which
6474 both comparisons may be validly done. If there is no such mode,
6475 return @code{VOIDmode}.
6476
6477 The default version of this hook checks whether the modes are the
6478 same. If they are, it returns that mode. If they are different, it
6479 returns @code{VOIDmode}.
6480 @end deftypefn
6481
6482 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_FLAGS_REGNUM
6483 If the target has a dedicated flags register, and it needs to use the post-reload comparison elimination pass, then this value should be set appropriately.
6484 @end deftypevr
6485
6486 @node Costs
6487 @section Describing Relative Costs of Operations
6488 @cindex costs of instructions
6489 @cindex relative costs
6490 @cindex speed of instructions
6491
6492 These macros let you describe the relative speed of various operations
6493 on the target machine.
6494
6495 @defmac REGISTER_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{from}, @var{to})
6496 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} from a
6497 register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes are
6498 expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}. A
6499 value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6500 that.
6501
6502 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6503 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6504 registers if they are not general registers.
6505
6506 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6507 hard registers, and if @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6508 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6509 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6510 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6511 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6512
6513 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6514 @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} instead.
6515 @end defmac
6516
6517 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST (machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{from}, reg_class_t @var{to})
6518 This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6519 from a register in class @var{from} to one in class @var{to}. The classes
6520 are expressed using the enumeration values such as @code{GENERAL_REGS}.
6521 A value of 2 is the default; other values are interpreted relative to
6522 that.
6523
6524 It is not required that the cost always equal 2 when @var{from} is the
6525 same as @var{to}; on some machines it is expensive to move between
6526 registers if they are not general registers.
6527
6528 If reload sees an insn consisting of a single @code{set} between two
6529 hard registers, and if @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST} applied to their
6530 classes returns a value of 2, reload does not check to ensure that the
6531 constraints of the insn are met. Setting a cost of other than 2 will
6532 allow reload to verify that the constraints are met. You should do this
6533 if the @samp{mov@var{m}} pattern's constraints do not allow such copying.
6534
6535 The default version of this function returns 2.
6536 @end deftypefn
6537
6538 @defmac MEMORY_MOVE_COST (@var{mode}, @var{class}, @var{in})
6539 A C expression for the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode} between a
6540 register of class @var{class} and memory; @var{in} is zero if the value
6541 is to be written to memory, nonzero if it is to be read in. This cost
6542 is relative to those in @code{REGISTER_MOVE_COST}. If moving between
6543 registers and memory is more expensive than between two registers, you
6544 should define this macro to express the relative cost.
6545
6546 If you do not define this macro, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6547 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6548 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6549 between memory and a register of @var{class} but the reload mechanism is
6550 more complex than copying via an intermediate, define this macro to
6551 reflect the actual cost of the move.
6552
6553 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6554 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6555 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6556 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
6557 4 is not correct for your machine, define this macro to add some other
6558 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6559 are the same as to this macro.
6560
6561 These macros are obsolete, new ports should use the target hook
6562 @code{TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST} instead.
6563 @end defmac
6564
6565 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MEMORY_MOVE_COST (machine_mode @var{mode}, reg_class_t @var{rclass}, bool @var{in})
6566 This target hook should return the cost of moving data of mode @var{mode}
6567 between a register of class @var{rclass} and memory; @var{in} is @code{false}
6568 if the value is to be written to memory, @code{true} if it is to be read in.
6569 This cost is relative to those in @code{TARGET_REGISTER_MOVE_COST}.
6570 If moving between registers and memory is more expensive than between two
6571 registers, you should add this target hook to express the relative cost.
6572
6573 If you do not add this target hook, GCC uses a default cost of 4 plus
6574 the cost of copying via a secondary reload register, if one is
6575 needed. If your machine requires a secondary reload register to copy
6576 between memory and a register of @var{rclass} but the reload mechanism is
6577 more complex than copying via an intermediate, use this target hook to
6578 reflect the actual cost of the move.
6579
6580 GCC defines the function @code{memory_move_secondary_cost} if
6581 secondary reloads are needed. It computes the costs due to copying via
6582 a secondary register. If your machine copies from memory using a
6583 secondary register in the conventional way but the default base value of
6584 4 is not correct for your machine, use this target hook to add some other
6585 value to the result of that function. The arguments to that function
6586 are the same as to this target hook.
6587 @end deftypefn
6588
6589 @defmac BRANCH_COST (@var{speed_p}, @var{predictable_p})
6590 A C expression for the cost of a branch instruction. A value of 1 is
6591 the default; other values are interpreted relative to that. Parameter
6592 @var{speed_p} is true when the branch in question should be optimized
6593 for speed. When it is false, @code{BRANCH_COST} should return a value
6594 optimal for code size rather than performance. @var{predictable_p} is
6595 true for well-predicted branches. On many architectures the
6596 @code{BRANCH_COST} can be reduced then.
6597 @end defmac
6598
6599 Here are additional macros which do not specify precise relative costs,
6600 but only that certain actions are more expensive than GCC would
6601 ordinarily expect.
6602
6603 @defmac SLOW_BYTE_ACCESS
6604 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if accessing less
6605 than a word of memory (i.e.@: a @code{char} or a @code{short}) is no
6606 faster than accessing a word of memory, i.e., if such access
6607 require more than one instruction or if there is no difference in cost
6608 between byte and (aligned) word loads.
6609
6610 When this macro is not defined, the compiler will access a field by
6611 finding the smallest containing object; when it is defined, a fullword
6612 load will be used if alignment permits. Unless bytes accesses are
6613 faster than word accesses, using word accesses is preferable since it
6614 may eliminate subsequent memory access if subsequent accesses occur to
6615 other fields in the same word of the structure, but to different bytes.
6616 @end defmac
6617
6618 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SLOW_UNALIGNED_ACCESS (machine_mode @var{mode}, unsigned int @var{align})
6619 This hook returns true if memory accesses described by the
6620 @var{mode} and @var{alignment} parameters have a cost many times greater
6621 than aligned accesses, for example if they are emulated in a trap handler.
6622 This hook is invoked only for unaligned accesses, i.e.@: when
6623 @code{@var{alignment} < GET_MODE_ALIGNMENT (@var{mode})}.
6624
6625 When this hook returns true, the compiler will act as if
6626 @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} were true when generating code for block
6627 moves. This can cause significantly more instructions to be produced.
6628 Therefore, do not make this hook return true if unaligned accesses only
6629 add a cycle or two to the time for a memory access.
6630
6631 The hook must return true whenever @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT} is true.
6632 The default implementation returns @code{STRICT_ALIGNMENT}.
6633 @end deftypefn
6634
6635 @defmac MOVE_RATIO (@var{speed})
6636 The threshold of number of scalar memory-to-memory move insns, @emph{below}
6637 which a sequence of insns should be generated instead of a
6638 string move insn or a library call. Increasing the value will always
6639 make code faster, but eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6640
6641 Note that on machines where the corresponding move insn is a
6642 @code{define_expand} that emits a sequence of insns, this macro counts
6643 the number of such sequences.
6644
6645 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6646 optimized for speed rather than size.
6647
6648 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6649 @end defmac
6650
6651 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_USE_BY_PIECES_INFRASTRUCTURE_P (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size}, unsigned int @var{alignment}, enum by_pieces_operation @var{op}, bool @var{speed_p})
6652 GCC will attempt several strategies when asked to copy between
6653 two areas of memory, or to set, clear or store to memory, for example
6654 when copying a @code{struct}. The @code{by_pieces} infrastructure
6655 implements such memory operations as a sequence of load, store or move
6656 insns. Alternate strategies are to expand the
6657 @code{movmem} or @code{setmem} optabs, to emit a library call, or to emit
6658 unit-by-unit, loop-based operations.
6659
6660 This target hook should return true if, for a memory operation with a
6661 given @var{size} and @var{alignment}, using the @code{by_pieces}
6662 infrastructure is expected to result in better code generation.
6663 Both @var{size} and @var{alignment} are measured in terms of storage
6664 units.
6665
6666 The parameter @var{op} is one of: @code{CLEAR_BY_PIECES},
6667 @code{MOVE_BY_PIECES}, @code{SET_BY_PIECES}, @code{STORE_BY_PIECES} or
6668 @code{COMPARE_BY_PIECES}. These describe the type of memory operation
6669 under consideration.
6670
6671 The parameter @var{speed_p} is true if the code is currently being
6672 optimized for speed rather than size.
6673
6674 Returning true for higher values of @var{size} can improve code generation
6675 for speed if the target does not provide an implementation of the
6676 @code{movmem} or @code{setmem} standard names, if the @code{movmem} or
6677 @code{setmem} implementation would be more expensive than a sequence of
6678 insns, or if the overhead of a library call would dominate that of
6679 the body of the memory operation.
6680
6681 Returning true for higher values of @code{size} may also cause an increase
6682 in code size, for example where the number of insns emitted to perform a
6683 move would be greater than that of a library call.
6684 @end deftypefn
6685
6686 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMPARE_BY_PIECES_BRANCH_RATIO (machine_mode @var{mode})
6687 When expanding a block comparison in MODE, gcc can try to reduce the
6688 number of branches at the expense of more memory operations. This hook
6689 allows the target to override the default choice. It should return the
6690 factor by which branches should be reduced over the plain expansion with
6691 one comparison per @var{mode}-sized piece. A port can also prevent a
6692 particular mode from being used for block comparisons by returning a
6693 negative number from this hook.
6694 @end deftypefn
6695
6696 @defmac MOVE_MAX_PIECES
6697 A C expression used by @code{move_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6698 a load or store used to copy memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX}.
6699 @end defmac
6700
6701 @defmac STORE_MAX_PIECES
6702 A C expression used by @code{store_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6703 a store used to memory is. Defaults to @code{MOVE_MAX_PIECES}, or two times
6704 the size of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, whichever is smaller.
6705 @end defmac
6706
6707 @defmac COMPARE_MAX_PIECES
6708 A C expression used by @code{compare_by_pieces} to determine the largest unit
6709 a load or store used to compare memory is. Defaults to
6710 @code{MOVE_MAX_PIECES}.
6711 @end defmac
6712
6713 @defmac CLEAR_RATIO (@var{speed})
6714 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6715 of insns should be generated to clear memory instead of a string clear insn
6716 or a library call. Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6717 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6718
6719 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6720 optimized for speed rather than size.
6721
6722 If you don't define this, a reasonable default is used.
6723 @end defmac
6724
6725 @defmac SET_RATIO (@var{speed})
6726 The threshold of number of scalar move insns, @emph{below} which a sequence
6727 of insns should be generated to set memory to a constant value, instead of
6728 a block set insn or a library call.
6729 Increasing the value will always make code faster, but
6730 eventually incurs high cost in increased code size.
6731
6732 The parameter @var{speed} is true if the code is currently being
6733 optimized for speed rather than size.
6734
6735 If you don't define this, it defaults to the value of @code{MOVE_RATIO}.
6736 @end defmac
6737
6738 @defmac USE_LOAD_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6739 A C expression used to determine whether a load postincrement is a good
6740 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6741 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6742 @end defmac
6743
6744 @defmac USE_LOAD_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6745 A C expression used to determine whether a load postdecrement is a good
6746 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6747 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6748 @end defmac
6749
6750 @defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6751 A C expression used to determine whether a load preincrement is a good
6752 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6753 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6754 @end defmac
6755
6756 @defmac USE_LOAD_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6757 A C expression used to determine whether a load predecrement is a good
6758 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6759 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6760 @end defmac
6761
6762 @defmac USE_STORE_POST_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6763 A C expression used to determine whether a store postincrement is a good
6764 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6765 @code{HAVE_POST_INCREMENT}.
6766 @end defmac
6767
6768 @defmac USE_STORE_POST_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6769 A C expression used to determine whether a store postdecrement is a good
6770 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6771 @code{HAVE_POST_DECREMENT}.
6772 @end defmac
6773
6774 @defmac USE_STORE_PRE_INCREMENT (@var{mode})
6775 This macro is used to determine whether a store preincrement is a good
6776 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6777 @code{HAVE_PRE_INCREMENT}.
6778 @end defmac
6779
6780 @defmac USE_STORE_PRE_DECREMENT (@var{mode})
6781 This macro is used to determine whether a store predecrement is a good
6782 thing to use for a given mode. Defaults to the value of
6783 @code{HAVE_PRE_DECREMENT}.
6784 @end defmac
6785
6786 @defmac NO_FUNCTION_CSE
6787 Define this macro to be true if it is as good or better to call a constant
6788 function address than to call an address kept in a register.
6789 @end defmac
6790
6791 @defmac LOGICAL_OP_NON_SHORT_CIRCUIT
6792 Define this macro if a non-short-circuit operation produced by
6793 @samp{fold_range_test ()} is optimal. This macro defaults to true if
6794 @code{BRANCH_COST} is greater than or equal to the value 2.
6795 @end defmac
6796
6797 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTAB_SUPPORTED_P (int @var{op}, machine_mode @var{mode1}, machine_mode @var{mode2}, optimization_type @var{opt_type})
6798 Return true if the optimizers should use optab @var{op} with
6799 modes @var{mode1} and @var{mode2} for optimization type @var{opt_type}.
6800 The optab is known to have an associated @file{.md} instruction
6801 whose C condition is true. @var{mode2} is only meaningful for conversion
6802 optabs; for direct optabs it is a copy of @var{mode1}.
6803
6804 For example, when called with @var{op} equal to @code{rint_optab} and
6805 @var{mode1} equal to @code{DFmode}, the hook should say whether the
6806 optimizers should use optab @code{rintdf2}.
6807
6808 The default hook returns true for all inputs.
6809 @end deftypefn
6810
6811 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_RTX_COSTS (rtx @var{x}, machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{outer_code}, int @var{opno}, int *@var{total}, bool @var{speed})
6812 This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL expressions.
6813
6814 The cost may depend on the precise form of the expression, which is
6815 available for examination in @var{x}, and the fact that @var{x} appears
6816 as operand @var{opno} of an expression with rtx code @var{outer_code}.
6817 That is, the hook can assume that there is some rtx @var{y} such
6818 that @samp{GET_CODE (@var{y}) == @var{outer_code}} and such that
6819 either (a) @samp{XEXP (@var{y}, @var{opno}) == @var{x}} or
6820 (b) @samp{XVEC (@var{y}, @var{opno})} contains @var{x}.
6821
6822 @var{mode} is @var{x}'s machine mode, or for cases like @code{const_int} that
6823 do not have a mode, the mode in which @var{x} is used.
6824
6825 In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6826 @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6827 instructions.
6828
6829 On entry to the hook, @code{*@var{total}} contains a default estimate
6830 for the cost of the expression. The hook should modify this value as
6831 necessary. Traditionally, the default costs are @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (5)}
6832 for multiplications, @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (7)} for division and modulus
6833 operations, and @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (1)} for all other operations.
6834
6835 When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6836 false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
6837 size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
6838
6839 The hook returns true when all subexpressions of @var{x} have been
6840 processed, and false when @code{rtx_cost} should recurse.
6841 @end deftypefn
6842
6843 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ADDRESS_COST (rtx @var{address}, machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as}, bool @var{speed})
6844 This hook computes the cost of an addressing mode that contains
6845 @var{address}. If not defined, the cost is computed from
6846 the @var{address} expression and the @code{TARGET_RTX_COST} hook.
6847
6848 For most CISC machines, the default cost is a good approximation of the
6849 true cost of the addressing mode. However, on RISC machines, all
6850 instructions normally have the same length and execution time. Hence
6851 all addresses will have equal costs.
6852
6853 In cases where more than one form of an address is known, the form with
6854 the lowest cost will be used. If multiple forms have the same, lowest,
6855 cost, the one that is the most complex will be used.
6856
6857 For example, suppose an address that is equal to the sum of a register
6858 and a constant is used twice in the same basic block. When this macro
6859 is not defined, the address will be computed in a register and memory
6860 references will be indirect through that register. On machines where
6861 the cost of the addressing mode containing the sum is no higher than
6862 that of a simple indirect reference, this will produce an additional
6863 instruction and possibly require an additional register. Proper
6864 specification of this macro eliminates this overhead for such machines.
6865
6866 This hook is never called with an invalid address.
6867
6868 On machines where an address involving more than one register is as
6869 cheap as an address computation involving only one register, defining
6870 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} to reflect this can cause two registers to
6871 be live over a region of code where only one would have been if
6872 @code{TARGET_ADDRESS_COST} were not defined in that manner. This effect
6873 should be considered in the definition of this macro. Equivalent costs
6874 should probably only be given to addresses with different numbers of
6875 registers on machines with lots of registers.
6876 @end deftypefn
6877
6878 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_INSN_COST (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, bool @var{speed})
6879 This target hook describes the relative costs of RTL instructions.
6880
6881 In implementing this hook, you can use the construct
6882 @code{COSTS_N_INSNS (@var{n})} to specify a cost equal to @var{n} fast
6883 instructions.
6884
6885 When optimizing for code size, i.e.@: when @code{speed} is
6886 false, this target hook should be used to estimate the relative
6887 size cost of an expression, again relative to @code{COSTS_N_INSNS}.
6888 @end deftypefn
6889
6890 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_MAX_NOCE_IFCVT_SEQ_COST (edge @var{e})
6891 This hook returns a value in the same units as @code{TARGET_RTX_COSTS},
6892 giving the maximum acceptable cost for a sequence generated by the RTL
6893 if-conversion pass when conditional execution is not available.
6894 The RTL if-conversion pass attempts to convert conditional operations
6895 that would require a branch to a series of unconditional operations and
6896 @code{mov@var{mode}cc} insns. This hook returns the maximum cost of the
6897 unconditional instructions and the @code{mov@var{mode}cc} insns.
6898 RTL if-conversion is cancelled if the cost of the converted sequence
6899 is greater than the value returned by this hook.
6900
6901 @code{e} is the edge between the basic block containing the conditional
6902 branch to the basic block which would be executed if the condition
6903 were true.
6904
6905 The default implementation of this hook uses the
6906 @code{max-rtl-if-conversion-[un]predictable} parameters if they are set,
6907 and uses a multiple of @code{BRANCH_COST} otherwise.
6908 @end deftypefn
6909
6910 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NOCE_CONVERSION_PROFITABLE_P (rtx_insn *@var{seq}, struct noce_if_info *@var{if_info})
6911 This hook returns true if the instruction sequence @code{seq} is a good
6912 candidate as a replacement for the if-convertible sequence described in
6913 @code{if_info}.
6914 @end deftypefn
6915
6916 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NO_SPECULATION_IN_DELAY_SLOTS_P (void)
6917 This predicate controls the use of the eager delay slot filler to disallow
6918 speculatively executed instructions being placed in delay slots. Targets
6919 such as certain MIPS architectures possess both branches with and without
6920 delay slots. As the eager delay slot filler can decrease performance,
6921 disabling it is beneficial when ordinary branches are available. Use of
6922 delay slot branches filled using the basic filler is often still desirable
6923 as the delay slot can hide a pipeline bubble.
6924 @end deftypefn
6925
6926 @deftypefn {Target Hook} HOST_WIDE_INT TARGET_ESTIMATED_POLY_VALUE (poly_int64 @var{val})
6927 Return an estimate of the runtime value of @var{val}, for use in
6928 things like cost calculations or profiling frequencies. The default
6929 implementation returns the lowest possible value of @var{val}.
6930 @end deftypefn
6931
6932 @node Scheduling
6933 @section Adjusting the Instruction Scheduler
6934
6935 The instruction scheduler may need a fair amount of machine-specific
6936 adjustment in order to produce good code. GCC provides several target
6937 hooks for this purpose. It is usually enough to define just a few of
6938 them: try the first ones in this list first.
6939
6940 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ISSUE_RATE (void)
6941 This hook returns the maximum number of instructions that can ever
6942 issue at the same time on the target machine. The default is one.
6943 Although the insn scheduler can define itself the possibility of issue
6944 an insn on the same cycle, the value can serve as an additional
6945 constraint to issue insns on the same simulated processor cycle (see
6946 hooks @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER} and @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}).
6947 This value must be constant over the entire compilation. If you need
6948 it to vary depending on what the instructions are, you must use
6949 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}.
6950 @end deftypefn
6951
6952 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{more})
6953 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled an insn
6954 from the ready list. It should return the number of insns which can
6955 still be issued in the current cycle. The default is
6956 @samp{@w{@var{more} - 1}} for insns other than @code{CLOBBER} and
6957 @code{USE}, which normally are not counted against the issue rate.
6958 You should define this hook if some insns take more machine resources
6959 than others, so that fewer insns can follow them in the same cycle.
6960 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6961 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6962 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{insn} is the instruction that
6963 was scheduled.
6964 @end deftypefn
6965
6966 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_COST (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{dep_type1}, rtx_insn *@var{dep_insn}, int @var{cost}, unsigned int @var{dw})
6967 This function corrects the value of @var{cost} based on the
6968 relationship between @var{insn} and @var{dep_insn} through a
6969 dependence of type dep_type, and strength @var{dw}. It should return the new
6970 value. The default is to make no adjustment to @var{cost}. This can be
6971 used for example to specify to the scheduler using the traditional pipeline
6972 description that an output- or anti-dependence does not incur the same cost
6973 as a data-dependence. If the scheduler using the automaton based pipeline
6974 description, the cost of anti-dependence is zero and the cost of
6975 output-dependence is maximum of one and the difference of latency
6976 times of the first and the second insns. If these values are not
6977 acceptable, you could use the hook to modify them too. See also
6978 @pxref{Processor pipeline description}.
6979 @end deftypefn
6980
6981 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_ADJUST_PRIORITY (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{priority})
6982 This hook adjusts the integer scheduling priority @var{priority} of
6983 @var{insn}. It should return the new priority. Increase the priority to
6984 execute @var{insn} earlier, reduce the priority to execute @var{insn}
6985 later. Do not define this hook if you do not need to adjust the
6986 scheduling priorities of insns.
6987 @end deftypefn
6988
6989 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn **@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
6990 This hook is executed by the scheduler after it has scheduled the ready
6991 list, to allow the machine description to reorder it (for example to
6992 combine two small instructions together on @samp{VLIW} machines).
6993 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any
6994 debug output to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
6995 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}. @var{ready} is a pointer to the ready
6996 list of instructions that are ready to be scheduled. @var{n_readyp} is
6997 a pointer to the number of elements in the ready list. The scheduler
6998 reads the ready list in reverse order, starting with
6999 @var{ready}[@var{*n_readyp} @minus{} 1] and going to @var{ready}[0]. @var{clock}
7000 is the timer tick of the scheduler. You may modify the ready list and
7001 the number of ready insns. The return value is the number of insns that
7002 can issue this cycle; normally this is just @code{issue_rate}. See also
7003 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2}.
7004 @end deftypefn
7005
7006 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REORDER2 (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn **@var{ready}, int *@var{n_readyp}, int @var{clock})
7007 Like @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}, but called at a different time. That
7008 function is called whenever the scheduler starts a new cycle. This one
7009 is called once per iteration over a cycle, immediately after
7010 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_VARIABLE_ISSUE}; it can reorder the ready list and
7011 return the number of insns to be scheduled in the same cycle. Defining
7012 this hook can be useful if there are frequent situations where
7013 scheduling one insn causes other insns to become ready in the same
7014 cycle. These other insns can then be taken into account properly.
7015 @end deftypefn
7016
7017 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_MACRO_FUSION_P (void)
7018 This hook is used to check whether target platform supports macro fusion.
7019 @end deftypefn
7020
7021 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_MACRO_FUSION_PAIR_P (rtx_insn *@var{prev}, rtx_insn *@var{curr})
7022 This hook is used to check whether two insns should be macro fused for
7023 a target microarchitecture. If this hook returns true for the given insn pair
7024 (@var{prev} and @var{curr}), the scheduler will put them into a sched
7025 group, and they will not be scheduled apart. The two insns will be either
7026 two SET insns or a compare and a conditional jump and this hook should
7027 validate any dependencies needed to fuse the two insns together.
7028 @end deftypefn
7029
7030 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DEPENDENCIES_EVALUATION_HOOK (rtx_insn *@var{head}, rtx_insn *@var{tail})
7031 This hook is called after evaluation forward dependencies of insns in
7032 chain given by two parameter values (@var{head} and @var{tail}
7033 correspondingly) but before insns scheduling of the insn chain. For
7034 example, it can be used for better insn classification if it requires
7035 analysis of dependencies. This hook can use backward and forward
7036 dependencies of the insn scheduler because they are already
7037 calculated.
7038 @end deftypefn
7039
7040 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{max_ready})
7041 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the beginning of each block of
7042 instructions that are to be scheduled. @var{file} is either a null
7043 pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to. @var{verbose}
7044 is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
7045 @var{max_ready} is the maximum number of insns in the current scheduling
7046 region that can be live at the same time. This can be used to allocate
7047 scratch space if it is needed, e.g.@: by @samp{TARGET_SCHED_REORDER}.
7048 @end deftypefn
7049
7050 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
7051 This hook is executed by the scheduler at the end of each block of
7052 instructions that are to be scheduled. It can be used to perform
7053 cleanup of any actions done by the other scheduling hooks. @var{file}
7054 is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output
7055 to. @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by
7056 @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
7057 @end deftypefn
7058
7059 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose}, int @var{old_max_uid})
7060 This hook is executed by the scheduler after function level initializations.
7061 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
7062 @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
7063 @var{old_max_uid} is the maximum insn uid when scheduling begins.
7064 @end deftypefn
7065
7066 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FINISH_GLOBAL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{verbose})
7067 This is the cleanup hook corresponding to @code{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_GLOBAL}.
7068 @var{file} is either a null pointer, or a stdio stream to write any debug output to.
7069 @var{verbose} is the verbose level provided by @option{-fsched-verbose-@var{n}}.
7070 @end deftypefn
7071
7072 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
7073 The hook returns an RTL insn. The automaton state used in the
7074 pipeline hazard recognizer is changed as if the insn were scheduled
7075 when the new simulated processor cycle starts. Usage of the hook may
7076 simplify the automaton pipeline description for some @acronym{VLIW}
7077 processors. If the hook is defined, it is used only for the automaton
7078 based pipeline description. The default is not to change the state
7079 when the new simulated processor cycle starts.
7080 @end deftypefn
7081
7082 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN (void)
7083 The hook can be used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
7084 @end deftypefn
7085
7086 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {rtx_insn *} TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
7087 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
7088 to changed the state as if the insn were scheduled when the new
7089 simulated processor cycle finishes.
7090 @end deftypefn
7091
7092 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN (void)
7093 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_INIT_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but
7094 used to initialize data used by the previous hook.
7095 @end deftypefn
7096
7097 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
7098 The hook to notify target that the current simulated cycle is about to finish.
7099 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_PRE_CYCLE_INSN} but used
7100 to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
7101 state on a single insn is not enough.
7102 @end deftypefn
7103
7104 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_ADVANCE_CYCLE (void)
7105 The hook to notify target that new simulated cycle has just started.
7106 The hook is analogous to @samp{TARGET_SCHED_DFA_POST_CYCLE_INSN} but used
7107 to change the state in more complicated situations - e.g., when advancing
7108 state on a single insn is not enough.
7109 @end deftypefn
7110
7111 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD (void)
7112 This hook controls better choosing an insn from the ready insn queue
7113 for the @acronym{DFA}-based insn scheduler. Usually the scheduler
7114 chooses the first insn from the queue. If the hook returns a positive
7115 value, an additional scheduler code tries all permutations of
7116 @samp{TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD ()}
7117 subsequent ready insns to choose an insn whose issue will result in
7118 maximal number of issued insns on the same cycle. For the
7119 @acronym{VLIW} processor, the code could actually solve the problem of
7120 packing simple insns into the @acronym{VLIW} insn. Of course, if the
7121 rules of @acronym{VLIW} packing are described in the automaton.
7122
7123 This code also could be used for superscalar @acronym{RISC}
7124 processors. Let us consider a superscalar @acronym{RISC} processor
7125 with 3 pipelines. Some insns can be executed in pipelines @var{A} or
7126 @var{B}, some insns can be executed only in pipelines @var{B} or
7127 @var{C}, and one insn can be executed in pipeline @var{B}. The
7128 processor may issue the 1st insn into @var{A} and the 2nd one into
7129 @var{B}. In this case, the 3rd insn will wait for freeing @var{B}
7130 until the next cycle. If the scheduler issues the 3rd insn the first,
7131 the processor could issue all 3 insns per cycle.
7132
7133 Actually this code demonstrates advantages of the automaton based
7134 pipeline hazard recognizer. We try quickly and easy many insn
7135 schedules to choose the best one.
7136
7137 The default is no multipass scheduling.
7138 @end deftypefn
7139
7140 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_DFA_LOOKAHEAD_GUARD (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{ready_index})
7141
7142 This hook controls what insns from the ready insn queue will be
7143 considered for the multipass insn scheduling. If the hook returns
7144 zero for @var{insn}, the insn will be considered in multipass scheduling.
7145 Positive return values will remove @var{insn} from consideration on
7146 the current round of multipass scheduling.
7147 Negative return values will remove @var{insn} from consideration for given
7148 number of cycles.
7149 Backends should be careful about returning non-zero for highest priority
7150 instruction at position 0 in the ready list. @var{ready_index} is passed
7151 to allow backends make correct judgements.
7152
7153 The default is that any ready insns can be chosen to be issued.
7154 @end deftypefn
7155
7156 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BEGIN (void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, bool @var{first_cycle_insn_p})
7157 This hook prepares the target backend for a new round of multipass
7158 scheduling.
7159 @end deftypefn
7160
7161 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_ISSUE (void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, const void *@var{prev_data})
7162 This hook is called when multipass scheduling evaluates instruction INSN.
7163 @end deftypefn
7164
7165 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_BACKTRACK (const void *@var{data}, signed char *@var{ready_try}, int @var{n_ready})
7166 This is called when multipass scheduling backtracks from evaluation of
7167 an instruction.
7168 @end deftypefn
7169
7170 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_END (const void *@var{data})
7171 This hook notifies the target about the result of the concluded current
7172 round of multipass scheduling.
7173 @end deftypefn
7174
7175 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_INIT (void *@var{data})
7176 This hook initializes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
7177 @end deftypefn
7178
7179 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FIRST_CYCLE_MULTIPASS_FINI (void *@var{data})
7180 This hook finalizes target-specific data used in multipass scheduling.
7181 @end deftypefn
7182
7183 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_DFA_NEW_CYCLE (FILE *@var{dump}, int @var{verbose}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{last_clock}, int @var{clock}, int *@var{sort_p})
7184 This hook is called by the insn scheduler before issuing @var{insn}
7185 on cycle @var{clock}. If the hook returns nonzero,
7186 @var{insn} is not issued on this processor cycle. Instead,
7187 the processor cycle is advanced. If *@var{sort_p}
7188 is zero, the insn ready queue is not sorted on the new cycle
7189 start as usually. @var{dump} and @var{verbose} specify the file and
7190 verbosity level to use for debugging output.
7191 @var{last_clock} and @var{clock} are, respectively, the
7192 processor cycle on which the previous insn has been issued,
7193 and the current processor cycle.
7194 @end deftypefn
7195
7196 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_IS_COSTLY_DEPENDENCE (struct _dep *@var{_dep}, int @var{cost}, int @var{distance})
7197 This hook is used to define which dependences are considered costly by
7198 the target, so costly that it is not advisable to schedule the insns that
7199 are involved in the dependence too close to one another. The parameters
7200 to this hook are as follows: The first parameter @var{_dep} is the dependence
7201 being evaluated. The second parameter @var{cost} is the cost of the
7202 dependence as estimated by the scheduler, and the third
7203 parameter @var{distance} is the distance in cycles between the two insns.
7204 The hook returns @code{true} if considering the distance between the two
7205 insns the dependence between them is considered costly by the target,
7206 and @code{false} otherwise.
7207
7208 Defining this hook can be useful in multiple-issue out-of-order machines,
7209 where (a) it's practically hopeless to predict the actual data/resource
7210 delays, however: (b) there's a better chance to predict the actual grouping
7211 that will be formed, and (c) correctly emulating the grouping can be very
7212 important. In such targets one may want to allow issuing dependent insns
7213 closer to one another---i.e., closer than the dependence distance; however,
7214 not in cases of ``costly dependences'', which this hooks allows to define.
7215 @end deftypefn
7216
7217 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_H_I_D_EXTENDED (void)
7218 This hook is called by the insn scheduler after emitting a new instruction to
7219 the instruction stream. The hook notifies a target backend to extend its
7220 per instruction data structures.
7221 @end deftypefn
7222
7223 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_SCHED_ALLOC_SCHED_CONTEXT (void)
7224 Return a pointer to a store large enough to hold target scheduling context.
7225 @end deftypefn
7226
7227 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_INIT_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc}, bool @var{clean_p})
7228 Initialize store pointed to by @var{tc} to hold target scheduling context.
7229 It @var{clean_p} is true then initialize @var{tc} as if scheduler is at the
7230 beginning of the block. Otherwise, copy the current context into @var{tc}.
7231 @end deftypefn
7232
7233 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
7234 Copy target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc} to the current context.
7235 @end deftypefn
7236
7237 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_CLEAR_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
7238 Deallocate internal data in target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
7239 @end deftypefn
7240
7241 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FREE_SCHED_CONTEXT (void *@var{tc})
7242 Deallocate a store for target scheduling context pointed to by @var{tc}.
7243 @end deftypefn
7244
7245 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SPECULATE_INSN (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, unsigned int @var{dep_status}, rtx *@var{new_pat})
7246 This hook is called by the insn scheduler when @var{insn} has only
7247 speculative dependencies and therefore can be scheduled speculatively.
7248 The hook is used to check if the pattern of @var{insn} has a speculative
7249 version and, in case of successful check, to generate that speculative
7250 pattern. The hook should return 1, if the instruction has a speculative form,
7251 or @minus{}1, if it doesn't. @var{request} describes the type of requested
7252 speculation. If the return value equals 1 then @var{new_pat} is assigned
7253 the generated speculative pattern.
7254 @end deftypefn
7255
7256 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_NEEDS_BLOCK_P (unsigned int @var{dep_status})
7257 This hook is called by the insn scheduler during generation of recovery code
7258 for @var{insn}. It should return @code{true}, if the corresponding check
7259 instruction should branch to recovery code, or @code{false} otherwise.
7260 @end deftypefn
7261
7262 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SCHED_GEN_SPEC_CHECK (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, rtx_insn *@var{label}, unsigned int @var{ds})
7263 This hook is called by the insn scheduler to generate a pattern for recovery
7264 check instruction. If @var{mutate_p} is zero, then @var{insn} is a
7265 speculative instruction for which the check should be generated.
7266 @var{label} is either a label of a basic block, where recovery code should
7267 be emitted, or a null pointer, when requested check doesn't branch to
7268 recovery code (a simple check). If @var{mutate_p} is nonzero, then
7269 a pattern for a branchy check corresponding to a simple check denoted by
7270 @var{insn} should be generated. In this case @var{label} can't be null.
7271 @end deftypefn
7272
7273 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_SET_SCHED_FLAGS (struct spec_info_def *@var{spec_info})
7274 This hook is used by the insn scheduler to find out what features should be
7275 enabled/used.
7276 The structure *@var{spec_info} should be filled in by the target.
7277 The structure describes speculation types that can be used in the scheduler.
7278 @end deftypefn
7279
7280 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_CAN_SPECULATE_INSN (rtx_insn *@var{insn})
7281 Some instructions should never be speculated by the schedulers, usually
7282 because the instruction is too expensive to get this wrong. Often such
7283 instructions have long latency, and often they are not fully modeled in the
7284 pipeline descriptions. This hook should return @code{false} if @var{insn}
7285 should not be speculated.
7286 @end deftypefn
7287
7288 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_SMS_RES_MII (struct ddg *@var{g})
7289 This hook is called by the swing modulo scheduler to calculate a
7290 resource-based lower bound which is based on the resources available in
7291 the machine and the resources required by each instruction. The target
7292 backend can use @var{g} to calculate such bound. A very simple lower
7293 bound will be used in case this hook is not implemented: the total number
7294 of instructions divided by the issue rate.
7295 @end deftypefn
7296
7297 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{x})
7298 This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It returns true if dispatch scheduling
7299 is supported in hardware and the condition specified in the parameter is true.
7300 @end deftypefn
7301
7302 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_DISPATCH_DO (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{x})
7303 This hook is called by Haifa Scheduler. It performs the operation specified
7304 in its second parameter.
7305 @end deftypefn
7306
7307 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SCHED_EXPOSED_PIPELINE
7308 True if the processor has an exposed pipeline, which means that not just
7309 the order of instructions is important for correctness when scheduling, but
7310 also the latencies of operations.
7311 @end deftypevr
7312
7313 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_SCHED_REASSOCIATION_WIDTH (unsigned int @var{opc}, machine_mode @var{mode})
7314 This hook is called by tree reassociator to determine a level of
7315 parallelism required in output calculations chain.
7316 @end deftypefn
7317
7318 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SCHED_FUSION_PRIORITY (rtx_insn *@var{insn}, int @var{max_pri}, int *@var{fusion_pri}, int *@var{pri})
7319 This hook is called by scheduling fusion pass. It calculates fusion
7320 priorities for each instruction passed in by parameter. The priorities
7321 are returned via pointer parameters.
7322
7323 @var{insn} is the instruction whose priorities need to be calculated.
7324 @var{max_pri} is the maximum priority can be returned in any cases.
7325 @var{fusion_pri} is the pointer parameter through which @var{insn}'s
7326 fusion priority should be calculated and returned.
7327 @var{pri} is the pointer parameter through which @var{insn}'s priority
7328 should be calculated and returned.
7329
7330 Same @var{fusion_pri} should be returned for instructions which should
7331 be scheduled together. Different @var{pri} should be returned for
7332 instructions with same @var{fusion_pri}. @var{fusion_pri} is the major
7333 sort key, @var{pri} is the minor sort key. All instructions will be
7334 scheduled according to the two priorities. All priorities calculated
7335 should be between 0 (exclusive) and @var{max_pri} (inclusive). To avoid
7336 false dependencies, @var{fusion_pri} of instructions which need to be
7337 scheduled together should be smaller than @var{fusion_pri} of irrelevant
7338 instructions.
7339
7340 Given below example:
7341
7342 @smallexample
7343 ldr r10, [r1, 4]
7344 add r4, r4, r10
7345 ldr r15, [r2, 8]
7346 sub r5, r5, r15
7347 ldr r11, [r1, 0]
7348 add r4, r4, r11
7349 ldr r16, [r2, 12]
7350 sub r5, r5, r16
7351 @end smallexample
7352
7353 On targets like ARM/AArch64, the two pairs of consecutive loads should be
7354 merged. Since peephole2 pass can't help in this case unless consecutive
7355 loads are actually next to each other in instruction flow. That's where
7356 this scheduling fusion pass works. This hook calculates priority for each
7357 instruction based on its fustion type, like:
7358
7359 @smallexample
7360 ldr r10, [r1, 4] ; fusion_pri=99, pri=96
7361 add r4, r4, r10 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
7362 ldr r15, [r2, 8] ; fusion_pri=98, pri=92
7363 sub r5, r5, r15 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
7364 ldr r11, [r1, 0] ; fusion_pri=99, pri=100
7365 add r4, r4, r11 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
7366 ldr r16, [r2, 12] ; fusion_pri=98, pri=88
7367 sub r5, r5, r16 ; fusion_pri=100, pri=100
7368 @end smallexample
7369
7370 Scheduling fusion pass then sorts all ready to issue instructions according
7371 to the priorities. As a result, instructions of same fusion type will be
7372 pushed together in instruction flow, like:
7373
7374 @smallexample
7375 ldr r11, [r1, 0]
7376 ldr r10, [r1, 4]
7377 ldr r15, [r2, 8]
7378 ldr r16, [r2, 12]
7379 add r4, r4, r10
7380 sub r5, r5, r15
7381 add r4, r4, r11
7382 sub r5, r5, r16
7383 @end smallexample
7384
7385 Now peephole2 pass can simply merge the two pairs of loads.
7386
7387 Since scheduling fusion pass relies on peephole2 to do real fusion
7388 work, it is only enabled by default when peephole2 is in effect.
7389
7390 This is firstly introduced on ARM/AArch64 targets, please refer to
7391 the hook implementation for how different fusion types are supported.
7392 @end deftypefn
7393
7394 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_EXPAND_DIVMOD_LIBFUNC (rtx @var{libfunc}, machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{op0}, rtx @var{op1}, rtx *@var{quot}, rtx *@var{rem})
7395 Define this hook for enabling divmod transform if the port does not have
7396 hardware divmod insn but defines target-specific divmod libfuncs.
7397 @end deftypefn
7398
7399 @node Sections
7400 @section Dividing the Output into Sections (Texts, Data, @dots{})
7401 @c the above section title is WAY too long. maybe cut the part between
7402 @c the (...)? --mew 10feb93
7403
7404 An object file is divided into sections containing different types of
7405 data. In the most common case, there are three sections: the @dfn{text
7406 section}, which holds instructions and read-only data; the @dfn{data
7407 section}, which holds initialized writable data; and the @dfn{bss
7408 section}, which holds uninitialized data. Some systems have other kinds
7409 of sections.
7410
7411 @file{varasm.c} provides several well-known sections, such as
7412 @code{text_section}, @code{data_section} and @code{bss_section}.
7413 The normal way of controlling a @code{@var{foo}_section} variable
7414 is to define the associated @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macro,
7415 as described below. The macros are only read once, when @file{varasm.c}
7416 initializes itself, so their values must be run-time constants.
7417 They may however depend on command-line flags.
7418
7419 @emph{Note:} Some run-time files, such @file{crtstuff.c}, also make
7420 use of the @code{@var{FOO}_SECTION_ASM_OP} macros, and expect them
7421 to be string literals.
7422
7423 Some assemblers require a different string to be written every time a
7424 section is selected. If your assembler falls into this category, you
7425 should define the @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS} hook and use
7426 @code{get_unnamed_section} to set up the sections.
7427
7428 You must always create a @code{text_section}, either by defining
7429 @code{TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or by initializing @code{text_section}
7430 in @code{TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS}. The same is true of
7431 @code{data_section} and @code{DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP}. If you do not
7432 create a distinct @code{readonly_data_section}, the default is to
7433 reuse @code{text_section}.
7434
7435 All the other @file{varasm.c} sections are optional, and are null
7436 if the target does not provide them.
7437
7438 @defmac TEXT_SECTION_ASM_OP
7439 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
7440 assembler operation that should precede instructions and read-only data.
7441 Normally @code{"\t.text"} is right.
7442 @end defmac
7443
7444 @defmac HOT_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
7445 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing most
7446 frequently executed functions of the program. If not defined, GCC will provide
7447 a default definition if the target supports named sections.
7448 @end defmac
7449
7450 @defmac UNLIKELY_EXECUTED_TEXT_SECTION_NAME
7451 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing unlikely
7452 executed functions in the program.
7453 @end defmac
7454
7455 @defmac DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
7456 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
7457 assembler operation to identify the following data as writable initialized
7458 data. Normally @code{"\t.data"} is right.
7459 @end defmac
7460
7461 @defmac SDATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
7462 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7463 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7464 initialized, writable small data.
7465 @end defmac
7466
7467 @defmac READONLY_DATA_SECTION_ASM_OP
7468 A C expression whose value is a string, including spacing, containing the
7469 assembler operation to identify the following data as read-only initialized
7470 data.
7471 @end defmac
7472
7473 @defmac BSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
7474 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7475 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7476 uninitialized global data. If not defined, and
7477 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS} not defined,
7478 uninitialized global data will be output in the data section if
7479 @option{-fno-common} is passed, otherwise @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} will be
7480 used.
7481 @end defmac
7482
7483 @defmac SBSS_SECTION_ASM_OP
7484 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7485 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7486 uninitialized, writable small data.
7487 @end defmac
7488
7489 @defmac TLS_COMMON_ASM_OP
7490 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string containing the
7491 assembler operation to identify the following data as thread-local
7492 common data. The default is @code{".tls_common"}.
7493 @end defmac
7494
7495 @defmac TLS_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
7496 If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
7497 containing the flag used to mark a section as a TLS section. The
7498 default is @code{'T'}.
7499 @end defmac
7500
7501 @defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
7502 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7503 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7504 initialization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
7505 not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{init_section}
7506 variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
7507 @end defmac
7508
7509 @defmac FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP
7510 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7511 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7512 finalization code. If not defined, GCC will assume such a section does
7513 not exist. This section has no corresponding @code{fini_section}
7514 variable; it is used entirely in runtime code.
7515 @end defmac
7516
7517 @defmac INIT_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
7518 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7519 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7520 part of the @code{.init_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
7521 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
7522 both this macro and @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
7523 @end defmac
7524
7525 @defmac FINI_ARRAY_SECTION_ASM_OP
7526 If defined, a C expression whose value is a string, including spacing,
7527 containing the assembler operation to identify the following data as
7528 part of the @code{.fini_array} (or equivalent) section. If not
7529 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. Do not define
7530 both this macro and @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
7531 @end defmac
7532
7533 @defmac MACH_DEP_SECTION_ASM_FLAG
7534 If defined, a C expression whose value is a character constant
7535 containing the flag used to mark a machine-dependent section. This
7536 corresponds to the @code{SECTION_MACH_DEP} section flag.
7537 @end defmac
7538
7539 @defmac CRT_CALL_STATIC_FUNCTION (@var{section_op}, @var{function})
7540 If defined, an ASM statement that switches to a different section
7541 via @var{section_op}, calls @var{function}, and switches back to
7542 the text section. This is used in @file{crtstuff.c} if
7543 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} or @code{FINI_SECTION_ASM_OP} to calls
7544 to initialization and finalization functions from the init and fini
7545 sections. By default, this macro uses a simple function call. Some
7546 ports need hand-crafted assembly code to avoid dependencies on
7547 registers initialized in the function prologue or to ensure that
7548 constant pools don't end up too far way in the text section.
7549 @end defmac
7550
7551 @defmac TARGET_LIBGCC_SDATA_SECTION
7552 If defined, a string which names the section into which small
7553 variables defined in crtstuff and libgcc should go. This is useful
7554 when the target has options for optimizing access to small data, and
7555 you want the crtstuff and libgcc routines to be conservative in what
7556 they expect of your application yet liberal in what your application
7557 expects. For example, for targets with a @code{.sdata} section (like
7558 MIPS), you could compile crtstuff with @code{-G 0} so that it doesn't
7559 require small data support from your application, but use this macro
7560 to put small data into @code{.sdata} so that your application can
7561 access these variables whether it uses small data or not.
7562 @end defmac
7563
7564 @defmac FORCE_CODE_SECTION_ALIGN
7565 If defined, an ASM statement that aligns a code section to some
7566 arbitrary boundary. This is used to force all fragments of the
7567 @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections to have to same alignment
7568 and thus prevent the linker from having to add any padding.
7569 @end defmac
7570
7571 @defmac JUMP_TABLES_IN_TEXT_SECTION
7572 Define this macro to be an expression with a nonzero value if jump
7573 tables (for @code{tablejump} insns) should be output in the text
7574 section, along with the assembler instructions. Otherwise, the
7575 readonly data section is used.
7576
7577 This macro is irrelevant if there is no separate readonly data section.
7578 @end defmac
7579
7580 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INIT_SECTIONS (void)
7581 Define this hook if you need to do something special to set up the
7582 @file{varasm.c} sections, or if your target has some special sections
7583 of its own that you need to create.
7584
7585 GCC calls this hook after processing the command line, but before writing
7586 any assembly code, and before calling any of the section-returning hooks
7587 described below.
7588 @end deftypefn
7589
7590 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RELOC_RW_MASK (void)
7591 Return a mask describing how relocations should be treated when
7592 selecting sections. Bit 1 should be set if global relocations
7593 should be placed in a read-write section; bit 0 should be set if
7594 local relocations should be placed in a read-write section.
7595
7596 The default version of this function returns 3 when @option{-fpic}
7597 is in effect, and 0 otherwise. The hook is typically redefined
7598 when the target cannot support (some kinds of) dynamic relocations
7599 in read-only sections even in executables.
7600 @end deftypefn
7601
7602 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_GENERATE_PIC_ADDR_DIFF_VEC (void)
7603 Return true to generate ADDR_DIF_VEC table
7604 or false to generate ADDR_VEC table for jumps in case of -fPIC.
7605
7606 The default version of this function returns true if flag_pic
7607 equals true and false otherwise
7608 @end deftypefn
7609
7610 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION (tree @var{exp}, int @var{reloc}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
7611 Return the section into which @var{exp} should be placed. You can
7612 assume that @var{exp} is either a @code{VAR_DECL} node or a constant of
7613 some sort. @var{reloc} indicates whether the initial value of @var{exp}
7614 requires link-time relocations. Bit 0 is set when variable contains
7615 local relocations only, while bit 1 is set for global relocations.
7616 @var{align} is the constant alignment in bits.
7617
7618 The default version of this function takes care of putting read-only
7619 variables in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7620
7621 See also @var{USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS}.
7622 @end deftypefn
7623
7624 @defmac USE_SELECT_SECTION_FOR_FUNCTIONS
7625 Define this macro if you wish TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION to be called
7626 for @code{FUNCTION_DECL}s as well as for variables and constants.
7627
7628 In the case of a @code{FUNCTION_DECL}, @var{reloc} will be zero if the
7629 function has been determined to be likely to be called, and nonzero if
7630 it is unlikely to be called.
7631 @end defmac
7632
7633 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNIQUE_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, int @var{reloc})
7634 Build up a unique section name, expressed as a @code{STRING_CST} node,
7635 and assign it to @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7636 As with @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION}, @var{reloc} indicates whether
7637 the initial value of @var{exp} requires link-time relocations.
7638
7639 The default version of this function appends the symbol name to the
7640 ELF section name that would normally be used for the symbol. For
7641 example, the function @code{foo} would be placed in @code{.text.foo}.
7642 Whatever the actual target object format, this is often good enough.
7643 @end deftypefn
7644
7645 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_RODATA_SECTION (tree @var{decl})
7646 Return the readonly data section associated with
7647 @samp{DECL_SECTION_NAME (@var{decl})}.
7648 The default version of this function selects @code{.gnu.linkonce.r.name} if
7649 the function's section is @code{.gnu.linkonce.t.name}, @code{.rodata.name}
7650 if function is in @code{.text.name}, and the normal readonly-data section
7651 otherwise.
7652 @end deftypefn
7653
7654 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_MERGEABLE_RODATA_PREFIX
7655 Usually, the compiler uses the prefix @code{".rodata"} to construct
7656 section names for mergeable constant data. Define this macro to override
7657 the string if a different section name should be used.
7658 @end deftypevr
7659
7660 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_TM_CLONE_TABLE_SECTION (void)
7661 Return the section that should be used for transactional memory clone tables.
7662 @end deftypefn
7663
7664 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_SELECT_RTX_SECTION (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{x}, unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{align})
7665 Return the section into which a constant @var{x}, of mode @var{mode},
7666 should be placed. You can assume that @var{x} is some kind of
7667 constant in RTL@. The argument @var{mode} is redundant except in the
7668 case of a @code{const_int} rtx. @var{align} is the constant alignment
7669 in bits.
7670
7671 The default version of this function takes care of putting symbolic
7672 constants in @code{flag_pic} mode in @code{data_section} and everything
7673 else in @code{readonly_data_section}.
7674 @end deftypefn
7675
7676 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_DECL_ASSEMBLER_NAME (tree @var{decl}, tree @var{id})
7677 Define this hook if you need to postprocess the assembler name generated
7678 by target-independent code. The @var{id} provided to this hook will be
7679 the computed name (e.g., the macro @code{DECL_NAME} of the @var{decl} in C,
7680 or the mangled name of the @var{decl} in C++). The return value of the
7681 hook is an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE} for the appropriate mangled name on
7682 your target system. The default implementation of this hook just
7683 returns the @var{id} provided.
7684 @end deftypefn
7685
7686 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO (tree @var{decl}, rtx @var{rtl}, int @var{new_decl_p})
7687 Define this hook if references to a symbol or a constant must be
7688 treated differently depending on something about the variable or
7689 function named by the symbol (such as what section it is in).
7690
7691 The hook is executed immediately after rtl has been created for
7692 @var{decl}, which may be a variable or function declaration or
7693 an entry in the constant pool. In either case, @var{rtl} is the
7694 rtl in question. Do @emph{not} use @code{DECL_RTL (@var{decl})}
7695 in this hook; that field may not have been initialized yet.
7696
7697 In the case of a constant, it is safe to assume that the rtl is
7698 a @code{mem} whose address is a @code{symbol_ref}. Most decls
7699 will also have this form, but that is not guaranteed. Global
7700 register variables, for instance, will have a @code{reg} for their
7701 rtl. (Normally the right thing to do with such unusual rtl is
7702 leave it alone.)
7703
7704 The @var{new_decl_p} argument will be true if this is the first time
7705 that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} has been invoked on this decl. It will
7706 be false for subsequent invocations, which will happen for duplicate
7707 declarations. Whether or not anything must be done for the duplicate
7708 declaration depends on whether the hook examines @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES}.
7709 @var{new_decl_p} is always true when the hook is called for a constant.
7710
7711 @cindex @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG}, in @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7712 The usual thing for this hook to do is to record flags in the
7713 @code{symbol_ref}, using @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAG} or @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7714 Historically, the name string was modified if it was necessary to
7715 encode more than one bit of information, but this practice is now
7716 discouraged; use @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}.
7717
7718 The default definition of this hook, @code{default_encode_section_info}
7719 in @file{varasm.c}, sets a number of commonly-useful bits in
7720 @code{SYMBOL_REF_FLAGS}. Check whether the default does what you need
7721 before overriding it.
7722 @end deftypefn
7723
7724 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING (const char *@var{name})
7725 Decode @var{name} and return the real name part, sans
7726 the characters that @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}
7727 may have added.
7728 @end deftypefn
7729
7730 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_IN_SMALL_DATA_P (const_tree @var{exp})
7731 Returns true if @var{exp} should be placed into a ``small data'' section.
7732 The default version of this hook always returns false.
7733 @end deftypefn
7734
7735 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SRODATA_SECTION
7736 Contains the value true if the target places read-only
7737 ``small data'' into a separate section. The default value is false.
7738 @end deftypevr
7739
7740 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE (void)
7741 It returns true if target wants profile code emitted before prologue.
7742
7743 The default version of this hook use the target macro
7744 @code{PROFILE_BEFORE_PROLOGUE}.
7745 @end deftypefn
7746
7747 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BINDS_LOCAL_P (const_tree @var{exp})
7748 Returns true if @var{exp} names an object for which name resolution
7749 rules must resolve to the current ``module'' (dynamic shared library
7750 or executable image).
7751
7752 The default version of this hook implements the name resolution rules
7753 for ELF, which has a looser model of global name binding than other
7754 currently supported object file formats.
7755 @end deftypefn
7756
7757 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_TLS
7758 Contains the value true if the target supports thread-local storage.
7759 The default value is false.
7760 @end deftypevr
7761
7762
7763 @node PIC
7764 @section Position Independent Code
7765 @cindex position independent code
7766 @cindex PIC
7767
7768 This section describes macros that help implement generation of position
7769 independent code. Simply defining these macros is not enough to
7770 generate valid PIC; you must also add support to the hook
7771 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} and to the macro
7772 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS}, as well as @code{LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS}. You
7773 must modify the definition of @samp{movsi} to do something appropriate
7774 when the source operand contains a symbolic address. You may also
7775 need to alter the handling of switch statements so that they use
7776 relative addresses.
7777 @c i rearranged the order of the macros above to try to force one of
7778 @c them to the next line, to eliminate an overfull hbox. --mew 10feb93
7779
7780 @defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM
7781 The register number of the register used to address a table of static
7782 data addresses in memory. In some cases this register is defined by a
7783 processor's ``application binary interface'' (ABI)@. When this macro
7784 is defined, RTL is generated for this register once, as with the stack
7785 pointer and frame pointer registers. If this macro is not defined, it
7786 is up to the machine-dependent files to allocate such a register (if
7787 necessary). Note that this register must be fixed when in use (e.g.@:
7788 when @code{flag_pic} is true).
7789 @end defmac
7790
7791 @defmac PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REG_CALL_CLOBBERED
7792 A C expression that is nonzero if the register defined by
7793 @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is clobbered by calls. If not defined,
7794 the default is zero. Do not define
7795 this macro if @code{PIC_OFFSET_TABLE_REGNUM} is not defined.
7796 @end defmac
7797
7798 @defmac LEGITIMATE_PIC_OPERAND_P (@var{x})
7799 A C expression that is nonzero if @var{x} is a legitimate immediate
7800 operand on the target machine when generating position independent code.
7801 You can assume that @var{x} satisfies @code{CONSTANT_P}, so you need not
7802 check this. You can also assume @var{flag_pic} is true, so you need not
7803 check it either. You need not define this macro if all constants
7804 (including @code{SYMBOL_REF}) can be immediate operands when generating
7805 position independent code.
7806 @end defmac
7807
7808 @node Assembler Format
7809 @section Defining the Output Assembler Language
7810
7811 This section describes macros whose principal purpose is to describe how
7812 to write instructions in assembler language---rather than what the
7813 instructions do.
7814
7815 @menu
7816 * File Framework:: Structural information for the assembler file.
7817 * Data Output:: Output of constants (numbers, strings, addresses).
7818 * Uninitialized Data:: Output of uninitialized variables.
7819 * Label Output:: Output and generation of labels.
7820 * Initialization:: General principles of initialization
7821 and termination routines.
7822 * Macros for Initialization::
7823 Specific macros that control the handling of
7824 initialization and termination routines.
7825 * Instruction Output:: Output of actual instructions.
7826 * Dispatch Tables:: Output of jump tables.
7827 * Exception Region Output:: Output of exception region code.
7828 * Alignment Output:: Pseudo ops for alignment and skipping data.
7829 @end menu
7830
7831 @node File Framework
7832 @subsection The Overall Framework of an Assembler File
7833 @cindex assembler format
7834 @cindex output of assembler code
7835
7836 @c prevent bad page break with this line
7837 This describes the overall framework of an assembly file.
7838
7839 @findex default_file_start
7840 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_START (void)
7841 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects to
7842 find at the beginning of a file. The default behavior is controlled
7843 by two flags, documented below. Unless your target's assembler is
7844 quite unusual, if you override the default, you should call
7845 @code{default_file_start} at some point in your target hook. This
7846 lets other target files rely on these variables.
7847 @end deftypefn
7848
7849 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_APP_OFF
7850 If this flag is true, the text of the macro @code{ASM_APP_OFF} will be
7851 printed as the very first line in the assembly file, unless
7852 @option{-fverbose-asm} is in effect. (If that macro has been defined
7853 to the empty string, this variable has no effect.) With the normal
7854 definition of @code{ASM_APP_OFF}, the effect is to notify the GNU
7855 assembler that it need not bother stripping comments or extra
7856 whitespace from its input. This allows it to work a bit faster.
7857
7858 The default is false. You should not set it to true unless you have
7859 verified that your port does not generate any extra whitespace or
7860 comments that will cause GAS to issue errors in NO_APP mode.
7861 @end deftypevr
7862
7863 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_FILE_START_FILE_DIRECTIVE
7864 If this flag is true, @code{output_file_directive} will be called
7865 for the primary source file, immediately after printing
7866 @code{ASM_APP_OFF} (if that is enabled). Most ELF assemblers expect
7867 this to be done. The default is false.
7868 @end deftypevr
7869
7870 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FILE_END (void)
7871 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7872 to find at the end of a file. The default is to output nothing.
7873 @end deftypefn
7874
7875 @deftypefun void file_end_indicate_exec_stack ()
7876 Some systems use a common convention, the @samp{.note.GNU-stack}
7877 special section, to indicate whether or not an object file relies on
7878 the stack being executable. If your system uses this convention, you
7879 should define @code{TARGET_ASM_FILE_END} to this function. If you
7880 need to do other things in that hook, have your hook function call
7881 this function.
7882 @end deftypefun
7883
7884 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_START (void)
7885 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7886 to find at the start of an LTO section. The default is to output
7887 nothing.
7888 @end deftypefn
7889
7890 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_LTO_END (void)
7891 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which the assembler expects
7892 to find at the end of an LTO section. The default is to output
7893 nothing.
7894 @end deftypefn
7895
7896 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CODE_END (void)
7897 Output to @code{asm_out_file} any text which is needed before emitting
7898 unwind info and debug info at the end of a file. Some targets emit
7899 here PIC setup thunks that cannot be emitted at the end of file,
7900 because they couldn't have unwind info then. The default is to output
7901 nothing.
7902 @end deftypefn
7903
7904 @defmac ASM_COMMENT_START
7905 A C string constant describing how to begin a comment in the target
7906 assembler language. The compiler assumes that the comment will end at
7907 the end of the line.
7908 @end defmac
7909
7910 @defmac ASM_APP_ON
7911 A C string constant for text to be output before each @code{asm}
7912 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7913 @code{"#APP"}, which is a comment that has no effect on most
7914 assemblers but tells the GNU assembler that it must check the lines
7915 that follow for all valid assembler constructs.
7916 @end defmac
7917
7918 @defmac ASM_APP_OFF
7919 A C string constant for text to be output after each @code{asm}
7920 statement or group of consecutive ones. Normally this is
7921 @code{"#NO_APP"}, which tells the GNU assembler to resume making the
7922 time-saving assumptions that are valid for ordinary compiler output.
7923 @end defmac
7924
7925 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
7926 A C statement to output COFF information or DWARF debugging information
7927 which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to
7928 the stdio stream @var{stream}.
7929
7930 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
7931 for the file format in use is appropriate.
7932 @end defmac
7933
7934 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_SOURCE_FILENAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name})
7935 Output DWARF debugging information which indicates that filename @var{name} is the current source file to the stdio stream @var{file}.
7936
7937 This target hook need not be defined if the standard form of output for the file format in use is appropriate.
7938 @end deftypefn
7939
7940 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_IDENT (const char *@var{name})
7941 Output a string based on @var{name}, suitable for the @samp{#ident} directive, or the equivalent directive or pragma in non-C-family languages. If this hook is not defined, nothing is output for the @samp{#ident} directive.
7942 @end deftypefn
7943
7944 @defmac OUTPUT_QUOTED_STRING (@var{stream}, @var{string})
7945 A C statement to output the string @var{string} to the stdio stream
7946 @var{stream}. If you do not call the function @code{output_quoted_string}
7947 in your config files, GCC will only call it to output filenames to
7948 the assembler source. So you can use it to canonicalize the format
7949 of the filename using this macro.
7950 @end defmac
7951
7952 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION (const char *@var{name}, unsigned int @var{flags}, tree @var{decl})
7953 Output assembly directives to switch to section @var{name}. The section
7954 should have attributes as specified by @var{flags}, which is a bit mask
7955 of the @code{SECTION_*} flags defined in @file{output.h}. If @var{decl}
7956 is non-NULL, it is the @code{VAR_DECL} or @code{FUNCTION_DECL} with which
7957 this section is associated.
7958 @end deftypefn
7959
7960 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_ELF_FLAGS_NUMERIC (unsigned int @var{flags}, unsigned int *@var{num})
7961 This hook can be used to encode ELF section flags for which no letter
7962 code has been defined in the assembler. It is called by
7963 @code{default_asm_named_section} whenever the section flags need to be
7964 emitted in the assembler output. If the hook returns true, then the
7965 numerical value for ELF section flags should be calculated from
7966 @var{flags} and saved in @var{*num}; the value is printed out instead of the
7967 normal sequence of letter codes. If the hook is not defined, or if it
7968 returns false, then @var{num} is ignored and the traditional letter sequence
7969 is emitted.
7970 @end deftypefn
7971
7972 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {section *} TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SECTION (tree @var{decl}, enum node_frequency @var{freq}, bool @var{startup}, bool @var{exit})
7973 Return preferred text (sub)section for function @var{decl}.
7974 Main purpose of this function is to separate cold, normal and hot
7975 functions. @var{startup} is true when function is known to be used only
7976 at startup (from static constructors or it is @code{main()}).
7977 @var{exit} is true when function is known to be used only at exit
7978 (from static destructors).
7979 Return NULL if function should go to default text section.
7980 @end deftypefn
7981
7982 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_SWITCHED_TEXT_SECTIONS (FILE *@var{file}, tree @var{decl}, bool @var{new_is_cold})
7983 Used by the target to emit any assembler directives or additional labels needed when a function is partitioned between different sections. Output should be written to @var{file}. The function decl is available as @var{decl} and the new section is `cold' if @var{new_is_cold} is @code{true}.
7984 @end deftypefn
7985
7986 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_NAMED_SECTIONS
7987 This flag is true if the target supports @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}.
7988 It must not be modified by command-line option processing.
7989 @end deftypevr
7990
7991 @anchor{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}
7992 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS
7993 This flag is true if we can create zeroed data by switching to a BSS
7994 section and then using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} to allocate the space.
7995 This is true on most ELF targets.
7996 @end deftypevr
7997
7998 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_SECTION_TYPE_FLAGS (tree @var{decl}, const char *@var{name}, int @var{reloc})
7999 Choose a set of section attributes for use by @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION}
8000 based on a variable or function decl, a section name, and whether or not the
8001 declaration's initializer may contain runtime relocations. @var{decl} may be
8002 null, in which case read-write data should be assumed.
8003
8004 The default version of this function handles choosing code vs data,
8005 read-only vs read-write data, and @code{flag_pic}. You should only
8006 need to override this if your target has special flags that might be
8007 set via @code{__attribute__}.
8008 @end deftypefn
8009
8010 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES (print_switch_type @var{type}, const char *@var{text})
8011 Provides the target with the ability to record the gcc command line
8012 switches that have been passed to the compiler, and options that are
8013 enabled. The @var{type} argument specifies what is being recorded.
8014 It can take the following values:
8015
8016 @table @gcctabopt
8017 @item SWITCH_TYPE_PASSED
8018 @var{text} is a command line switch that has been set by the user.
8019
8020 @item SWITCH_TYPE_ENABLED
8021 @var{text} is an option which has been enabled. This might be as a
8022 direct result of a command line switch, or because it is enabled by
8023 default or because it has been enabled as a side effect of a different
8024 command line switch. For example, the @option{-O2} switch enables
8025 various different individual optimization passes.
8026
8027 @item SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE
8028 @var{text} is either NULL or some descriptive text which should be
8029 ignored. If @var{text} is NULL then it is being used to warn the
8030 target hook that either recording is starting or ending. The first
8031 time @var{type} is SWITCH_TYPE_DESCRIPTIVE and @var{text} is NULL, the
8032 warning is for start up and the second time the warning is for
8033 wind down. This feature is to allow the target hook to make any
8034 necessary preparations before it starts to record switches and to
8035 perform any necessary tidying up after it has finished recording
8036 switches.
8037
8038 @item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_START
8039 This option can be ignored by this target hook.
8040
8041 @item SWITCH_TYPE_LINE_END
8042 This option can be ignored by this target hook.
8043 @end table
8044
8045 The hook's return value must be zero. Other return values may be
8046 supported in the future.
8047
8048 By default this hook is set to NULL, but an example implementation is
8049 provided for ELF based targets. Called @var{elf_record_gcc_switches},
8050 it records the switches as ASCII text inside a new, string mergeable
8051 section in the assembler output file. The name of the new section is
8052 provided by the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION} target
8053 hook.
8054 @end deftypefn
8055
8056 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES_SECTION
8057 This is the name of the section that will be created by the example
8058 ELF implementation of the @code{TARGET_ASM_RECORD_GCC_SWITCHES} target
8059 hook.
8060 @end deftypevr
8061
8062 @need 2000
8063 @node Data Output
8064 @subsection Output of Data
8065
8066
8067 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP
8068 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP
8069 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_PSI_OP
8070 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_SI_OP
8071 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_PDI_OP
8072 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_DI_OP
8073 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_PTI_OP
8074 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_TI_OP
8075 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_HI_OP
8076 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_PSI_OP
8077 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_SI_OP
8078 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_PDI_OP
8079 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_DI_OP
8080 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_PTI_OP
8081 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_UNALIGNED_TI_OP
8082 These hooks specify assembly directives for creating certain kinds
8083 of integer object. The @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} directive creates a
8084 byte-sized object, the @code{TARGET_ASM_ALIGNED_HI_OP} one creates an
8085 aligned two-byte object, and so on. Any of the hooks may be
8086 @code{NULL}, indicating that no suitable directive is available.
8087
8088 The compiler will print these strings at the start of a new line,
8089 followed immediately by the object's initial value. In most cases,
8090 the string should contain a tab, a pseudo-op, and then another tab.
8091 @end deftypevr
8092
8093 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_INTEGER (rtx @var{x}, unsigned int @var{size}, int @var{aligned_p})
8094 The @code{assemble_integer} function uses this hook to output an
8095 integer object. @var{x} is the object's value, @var{size} is its size
8096 in bytes and @var{aligned_p} indicates whether it is aligned. The
8097 function should return @code{true} if it was able to output the
8098 object. If it returns false, @code{assemble_integer} will try to
8099 split the object into smaller parts.
8100
8101 The default implementation of this hook will use the
8102 @code{TARGET_ASM_BYTE_OP} family of strings, returning @code{false}
8103 when the relevant string is @code{NULL}.
8104 @end deftypefn
8105
8106 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DECL_END (void)
8107 Define this hook if the target assembler requires a special marker to
8108 terminate an initialized variable declaration.
8109 @end deftypefn
8110
8111 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_CONST_EXTRA (FILE *@var{file}, rtx @var{x})
8112 A target hook to recognize @var{rtx} patterns that @code{output_addr_const}
8113 can't deal with, and output assembly code to @var{file} corresponding to
8114 the pattern @var{x}. This may be used to allow machine-dependent
8115 @code{UNSPEC}s to appear within constants.
8116
8117 If target hook fails to recognize a pattern, it must return @code{false},
8118 so that a standard error message is printed. If it prints an error message
8119 itself, by calling, for example, @code{output_operand_lossage}, it may just
8120 return @code{true}.
8121 @end deftypefn
8122
8123 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII (@var{stream}, @var{ptr}, @var{len})
8124 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
8125 instruction to assemble a string constant containing the @var{len}
8126 bytes at @var{ptr}. @var{ptr} will be a C expression of type
8127 @code{char *} and @var{len} a C expression of type @code{int}.
8128
8129 If the assembler has a @code{.ascii} pseudo-op as found in the
8130 Berkeley Unix assembler, do not define the macro
8131 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ASCII}.
8132 @end defmac
8133
8134 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FDESC (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{n})
8135 A C statement to output word @var{n} of a function descriptor for
8136 @var{decl}. This must be defined if @code{TARGET_VTABLE_USES_DESCRIPTORS}
8137 is defined, and is otherwise unused.
8138 @end defmac
8139
8140 @defmac CONSTANT_POOL_BEFORE_FUNCTION
8141 You may define this macro as a C expression. You should define the
8142 expression to have a nonzero value if GCC should output the constant
8143 pool for a function before the code for the function, or a zero value if
8144 GCC should output the constant pool after the function. If you do
8145 not define this macro, the usual case, GCC will output the constant
8146 pool before the function.
8147 @end defmac
8148
8149 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_PROLOGUE (@var{file}, @var{funname}, @var{fundecl}, @var{size})
8150 A C statement to output assembler commands to define the start of the
8151 constant pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving
8152 the name of the function. Should the return type of the function
8153 be required, it can be obtained via @var{fundecl}. @var{size}
8154 is the size, in bytes, of the constant pool that will be written
8155 immediately after this call.
8156
8157 If no constant-pool prefix is required, the usual case, this macro need
8158 not be defined.
8159 @end defmac
8160
8161 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SPECIAL_POOL_ENTRY (@var{file}, @var{x}, @var{mode}, @var{align}, @var{labelno}, @var{jumpto})
8162 A C statement (with or without semicolon) to output a constant in the
8163 constant pool, if it needs special treatment. (This macro need not do
8164 anything for RTL expressions that can be output normally.)
8165
8166 The argument @var{file} is the standard I/O stream to output the
8167 assembler code on. @var{x} is the RTL expression for the constant to
8168 output, and @var{mode} is the machine mode (in case @var{x} is a
8169 @samp{const_int}). @var{align} is the required alignment for the value
8170 @var{x}; you should output an assembler directive to force this much
8171 alignment.
8172
8173 The argument @var{labelno} is a number to use in an internal label for
8174 the address of this pool entry. The definition of this macro is
8175 responsible for outputting the label definition at the proper place.
8176 Here is how to do this:
8177
8178 @smallexample
8179 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} (@var{file}, "LC", @var{labelno});
8180 @end smallexample
8181
8182 When you output a pool entry specially, you should end with a
8183 @code{goto} to the label @var{jumpto}. This will prevent the same pool
8184 entry from being output a second time in the usual manner.
8185
8186 You need not define this macro if it would do nothing.
8187 @end defmac
8188
8189 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_POOL_EPILOGUE (@var{file} @var{funname} @var{fundecl} @var{size})
8190 A C statement to output assembler commands to at the end of the constant
8191 pool for a function. @var{funname} is a string giving the name of the
8192 function. Should the return type of the function be required, you can
8193 obtain it via @var{fundecl}. @var{size} is the size, in bytes, of the
8194 constant pool that GCC wrote immediately before this call.
8195
8196 If no constant-pool epilogue is required, the usual case, you need not
8197 define this macro.
8198 @end defmac
8199
8200 @defmac IS_ASM_LOGICAL_LINE_SEPARATOR (@var{C}, @var{STR})
8201 Define this macro as a C expression which is nonzero if @var{C} is
8202 used as a logical line separator by the assembler. @var{STR} points
8203 to the position in the string where @var{C} was found; this can be used if
8204 a line separator uses multiple characters.
8205
8206 If you do not define this macro, the default is that only
8207 the character @samp{;} is treated as a logical line separator.
8208 @end defmac
8209
8210 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_OPEN_PAREN
8211 @deftypevrx {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_ASM_CLOSE_PAREN
8212 These target hooks are C string constants, describing the syntax in the
8213 assembler for grouping arithmetic expressions. If not overridden, they
8214 default to normal parentheses, which is correct for most assemblers.
8215 @end deftypevr
8216
8217 These macros are provided by @file{real.h} for writing the definitions
8218 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DOUBLE} and the like:
8219
8220 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
8221 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
8222 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_LONG_DOUBLE (@var{x}, @var{l})
8223 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32 (@var{x}, @var{l})
8224 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL64 (@var{x}, @var{l})
8225 @defmacx REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL128 (@var{x}, @var{l})
8226 These translate @var{x}, of type @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE}, to the
8227 target's floating point representation, and store its bit pattern in
8228 the variable @var{l}. For @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_SINGLE} and
8229 @code{REAL_VALUE_TO_TARGET_DECIMAL32}, this variable should be a
8230 simple @code{long int}. For the others, it should be an array of
8231 @code{long int}. The number of elements in this array is determined
8232 by the size of the desired target floating point data type: 32 bits of
8233 it go in each @code{long int} array element. Each array element holds
8234 32 bits of the result, even if @code{long int} is wider than 32 bits
8235 on the host machine.
8236
8237 The array element values are designed so that you can print them out
8238 using @code{fprintf} in the order they should appear in the target
8239 machine's memory.
8240 @end defmac
8241
8242 @node Uninitialized Data
8243 @subsection Output of Uninitialized Variables
8244
8245 Each of the macros in this section is used to do the whole job of
8246 outputting a single uninitialized variable.
8247
8248 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
8249 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8250 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a common-label named
8251 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
8252 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants. It is
8253 possible that @var{size} may be zero, for instance if a struct with no
8254 other member than a zero-length array is defined. In this case, the
8255 backend must output a symbol definition that allocates at least one
8256 byte, both so that the address of the resulting object does not compare
8257 equal to any other, and because some object formats cannot even express
8258 the concept of a zero-sized common symbol, as that is how they represent
8259 an ordinary undefined external.
8260
8261 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
8262 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
8263 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
8264
8265 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
8266 common global variables are output.
8267 @end defmac
8268
8269 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
8270 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} except takes the required alignment as a
8271 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
8272 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON}, and gives you more flexibility in
8273 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
8274 as the number of bits.
8275 @end defmac
8276
8277 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_COMMON (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
8278 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON} except that @var{decl} of the
8279 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
8280 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
8281 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_COMMON} and
8282 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_COMMON}. Define this macro when you need to see
8283 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
8284 @end defmac
8285
8286 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_BSS (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
8287 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8288 @var{stream} the assembler definition of uninitialized global @var{decl} named
8289 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{alignment}
8290 is the alignment specified as the number of bits.
8291
8292 Try to use function @code{asm_output_aligned_bss} defined in file
8293 @file{varasm.c} when defining this macro. If unable, use the expression
8294 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name itself;
8295 before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax for defining
8296 the name, and a newline.
8297
8298 There are two ways of handling global BSS@. One is to define this macro.
8299 The other is to have @code{TARGET_ASM_SELECT_SECTION} return a
8300 switchable BSS section (@pxref{TARGET_HAVE_SWITCHABLE_BSS_SECTIONS}).
8301 You do not need to do both.
8302
8303 Some languages do not have @code{common} data, and require a
8304 non-common form of global BSS in order to handle uninitialized globals
8305 efficiently. C++ is one example of this. However, if the target does
8306 not support global BSS, the front end may choose to make globals
8307 common in order to save space in the object file.
8308 @end defmac
8309
8310 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{rounded})
8311 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8312 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a local-common-label named
8313 @var{name} whose size is @var{size} bytes. The variable @var{rounded}
8314 is the size rounded up to whatever alignment the caller wants.
8315
8316 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
8317 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
8318 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline.
8319
8320 This macro controls how the assembler definitions of uninitialized
8321 static variables are output.
8322 @end defmac
8323
8324 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
8325 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL} except takes the required alignment as a
8326 separate, explicit argument. If you define this macro, it is used in
8327 place of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LOCAL}, and gives you more flexibility in
8328 handling the required alignment of the variable. The alignment is specified
8329 as the number of bits.
8330 @end defmac
8331
8332 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL_LOCAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{size}, @var{alignment})
8333 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL} except that @var{decl} of the
8334 variable to be output, if there is one, or @code{NULL_TREE} if there
8335 is no corresponding variable. If you define this macro, GCC will use it
8336 in place of both @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DECL} and
8337 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGNED_DECL}. Define this macro when you need to see
8338 the variable's decl in order to chose what to output.
8339 @end defmac
8340
8341 @node Label Output
8342 @subsection Output and Generation of Labels
8343
8344 @c prevent bad page break with this line
8345 This is about outputting labels.
8346
8347 @findex assemble_name
8348 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8349 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8350 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name}.
8351 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
8352 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
8353 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
8354 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
8355 @end defmac
8356
8357 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8358 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8359 @var{stream} the assembler definition of a label named @var{name} of
8360 a function.
8361 Use the expression @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to
8362 output the name itself; before and after that, output the additional
8363 assembler syntax for defining the name, and a newline. A default
8364 definition of this macro is provided which is correct for most systems.
8365
8366 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
8367 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
8368 @end defmac
8369
8370 @findex assemble_name_raw
8371 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8372 Identical to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}, except that @var{name} is known
8373 to refer to a compiler-generated label. The default definition uses
8374 @code{assemble_name_raw}, which is like @code{assemble_name} except
8375 that it is more efficient.
8376 @end defmac
8377
8378 @defmac SIZE_ASM_OP
8379 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
8380 size of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
8381 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.size\t"}; on other
8382 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
8383
8384 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definitions
8385 of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE}
8386 for your system. If you need your own custom definitions of those
8387 macros, or if you do not need explicit symbol sizes at all, do not
8388 define this macro.
8389 @end defmac
8390
8391 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{size})
8392 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8393 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the size of the
8394 symbol @var{name} is @var{size}. @var{size} is a @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}.
8395 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
8396 provided.
8397 @end defmac
8398
8399 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8400 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8401 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler to calculate the size of
8402 the symbol @var{name} by subtracting its address from the current
8403 address.
8404
8405 If you define @code{SIZE_ASM_OP}, a default definition of this macro is
8406 provided. The default assumes that the assembler recognizes a special
8407 @samp{.} symbol as referring to the current address, and can calculate
8408 the difference between this and another symbol. If your assembler does
8409 not recognize @samp{.} or cannot do calculations with it, you will need
8410 to redefine @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} to use some other technique.
8411 @end defmac
8412
8413 @defmac NO_DOLLAR_IN_LABEL
8414 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
8415 @samp{$} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in
8416 G++ have @samp{$} in the identifiers. If this macro is defined,
8417 @samp{.} is used instead.
8418 @end defmac
8419
8420 @defmac NO_DOT_IN_LABEL
8421 Define this macro if the assembler does not accept the character
8422 @samp{.} in label names. By default constructors and destructors in G++
8423 have names that use @samp{.}. If this macro is defined, these names
8424 are rewritten to avoid @samp{.}.
8425 @end defmac
8426
8427 @defmac TYPE_ASM_OP
8428 A C string containing the appropriate assembler directive to specify the
8429 type of a symbol, without any arguments. On systems that use ELF, the
8430 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"\t.type\t"}; on other
8431 systems, the default is not to define this macro.
8432
8433 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
8434 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
8435 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
8436 types at all, do not define this macro.
8437 @end defmac
8438
8439 @defmac TYPE_OPERAND_FMT
8440 A C string which specifies (using @code{printf} syntax) the format of
8441 the second operand to @code{TYPE_ASM_OP}. On systems that use ELF, the
8442 default (in @file{config/elfos.h}) is @samp{"@@%s"}; on other systems,
8443 the default is not to define this macro.
8444
8445 Define this macro only if it is correct to use the default definition of
8446 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} for your system. If you need your own
8447 custom definition of this macro, or if you do not need explicit symbol
8448 types at all, do not define this macro.
8449 @end defmac
8450
8451 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE (@var{stream}, @var{type})
8452 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8453 @var{stream} a directive telling the assembler that the type of the
8454 symbol @var{name} is @var{type}. @var{type} is a C string; currently,
8455 that string is always either @samp{"function"} or @samp{"object"}, but
8456 you should not count on this.
8457
8458 If you define @code{TYPE_ASM_OP} and @code{TYPE_OPERAND_FMT}, a default
8459 definition of this macro is provided.
8460 @end defmac
8461
8462 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8463 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8464 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
8465 function which is being defined. This macro is responsible for
8466 outputting the label definition (perhaps using
8467 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
8468 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
8469
8470 If this macro is not defined, then the function name is defined in the
8471 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}).
8472
8473 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
8474 of this macro.
8475 @end defmac
8476
8477 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8478 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8479 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a function
8480 which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
8481 function. The argument @var{decl} is the @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node
8482 representing the function.
8483
8484 If this macro is not defined, then the function size is not defined.
8485
8486 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
8487 of this macro.
8488 @end defmac
8489
8490 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_COLD_FUNCTION_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8491 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8492 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of a
8493 cold function partition which is being defined. This macro is responsible
8494 for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
8495 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_FUNCTION_LABEL}). The argument @var{decl} is the
8496 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
8497
8498 If this macro is not defined, then the cold partition name is defined in the
8499 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
8500
8501 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition
8502 of this macro.
8503 @end defmac
8504
8505 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_COLD_FUNCTION_SIZE (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8506 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8507 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the size of a cold function
8508 partition which is being defined. The argument @var{name} is the name of the
8509 cold partition of the function. The argument @var{decl} is the
8510 @code{FUNCTION_DECL} tree node representing the function.
8511
8512 If this macro is not defined, then the partition size is not defined.
8513
8514 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition
8515 of this macro.
8516 @end defmac
8517
8518 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_OBJECT_NAME (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{decl})
8519 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8520 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name @var{name} of an
8521 initialized variable which is being defined. This macro must output the
8522 label definition (perhaps using @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}). The argument
8523 @var{decl} is the @code{VAR_DECL} tree node representing the variable.
8524
8525 If this macro is not defined, then the variable name is defined in the
8526 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL}).
8527
8528 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
8529 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} in the definition of this macro.
8530 @end defmac
8531
8532 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DECLARE_CONSTANT_NAME (FILE *@var{file}, const char *@var{name}, const_tree @var{expr}, HOST_WIDE_INT @var{size})
8533 A target hook to output to the stdio stream @var{file} any text necessary
8534 for declaring the name @var{name} of a constant which is being defined. This
8535 target hook is responsible for outputting the label definition (perhaps using
8536 @code{assemble_label}). The argument @var{exp} is the value of the constant,
8537 and @var{size} is the size of the constant in bytes. The @var{name}
8538 will be an internal label.
8539
8540 The default version of this target hook, define the @var{name} in the
8541 usual manner as a label (by means of @code{assemble_label}).
8542
8543 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_TYPE_DIRECTIVE} in this target hook.
8544 @end deftypefn
8545
8546 @defmac ASM_DECLARE_REGISTER_GLOBAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{regno}, @var{name})
8547 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8548 @var{stream} any text necessary for claiming a register @var{regno}
8549 for a global variable @var{decl} with name @var{name}.
8550
8551 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
8552 nothing.
8553 @end defmac
8554
8555 @defmac ASM_FINISH_DECLARE_OBJECT (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{toplevel}, @var{atend})
8556 A C statement (sans semicolon) to finish up declaring a variable name
8557 once the compiler has processed its initializer fully and thus has had a
8558 chance to determine the size of an array when controlled by an
8559 initializer. This is used on systems where it's necessary to declare
8560 something about the size of the object.
8561
8562 If you don't define this macro, that is equivalent to defining it to do
8563 nothing.
8564
8565 You may wish to use @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SIZE_DIRECTIVE} and/or
8566 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_MEASURED_SIZE} in the definition of this macro.
8567 @end defmac
8568
8569 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name})
8570 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
8571 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} global;
8572 that is, available for reference from other files.
8573
8574 The default implementation relies on a proper definition of
8575 @code{GLOBAL_ASM_OP}.
8576 @end deftypefn
8577
8578 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_DECL_NAME (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl})
8579 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
8580 @var{stream} some commands that will make the name associated with @var{decl}
8581 global; that is, available for reference from other files.
8582
8583 The default implementation uses the TARGET_ASM_GLOBALIZE_LABEL target hook.
8584 @end deftypefn
8585
8586 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_UNDEFINED_DECL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{name}, const_tree @var{decl})
8587 This target hook is a function to output to the stdio stream
8588 @var{stream} some commands that will declare the name associated with
8589 @var{decl} which is not defined in the current translation unit. Most
8590 assemblers do not require anything to be output in this case.
8591 @end deftypefn
8592
8593 @defmac ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8594 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8595 @var{stream} some commands that will make the label @var{name} weak;
8596 that is, available for reference from other files but only used if
8597 no other definition is available. Use the expression
8598 @code{assemble_name (@var{stream}, @var{name})} to output the name
8599 itself; before and after that, output the additional assembler syntax
8600 for making that name weak, and a newline.
8601
8602 If you don't define this macro or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}, GCC will not
8603 support weak symbols and you should not define the @code{SUPPORTS_WEAK}
8604 macro.
8605 @end defmac
8606
8607 @defmac ASM_WEAKEN_DECL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8608 Combines (and replaces) the function of @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} and
8609 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS}, allowing access to the associated function
8610 or variable decl. If @var{value} is not @code{NULL}, this C statement
8611 should output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code which
8612 defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8613 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it should output commands
8614 to make @var{name} weak.
8615 @end defmac
8616
8617 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAKREF (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8618 Outputs a directive that enables @var{name} to be used to refer to
8619 symbol @var{value} with weak-symbol semantics. @code{decl} is the
8620 declaration of @code{name}.
8621 @end defmac
8622
8623 @defmac SUPPORTS_WEAK
8624 A preprocessor constant expression which evaluates to true if the target
8625 supports weak symbols.
8626
8627 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
8628 definition. If either @code{ASM_WEAKEN_LABEL} or @code{ASM_WEAKEN_DECL}
8629 is defined, the default definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}.
8630 @end defmac
8631
8632 @defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WEAK
8633 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports weak symbols.
8634
8635 If you don't define this macro, @file{defaults.h} provides a default
8636 definition. The default definition is @samp{(SUPPORTS_WEAK)}. Define
8637 this macro if you want to control weak symbol support with a compiler
8638 flag such as @option{-melf}.
8639 @end defmac
8640
8641 @defmac MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY (@var{decl})
8642 A C statement (sans semicolon) to mark @var{decl} to be emitted as a
8643 public symbol such that extra copies in multiple translation units will
8644 be discarded by the linker. Define this macro if your object file
8645 format provides support for this concept, such as the @samp{COMDAT}
8646 section flags in the Microsoft Windows PE/COFF format, and this support
8647 requires changes to @var{decl}, such as putting it in a separate section.
8648 @end defmac
8649
8650 @defmac SUPPORTS_ONE_ONLY
8651 A C expression which evaluates to true if the target supports one-only
8652 semantics.
8653
8654 If you don't define this macro, @file{varasm.c} provides a default
8655 definition. If @code{MAKE_DECL_ONE_ONLY} is defined, the default
8656 definition is @samp{1}; otherwise, it is @samp{0}. Define this macro if
8657 you want to control one-only symbol support with a compiler flag, or if
8658 setting the @code{DECL_ONE_ONLY} flag is enough to mark a declaration to
8659 be emitted as one-only.
8660 @end defmac
8661
8662 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_ASSEMBLE_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl}, int @var{visibility})
8663 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} some
8664 commands that will make the symbol(s) associated with @var{decl} have
8665 hidden, protected or internal visibility as specified by @var{visibility}.
8666 @end deftypefn
8667
8668 @defmac TARGET_WEAK_NOT_IN_ARCHIVE_TOC
8669 A C expression that evaluates to true if the target's linker expects
8670 that weak symbols do not appear in a static archive's table of contents.
8671 The default is @code{0}.
8672
8673 Leaving weak symbols out of an archive's table of contents means that,
8674 if a symbol will only have a definition in one translation unit and
8675 will have undefined references from other translation units, that
8676 symbol should not be weak. Defining this macro to be nonzero will
8677 thus have the effect that certain symbols that would normally be weak
8678 (explicit template instantiations, and vtables for polymorphic classes
8679 with noninline key methods) will instead be nonweak.
8680
8681 The C++ ABI requires this macro to be zero. Define this macro for
8682 targets where full C++ ABI compliance is impossible and where linker
8683 restrictions require weak symbols to be left out of a static archive's
8684 table of contents.
8685 @end defmac
8686
8687 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_EXTERNAL (@var{stream}, @var{decl}, @var{name})
8688 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8689 @var{stream} any text necessary for declaring the name of an external
8690 symbol named @var{name} which is referenced in this compilation but
8691 not defined. The value of @var{decl} is the tree node for the
8692 declaration.
8693
8694 This macro need not be defined if it does not need to output anything.
8695 The GNU assembler and most Unix assemblers don't require anything.
8696 @end defmac
8697
8698 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EXTERNAL_LIBCALL (rtx @var{symref})
8699 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
8700 pseudo-op to declare a library function name external. The name of the
8701 library function is given by @var{symref}, which is a @code{symbol_ref}.
8702 @end deftypefn
8703
8704 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_MARK_DECL_PRESERVED (const char *@var{symbol})
8705 This target hook is a function to output to @var{asm_out_file} an assembler
8706 directive to annotate @var{symbol} as used. The Darwin target uses the
8707 .no_dead_code_strip directive.
8708 @end deftypefn
8709
8710 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF (@var{stream}, @var{name})
8711 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output to the stdio stream
8712 @var{stream} a reference in assembler syntax to a label named
8713 @var{name}. This should add @samp{_} to the front of the name, if that
8714 is customary on your operating system, as it is in most Berkeley Unix
8715 systems. This macro is used in @code{assemble_name}.
8716 @end defmac
8717
8718 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MANGLE_ASSEMBLER_NAME (const char *@var{name})
8719 Given a symbol @var{name}, perform same mangling as @code{varasm.c}'s @code{assemble_name}, but in memory rather than to a file stream, returning result as an @code{IDENTIFIER_NODE}. Required for correct LTO symtabs. The default implementation calls the @code{TARGET_STRIP_NAME_ENCODING} hook and then prepends the @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX}, if any.
8720 @end deftypefn
8721
8722 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SYMBOL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{sym})
8723 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to
8724 @code{SYMBOL_REF} @var{sym}. If not defined, @code{assemble_name}
8725 will be used to output the name of the symbol. This macro may be used
8726 to modify the way a symbol is referenced depending on information
8727 encoded by @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO}.
8728 @end defmac
8729
8730 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_LABEL_REF (@var{stream}, @var{buf})
8731 A C statement (sans semicolon) to output a reference to @var{buf}, the
8732 result of @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}. If not defined,
8733 @code{assemble_name} will be used to output the name of the symbol.
8734 This macro is not used by @code{output_asm_label}, or the @code{%l}
8735 specifier that calls it; the intention is that this macro should be set
8736 when it is necessary to output a label differently when its address is
8737 being taken.
8738 @end defmac
8739
8740 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_INTERNAL_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, const char *@var{prefix}, unsigned long @var{labelno})
8741 A function to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a label whose
8742 name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{labelno}.
8743
8744 It is absolutely essential that these labels be distinct from the labels
8745 used for user-level functions and variables. Otherwise, certain programs
8746 will have name conflicts with internal labels.
8747
8748 It is desirable to exclude internal labels from the symbol table of the
8749 object file. Most assemblers have a naming convention for labels that
8750 should be excluded; on many systems, the letter @samp{L} at the
8751 beginning of a label has this effect. You should find out what
8752 convention your system uses, and follow it.
8753
8754 The default version of this function utilizes @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL}.
8755 @end deftypefn
8756
8757 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEBUG_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8758 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} a debug info
8759 label whose name is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number
8760 @var{num}. This is useful for VLIW targets, where debug info labels
8761 may need to be treated differently than branch target labels. On some
8762 systems, branch target labels must be at the beginning of instruction
8763 bundles, but debug info labels can occur in the middle of instruction
8764 bundles.
8765
8766 If this macro is not defined, then @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} will be
8767 used.
8768 @end defmac
8769
8770 @defmac ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL (@var{string}, @var{prefix}, @var{num})
8771 A C statement to store into the string @var{string} a label whose name
8772 is made from the string @var{prefix} and the number @var{num}.
8773
8774 This string, when output subsequently by @code{assemble_name}, should
8775 produce the output that @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)} would produce
8776 with the same @var{prefix} and @var{num}.
8777
8778 If the string begins with @samp{*}, then @code{assemble_name} will
8779 output the rest of the string unchanged. It is often convenient for
8780 @code{ASM_GENERATE_INTERNAL_LABEL} to use @samp{*} in this way. If the
8781 string doesn't start with @samp{*}, then @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} gets
8782 to output the string, and may change it. (Of course,
8783 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} is also part of your machine description, so
8784 you should know what it does on your machine.)
8785 @end defmac
8786
8787 @defmac ASM_FORMAT_PRIVATE_NAME (@var{outvar}, @var{name}, @var{number})
8788 A C expression to assign to @var{outvar} (which is a variable of type
8789 @code{char *}) a newly allocated string made from the string
8790 @var{name} and the number @var{number}, with some suitable punctuation
8791 added. Use @code{alloca} to get space for the string.
8792
8793 The string will be used as an argument to @code{ASM_OUTPUT_LABELREF} to
8794 produce an assembler label for an internal static variable whose name is
8795 @var{name}. Therefore, the string must be such as to result in valid
8796 assembler code. The argument @var{number} is different each time this
8797 macro is executed; it prevents conflicts between similarly-named
8798 internal static variables in different scopes.
8799
8800 Ideally this string should not be a valid C identifier, to prevent any
8801 conflict with the user's own symbols. Most assemblers allow periods
8802 or percent signs in assembler symbols; putting at least one of these
8803 between the name and the number will suffice.
8804
8805 If this macro is not defined, a default definition will be provided
8806 which is correct for most systems.
8807 @end defmac
8808
8809 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8810 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8811 which defines (equates) the symbol @var{name} to have the value @var{value}.
8812
8813 @findex SET_ASM_OP
8814 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8815 correct for most systems.
8816 @end defmac
8817
8818 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS (@var{stream}, @var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8819 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8820 which defines (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name}
8821 to have the value of the tree node @var{decl_of_value}. This macro will
8822 be used in preference to @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} if it is defined and if
8823 the tree nodes are available.
8824
8825 @findex SET_ASM_OP
8826 If @code{SET_ASM_OP} is defined, a default definition is provided which is
8827 correct for most systems.
8828 @end defmac
8829
8830 @defmac TARGET_DEFERRED_OUTPUT_DEFS (@var{decl_of_name}, @var{decl_of_value})
8831 A C statement that evaluates to true if the assembler code which defines
8832 (equates) the symbol whose tree node is @var{decl_of_name} to have the value
8833 of the tree node @var{decl_of_value} should be emitted near the end of the
8834 current compilation unit. The default is to not defer output of defines.
8835 This macro affects defines output by @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} and
8836 @samp{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF_FROM_DECLS}.
8837 @end defmac
8838
8839 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_WEAK_ALIAS (@var{stream}, @var{name}, @var{value})
8840 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} assembler code
8841 which defines (equates) the weak symbol @var{name} to have the value
8842 @var{value}. If @var{value} is @code{NULL}, it defines @var{name} as
8843 an undefined weak symbol.
8844
8845 Define this macro if the target only supports weak aliases; define
8846 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF} instead if possible.
8847 @end defmac
8848
8849 @defmac OBJC_GEN_METHOD_LABEL (@var{buf}, @var{is_inst}, @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name}, @var{sel_name})
8850 Define this macro to override the default assembler names used for
8851 Objective-C methods.
8852
8853 The default name is a unique method number followed by the name of the
8854 class (e.g.@: @samp{_1_Foo}). For methods in categories, the name of
8855 the category is also included in the assembler name (e.g.@:
8856 @samp{_1_Foo_Bar}).
8857
8858 These names are safe on most systems, but make debugging difficult since
8859 the method's selector is not present in the name. Therefore, particular
8860 systems define other ways of computing names.
8861
8862 @var{buf} is an expression of type @code{char *} which gives you a
8863 buffer in which to store the name; its length is as long as
8864 @var{class_name}, @var{cat_name} and @var{sel_name} put together, plus
8865 50 characters extra.
8866
8867 The argument @var{is_inst} specifies whether the method is an instance
8868 method or a class method; @var{class_name} is the name of the class;
8869 @var{cat_name} is the name of the category (or @code{NULL} if the method is not
8870 in a category); and @var{sel_name} is the name of the selector.
8871
8872 On systems where the assembler can handle quoted names, you can use this
8873 macro to provide more human-readable names.
8874 @end defmac
8875
8876 @node Initialization
8877 @subsection How Initialization Functions Are Handled
8878 @cindex initialization routines
8879 @cindex termination routines
8880 @cindex constructors, output of
8881 @cindex destructors, output of
8882
8883 The compiled code for certain languages includes @dfn{constructors}
8884 (also called @dfn{initialization routines})---functions to initialize
8885 data in the program when the program is started. These functions need
8886 to be called before the program is ``started''---that is to say, before
8887 @code{main} is called.
8888
8889 Compiling some languages generates @dfn{destructors} (also called
8890 @dfn{termination routines}) that should be called when the program
8891 terminates.
8892
8893 To make the initialization and termination functions work, the compiler
8894 must output something in the assembler code to cause those functions to
8895 be called at the appropriate time. When you port the compiler to a new
8896 system, you need to specify how to do this.
8897
8898 There are two major ways that GCC currently supports the execution of
8899 initialization and termination functions. Each way has two variants.
8900 Much of the structure is common to all four variations.
8901
8902 @findex __CTOR_LIST__
8903 @findex __DTOR_LIST__
8904 The linker must build two lists of these functions---a list of
8905 initialization functions, called @code{__CTOR_LIST__}, and a list of
8906 termination functions, called @code{__DTOR_LIST__}.
8907
8908 Each list always begins with an ignored function pointer (which may hold
8909 0, @minus{}1, or a count of the function pointers after it, depending on
8910 the environment). This is followed by a series of zero or more function
8911 pointers to constructors (or destructors), followed by a function
8912 pointer containing zero.
8913
8914 Depending on the operating system and its executable file format, either
8915 @file{crtstuff.c} or @file{libgcc2.c} traverses these lists at startup
8916 time and exit time. Constructors are called in reverse order of the
8917 list; destructors in forward order.
8918
8919 The best way to handle static constructors works only for object file
8920 formats which provide arbitrarily-named sections. A section is set
8921 aside for a list of constructors, and another for a list of destructors.
8922 Traditionally these are called @samp{.ctors} and @samp{.dtors}. Each
8923 object file that defines an initialization function also puts a word in
8924 the constructor section to point to that function. The linker
8925 accumulates all these words into one contiguous @samp{.ctors} section.
8926 Termination functions are handled similarly.
8927
8928 This method will be chosen as the default by @file{target-def.h} if
8929 @code{TARGET_ASM_NAMED_SECTION} is defined. A target that does not
8930 support arbitrary sections, but does support special designated
8931 constructor and destructor sections may define @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8932 and @code{DTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP} to achieve the same effect.
8933
8934 When arbitrary sections are available, there are two variants, depending
8935 upon how the code in @file{crtstuff.c} is called. On systems that
8936 support a @dfn{.init} section which is executed at program startup,
8937 parts of @file{crtstuff.c} are compiled into that section. The
8938 program is linked by the @command{gcc} driver like this:
8939
8940 @smallexample
8941 ld -o @var{output_file} crti.o crtbegin.o @dots{} -lgcc crtend.o crtn.o
8942 @end smallexample
8943
8944 The prologue of a function (@code{__init}) appears in the @code{.init}
8945 section of @file{crti.o}; the epilogue appears in @file{crtn.o}. Likewise
8946 for the function @code{__fini} in the @dfn{.fini} section. Normally these
8947 files are provided by the operating system or by the GNU C library, but
8948 are provided by GCC for a few targets.
8949
8950 The objects @file{crtbegin.o} and @file{crtend.o} are (for most targets)
8951 compiled from @file{crtstuff.c}. They contain, among other things, code
8952 fragments within the @code{.init} and @code{.fini} sections that branch
8953 to routines in the @code{.text} section. The linker will pull all parts
8954 of a section together, which results in a complete @code{__init} function
8955 that invokes the routines we need at startup.
8956
8957 To use this variant, you must define the @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}
8958 macro properly.
8959
8960 If no init section is available, when GCC compiles any function called
8961 @code{main} (or more accurately, any function designated as a program
8962 entry point by the language front end calling @code{expand_main_function}),
8963 it inserts a procedure call to @code{__main} as the first executable code
8964 after the function prologue. The @code{__main} function is defined
8965 in @file{libgcc2.c} and runs the global constructors.
8966
8967 In file formats that don't support arbitrary sections, there are again
8968 two variants. In the simplest variant, the GNU linker (GNU @code{ld})
8969 and an `a.out' format must be used. In this case,
8970 @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} is defined to produce a @code{.stabs}
8971 entry of type @samp{N_SETT}, referencing the name @code{__CTOR_LIST__},
8972 and with the address of the void function containing the initialization
8973 code as its value. The GNU linker recognizes this as a request to add
8974 the value to a @dfn{set}; the values are accumulated, and are eventually
8975 placed in the executable as a vector in the format described above, with
8976 a leading (ignored) count and a trailing zero element.
8977 @code{TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR} is handled similarly. Since no init
8978 section is available, the absence of @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP} causes
8979 the compilation of @code{main} to call @code{__main} as above, starting
8980 the initialization process.
8981
8982 The last variant uses neither arbitrary sections nor the GNU linker.
8983 This is preferable when you want to do dynamic linking and when using
8984 file formats which the GNU linker does not support, such as `ECOFF'@. In
8985 this case, @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is false, initialization and
8986 termination functions are recognized simply by their names. This requires
8987 an extra program in the linkage step, called @command{collect2}. This program
8988 pretends to be the linker, for use with GCC; it does its job by running
8989 the ordinary linker, but also arranges to include the vectors of
8990 initialization and termination functions. These functions are called
8991 via @code{__main} as described above. In order to use this method,
8992 @code{use_collect2} must be defined in the target in @file{config.gcc}.
8993
8994 @ifinfo
8995 The following section describes the specific macros that control and
8996 customize the handling of initialization and termination functions.
8997 @end ifinfo
8998
8999 @node Macros for Initialization
9000 @subsection Macros Controlling Initialization Routines
9001
9002 Here are the macros that control how the compiler handles initialization
9003 and termination functions:
9004
9005 @defmac INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP
9006 If defined, a C string constant, including spacing, for the assembler
9007 operation to identify the following data as initialization code. If not
9008 defined, GCC will assume such a section does not exist. When you are
9009 using special sections for initialization and termination functions, this
9010 macro also controls how @file{crtstuff.c} and @file{libgcc2.c} arrange to
9011 run the initialization functions.
9012 @end defmac
9013
9014 @defmac HAS_INIT_SECTION
9015 If defined, @code{main} will not call @code{__main} as described above.
9016 This macro should be defined for systems that control start-up code
9017 on a symbol-by-symbol basis, such as OSF/1, and should not
9018 be defined explicitly for systems that support @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}.
9019 @end defmac
9020
9021 @defmac LD_INIT_SWITCH
9022 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
9023 the following symbol is an initialization routine.
9024 @end defmac
9025
9026 @defmac LD_FINI_SWITCH
9027 If defined, a C string constant for a switch that tells the linker that
9028 the following symbol is a finalization routine.
9029 @end defmac
9030
9031 @defmac COLLECT_SHARED_INIT_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
9032 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
9033 automatically called when a shared library is loaded. The function
9034 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
9035 the object format requires an explicit initialization function, then a
9036 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DI} will be generated.
9037
9038 This function and the following one are used by collect2 when linking a
9039 shared library that needs constructors or destructors, or has DWARF2
9040 exception tables embedded in the code.
9041 @end defmac
9042
9043 @defmac COLLECT_SHARED_FINI_FUNC (@var{stream}, @var{func})
9044 If defined, a C statement that will write a function that can be
9045 automatically called when a shared library is unloaded. The function
9046 should call @var{func}, which takes no arguments. If not defined, and
9047 the object format requires an explicit finalization function, then a
9048 function called @code{_GLOBAL__DD} will be generated.
9049 @end defmac
9050
9051 @defmac INVOKE__main
9052 If defined, @code{main} will call @code{__main} despite the presence of
9053 @code{INIT_SECTION_ASM_OP}. This macro should be defined for systems
9054 where the init section is not actually run automatically, but is still
9055 useful for collecting the lists of constructors and destructors.
9056 @end defmac
9057
9058 @defmac SUPPORTS_INIT_PRIORITY
9059 If nonzero, the C++ @code{init_priority} attribute is supported and the
9060 compiler should emit instructions to control the order of initialization
9061 of objects. If zero, the compiler will issue an error message upon
9062 encountering an @code{init_priority} attribute.
9063 @end defmac
9064
9065 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS
9066 This value is true if the target supports some ``native'' method of
9067 collecting constructors and destructors to be run at startup and exit.
9068 It is false if we must use @command{collect2}.
9069 @end deftypevr
9070
9071 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
9072 If defined, a function that outputs assembler code to arrange to call
9073 the function referenced by @var{symbol} at initialization time.
9074
9075 Assume that @var{symbol} is a @code{SYMBOL_REF} for a function taking
9076 no arguments and with no return value. If the target supports initialization
9077 priorities, @var{priority} is a value between 0 and @code{MAX_INIT_PRIORITY};
9078 otherwise it must be @code{DEFAULT_INIT_PRIORITY}.
9079
9080 If this macro is not defined by the target, a suitable default will
9081 be chosen if (1) the target supports arbitrary section names, (2) the
9082 target defines @code{CTORS_SECTION_ASM_OP}, or (3) @code{USE_COLLECT2}
9083 is not defined.
9084 @end deftypefn
9085
9086 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_DESTRUCTOR (rtx @var{symbol}, int @var{priority})
9087 This is like @code{TARGET_ASM_CONSTRUCTOR} but used for termination
9088 functions rather than initialization functions.
9089 @end deftypefn
9090
9091 If @code{TARGET_HAVE_CTORS_DTORS} is true, the initialization routine
9092 generated for the generated object file will have static linkage.
9093
9094 If your system uses @command{collect2} as the means of processing
9095 constructors, then that program normally uses @command{nm} to scan
9096 an object file for constructor functions to be called.
9097
9098 On certain kinds of systems, you can define this macro to make
9099 @command{collect2} work faster (and, in some cases, make it work at all):
9100
9101 @defmac OBJECT_FORMAT_COFF
9102 Define this macro if the system uses COFF (Common Object File Format)
9103 object files, so that @command{collect2} can assume this format and scan
9104 object files directly for dynamic constructor/destructor functions.
9105
9106 This macro is effective only in a native compiler; @command{collect2} as
9107 part of a cross compiler always uses @command{nm} for the target machine.
9108 @end defmac
9109
9110 @defmac REAL_NM_FILE_NAME
9111 Define this macro as a C string constant containing the file name to use
9112 to execute @command{nm}. The default is to search the path normally for
9113 @command{nm}.
9114 @end defmac
9115
9116 @defmac NM_FLAGS
9117 @command{collect2} calls @command{nm} to scan object files for static
9118 constructors and destructors and LTO info. By default, @option{-n} is
9119 passed. Define @code{NM_FLAGS} to a C string constant if other options
9120 are needed to get the same output format as GNU @command{nm -n}
9121 produces.
9122 @end defmac
9123
9124 If your system supports shared libraries and has a program to list the
9125 dynamic dependencies of a given library or executable, you can define
9126 these macros to enable support for running initialization and
9127 termination functions in shared libraries:
9128
9129 @defmac LDD_SUFFIX
9130 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the name of the program
9131 which lists dynamic dependencies, like @command{ldd} under SunOS 4.
9132 @end defmac
9133
9134 @defmac PARSE_LDD_OUTPUT (@var{ptr})
9135 Define this macro to be C code that extracts filenames from the output
9136 of the program denoted by @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. @var{ptr} is a variable
9137 of type @code{char *} that points to the beginning of a line of output
9138 from @code{LDD_SUFFIX}. If the line lists a dynamic dependency, the
9139 code must advance @var{ptr} to the beginning of the filename on that
9140 line. Otherwise, it must set @var{ptr} to @code{NULL}.
9141 @end defmac
9142
9143 @defmac SHLIB_SUFFIX
9144 Define this macro to a C string constant containing the default shared
9145 library extension of the target (e.g., @samp{".so"}). @command{collect2}
9146 strips version information after this suffix when generating global
9147 constructor and destructor names. This define is only needed on targets
9148 that use @command{collect2} to process constructors and destructors.
9149 @end defmac
9150
9151 @node Instruction Output
9152 @subsection Output of Assembler Instructions
9153
9154 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9155 This describes assembler instruction output.
9156
9157 @defmac REGISTER_NAMES
9158 A C initializer containing the assembler's names for the machine
9159 registers, each one as a C string constant. This is what translates
9160 register numbers in the compiler into assembler language.
9161 @end defmac
9162
9163 @defmac ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES
9164 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a name
9165 and a register number. This macro defines additional names for hard
9166 registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in declarations to refer
9167 to registers using alternate names.
9168 @end defmac
9169
9170 @defmac OVERLAPPING_REGISTER_NAMES
9171 If defined, a C initializer for an array of structures containing a
9172 name, a register number and a count of the number of consecutive
9173 machine registers the name overlaps. This macro defines additional
9174 names for hard registers, thus allowing the @code{asm} option in
9175 declarations to refer to registers using alternate names. Unlike
9176 @code{ADDITIONAL_REGISTER_NAMES}, this macro should be used when the
9177 register name implies multiple underlying registers.
9178
9179 This macro should be used when it is important that a clobber in an
9180 @code{asm} statement clobbers all the underlying values implied by the
9181 register name. For example, on ARM, clobbering the double-precision
9182 VFP register ``d0'' implies clobbering both single-precision registers
9183 ``s0'' and ``s1''.
9184 @end defmac
9185
9186 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_OPCODE (@var{stream}, @var{ptr})
9187 Define this macro if you are using an unusual assembler that
9188 requires different names for the machine instructions.
9189
9190 The definition is a C statement or statements which output an
9191 assembler instruction opcode to the stdio stream @var{stream}. The
9192 macro-operand @var{ptr} is a variable of type @code{char *} which
9193 points to the opcode name in its ``internal'' form---the form that is
9194 written in the machine description. The definition should output the
9195 opcode name to @var{stream}, performing any translation you desire, and
9196 increment the variable @var{ptr} to point at the end of the opcode
9197 so that it will not be output twice.
9198
9199 In fact, your macro definition may process less than the entire opcode
9200 name, or more than the opcode name; but if you want to process text
9201 that includes @samp{%}-sequences to substitute operands, you must take
9202 care of the substitution yourself. Just be sure to increment
9203 @var{ptr} over whatever text should not be output normally.
9204
9205 @findex recog_data.operand
9206 If you need to look at the operand values, they can be found as the
9207 elements of @code{recog_data.operand}.
9208
9209 If the macro definition does nothing, the instruction is output
9210 in the usual way.
9211 @end defmac
9212
9213 @defmac FINAL_PRESCAN_INSN (@var{insn}, @var{opvec}, @var{noperands})
9214 If defined, a C statement to be executed just prior to the output of
9215 assembler code for @var{insn}, to modify the extracted operands so
9216 they will be output differently.
9217
9218 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
9219 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
9220 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
9221 The contents of this vector are what will be used to convert the insn
9222 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler output
9223 by changing the contents of the vector.
9224
9225 This macro is useful when various assembler syntaxes share a single
9226 file of instruction patterns; by defining this macro differently, you
9227 can cause a large class of instructions to be output differently (such
9228 as with rearranged operands). Naturally, variations in assembler
9229 syntax affecting individual insn patterns ought to be handled by
9230 writing conditional output routines in those patterns.
9231
9232 If this macro is not defined, it is equivalent to a null statement.
9233 @end defmac
9234
9235 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_FINAL_POSTSCAN_INSN (FILE *@var{file}, rtx_insn *@var{insn}, rtx *@var{opvec}, int @var{noperands})
9236 If defined, this target hook is a function which is executed just after the
9237 output of assembler code for @var{insn}, to change the mode of the assembler
9238 if necessary.
9239
9240 Here the argument @var{opvec} is the vector containing the operands
9241 extracted from @var{insn}, and @var{noperands} is the number of
9242 elements of the vector which contain meaningful data for this insn.
9243 The contents of this vector are what was used to convert the insn
9244 template into assembler code, so you can change the assembler mode
9245 by checking the contents of the vector.
9246 @end deftypefn
9247
9248 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND (@var{stream}, @var{x}, @var{code})
9249 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
9250 assembler syntax for an instruction operand @var{x}. @var{x} is an
9251 RTL expression.
9252
9253 @var{code} is a value that can be used to specify one of several ways
9254 of printing the operand. It is used when identical operands must be
9255 printed differently depending on the context. @var{code} comes from
9256 the @samp{%} specification that was used to request printing of the
9257 operand. If the specification was just @samp{%@var{digit}} then
9258 @var{code} is 0; if the specification was @samp{%@var{ltr}
9259 @var{digit}} then @var{code} is the ASCII code for @var{ltr}.
9260
9261 @findex reg_names
9262 If @var{x} is a register, this macro should print the register's name.
9263 The names can be found in an array @code{reg_names} whose type is
9264 @code{char *[]}. @code{reg_names} is initialized from
9265 @code{REGISTER_NAMES}.
9266
9267 When the machine description has a specification @samp{%@var{punct}}
9268 (a @samp{%} followed by a punctuation character), this macro is called
9269 with a null pointer for @var{x} and the punctuation character for
9270 @var{code}.
9271 @end defmac
9272
9273 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P (@var{code})
9274 A C expression which evaluates to true if @var{code} is a valid
9275 punctuation character for use in the @code{PRINT_OPERAND} macro. If
9276 @code{PRINT_OPERAND_PUNCT_VALID_P} is not defined, it means that no
9277 punctuation characters (except for the standard one, @samp{%}) are used
9278 in this way.
9279 @end defmac
9280
9281 @defmac PRINT_OPERAND_ADDRESS (@var{stream}, @var{x})
9282 A C compound statement to output to stdio stream @var{stream} the
9283 assembler syntax for an instruction operand that is a memory reference
9284 whose address is @var{x}. @var{x} is an RTL expression.
9285
9286 @cindex @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} usage
9287 On some machines, the syntax for a symbolic address depends on the
9288 section that the address refers to. On these machines, define the hook
9289 @code{TARGET_ENCODE_SECTION_INFO} to store the information into the
9290 @code{symbol_ref}, and then check for it here. @xref{Assembler
9291 Format}.
9292 @end defmac
9293
9294 @findex dbr_sequence_length
9295 @defmac DBR_OUTPUT_SEQEND (@var{file})
9296 A C statement, to be executed after all slot-filler instructions have
9297 been output. If necessary, call @code{dbr_sequence_length} to
9298 determine the number of slots filled in a sequence (zero if not
9299 currently outputting a sequence), to decide how many no-ops to output,
9300 or whatever.
9301
9302 Don't define this macro if it has nothing to do, but it is helpful in
9303 reading assembly output if the extent of the delay sequence is made
9304 explicit (e.g.@: with white space).
9305 @end defmac
9306
9307 @findex final_sequence
9308 Note that output routines for instructions with delay slots must be
9309 prepared to deal with not being output as part of a sequence
9310 (i.e.@: when the scheduling pass is not run, or when no slot fillers could be
9311 found.) The variable @code{final_sequence} is null when not
9312 processing a sequence, otherwise it contains the @code{sequence} rtx
9313 being output.
9314
9315 @findex asm_fprintf
9316 @defmac REGISTER_PREFIX
9317 @defmacx LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX
9318 @defmacx USER_LABEL_PREFIX
9319 @defmacx IMMEDIATE_PREFIX
9320 If defined, C string expressions to be used for the @samp{%R}, @samp{%L},
9321 @samp{%U}, and @samp{%I} options of @code{asm_fprintf} (see
9322 @file{final.c}). These are useful when a single @file{md} file must
9323 support multiple assembler formats. In that case, the various @file{tm.h}
9324 files can define these macros differently.
9325 @end defmac
9326
9327 @defmac ASM_FPRINTF_EXTENSIONS (@var{file}, @var{argptr}, @var{format})
9328 If defined this macro should expand to a series of @code{case}
9329 statements which will be parsed inside the @code{switch} statement of
9330 the @code{asm_fprintf} function. This allows targets to define extra
9331 printf formats which may useful when generating their assembler
9332 statements. Note that uppercase letters are reserved for future
9333 generic extensions to asm_fprintf, and so are not available to target
9334 specific code. The output file is given by the parameter @var{file}.
9335 The varargs input pointer is @var{argptr} and the rest of the format
9336 string, starting the character after the one that is being switched
9337 upon, is pointed to by @var{format}.
9338 @end defmac
9339
9340 @defmac ASSEMBLER_DIALECT
9341 If your target supports multiple dialects of assembler language (such as
9342 different opcodes), define this macro as a C expression that gives the
9343 numeric index of the assembler language dialect to use, with zero as the
9344 first variant.
9345
9346 If this macro is defined, you may use constructs of the form
9347 @smallexample
9348 @samp{@{option0|option1|option2@dots{}@}}
9349 @end smallexample
9350 @noindent
9351 in the output templates of patterns (@pxref{Output Template}) or in the
9352 first argument of @code{asm_fprintf}. This construct outputs
9353 @samp{option0}, @samp{option1}, @samp{option2}, etc., if the value of
9354 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} is zero, one, two, etc. Any special characters
9355 within these strings retain their usual meaning. If there are fewer
9356 alternatives within the braces than the value of
9357 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT}, the construct outputs nothing. If it's needed
9358 to print curly braces or @samp{|} character in assembler output directly,
9359 @samp{%@{}, @samp{%@}} and @samp{%|} can be used.
9360
9361 If you do not define this macro, the characters @samp{@{}, @samp{|} and
9362 @samp{@}} do not have any special meaning when used in templates or
9363 operands to @code{asm_fprintf}.
9364
9365 Define the macros @code{REGISTER_PREFIX}, @code{LOCAL_LABEL_PREFIX},
9366 @code{USER_LABEL_PREFIX} and @code{IMMEDIATE_PREFIX} if you can express
9367 the variations in assembler language syntax with that mechanism. Define
9368 @code{ASSEMBLER_DIALECT} and use the @samp{@{option0|option1@}} syntax
9369 if the syntax variant are larger and involve such things as different
9370 opcodes or operand order.
9371 @end defmac
9372
9373 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_PUSH (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
9374 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
9375 which will push hard register number @var{regno} onto the stack.
9376 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
9377 profiling.
9378 @end defmac
9379
9380 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_REG_POP (@var{stream}, @var{regno})
9381 A C expression to output to @var{stream} some assembler code
9382 which will pop hard register number @var{regno} off of the stack.
9383 The code need not be optimal, since this macro is used only when
9384 profiling.
9385 @end defmac
9386
9387 @node Dispatch Tables
9388 @subsection Output of Dispatch Tables
9389
9390 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9391 This concerns dispatch tables.
9392
9393 @cindex dispatch table
9394 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_DIFF_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{body}, @var{value}, @var{rel})
9395 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9396 pseudo-instruction to generate a difference between two labels.
9397 @var{value} and @var{rel} are the numbers of two internal labels. The
9398 definitions of these labels are output using
9399 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}, and they must be printed in the same
9400 way here. For example,
9401
9402 @smallexample
9403 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d-L%d\n",
9404 @var{value}, @var{rel})
9405 @end smallexample
9406
9407 You must provide this macro on machines where the addresses in a
9408 dispatch table are relative to the table's own address. If defined, GCC
9409 will also use this macro on all machines when producing PIC@.
9410 @var{body} is the body of the @code{ADDR_DIFF_VEC}; it is provided so that the
9411 mode and flags can be read.
9412 @end defmac
9413
9414 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ADDR_VEC_ELT (@var{stream}, @var{value})
9415 This macro should be provided on machines where the addresses
9416 in a dispatch table are absolute.
9417
9418 The definition should be a C statement to output to the stdio stream
9419 @var{stream} an assembler pseudo-instruction to generate a reference to
9420 a label. @var{value} is the number of an internal label whose
9421 definition is output using @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
9422 For example,
9423
9424 @smallexample
9425 fprintf (@var{stream}, "\t.word L%d\n", @var{value})
9426 @end smallexample
9427 @end defmac
9428
9429 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_LABEL (@var{stream}, @var{prefix}, @var{num}, @var{table})
9430 Define this if the label before a jump-table needs to be output
9431 specially. The first three arguments are the same as for
9432 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}; the fourth argument is the
9433 jump-table which follows (a @code{jump_table_data} containing an
9434 @code{addr_vec} or @code{addr_diff_vec}).
9435
9436 This feature is used on system V to output a @code{swbeg} statement
9437 for the table.
9438
9439 If this macro is not defined, these labels are output with
9440 @code{(*targetm.asm_out.internal_label)}.
9441 @end defmac
9442
9443 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_CASE_END (@var{stream}, @var{num}, @var{table})
9444 Define this if something special must be output at the end of a
9445 jump-table. The definition should be a C statement to be executed
9446 after the assembler code for the table is written. It should write
9447 the appropriate code to stdio stream @var{stream}. The argument
9448 @var{table} is the jump-table insn, and @var{num} is the label-number
9449 of the preceding label.
9450
9451 If this macro is not defined, nothing special is output at the end of
9452 the jump-table.
9453 @end defmac
9454
9455 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_POST_CFI_STARTPROC (FILE *@var{}, @var{tree})
9456 This target hook is used to emit assembly strings required by the target
9457 after the .cfi_startproc directive. The first argument is the file stream to
9458 write the strings to and the second argument is the function's declaration. The
9459 expected use is to add more .cfi_* directives.
9460
9461 The default is to not output any assembly strings.
9462 @end deftypefn
9463
9464 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_UNWIND_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream}, tree @var{decl}, int @var{for_eh}, int @var{empty})
9465 This target hook emits a label at the beginning of each FDE@. It
9466 should be defined on targets where FDEs need special labels, and it
9467 should write the appropriate label, for the FDE associated with the
9468 function declaration @var{decl}, to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
9469 The third argument, @var{for_eh}, is a boolean: true if this is for an
9470 exception table. The fourth argument, @var{empty}, is a boolean:
9471 true if this is a placeholder label for an omitted FDE@.
9472
9473 The default is that FDEs are not given nonlocal labels.
9474 @end deftypefn
9475
9476 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_TABLE_LABEL (FILE *@var{stream})
9477 This target hook emits a label at the beginning of the exception table.
9478 It should be defined on targets where it is desirable for the table
9479 to be broken up according to function.
9480
9481 The default is that no label is emitted.
9482 @end deftypefn
9483
9484 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_EMIT_EXCEPT_PERSONALITY (rtx @var{personality})
9485 If the target implements @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT}, this hook may be used to emit a directive to install a personality hook into the unwind info. This hook should not be used if dwarf2 unwind info is used.
9486 @end deftypefn
9487
9488 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT (FILE *@var{stream}, rtx_insn *@var{insn})
9489 This target hook emits assembly directives required to unwind the
9490 given instruction. This is only used when @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
9491 returns @code{UI_TARGET}.
9492 @end deftypefn
9493
9494 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT_BEFORE_INSN
9495 True if the @code{TARGET_ASM_UNWIND_EMIT} hook should be called before the assembly for @var{insn} has been emitted, false if the hook should be called afterward.
9496 @end deftypevr
9497
9498 @node Exception Region Output
9499 @subsection Assembler Commands for Exception Regions
9500
9501 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9502
9503 This describes commands marking the start and the end of an exception
9504 region.
9505
9506 @defmac EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME
9507 If defined, a C string constant for the name of the section containing
9508 exception handling frame unwind information. If not defined, GCC will
9509 provide a default definition if the target supports named sections.
9510 @file{crtstuff.c} uses this macro to switch to the appropriate section.
9511
9512 You should define this symbol if your target supports DWARF 2 frame
9513 unwind information and the default definition does not work.
9514 @end defmac
9515
9516 @defmac EH_FRAME_THROUGH_COLLECT2
9517 If defined, DWARF 2 frame unwind information will identified by
9518 specially named labels. The collect2 process will locate these
9519 labels and generate code to register the frames.
9520
9521 This might be necessary, for instance, if the system linker will not
9522 place the eh_frames in-between the sentinals from @file{crtstuff.c},
9523 or if the system linker does garbage collection and sections cannot
9524 be marked as not to be collected.
9525 @end defmac
9526
9527 @defmac EH_TABLES_CAN_BE_READ_ONLY
9528 Define this macro to 1 if your target is such that no frame unwind
9529 information encoding used with non-PIC code will ever require a
9530 runtime relocation, but the linker may not support merging read-only
9531 and read-write sections into a single read-write section.
9532 @end defmac
9533
9534 @defmac MASK_RETURN_ADDR
9535 An rtx used to mask the return address found via @code{RETURN_ADDR_RTX}, so
9536 that it does not contain any extraneous set bits in it.
9537 @end defmac
9538
9539 @defmac DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO
9540 Define this macro to 0 if your target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
9541 information, but it does not yet work with exception handling.
9542 Otherwise, if your target supports this information (if it defines
9543 @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and @code{OBJECT_FORMAT_ELF}),
9544 GCC will provide a default definition of 1.
9545 @end defmac
9546
9547 @deftypefn {Common Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO (struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
9548 This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for exception handling
9549 by the target. If the target has ABI specified unwind tables, the hook
9550 should return @code{UI_TARGET}. If the target is to use the
9551 @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling scheme, the hook
9552 should return @code{UI_SJLJ}. If the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind
9553 information, the hook should return @code{UI_DWARF2}.
9554
9555 A target may, if exceptions are disabled, choose to return @code{UI_NONE}.
9556 This may end up simplifying other parts of target-specific code. The
9557 default implementation of this hook never returns @code{UI_NONE}.
9558
9559 Note that the value returned by this hook should be constant. It should
9560 not depend on anything except the command-line switches described by
9561 @var{opts}. In particular, the
9562 setting @code{UI_SJLJ} must be fixed at compiler start-up as C pre-processor
9563 macros and builtin functions related to exception handling are set up
9564 depending on this setting.
9565
9566 The default implementation of the hook first honors the
9567 @option{--enable-sjlj-exceptions} configure option, then
9568 @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO}, and finally defaults to @code{UI_SJLJ}. If
9569 @code{DWARF2_UNWIND_INFO} depends on command-line options, the target
9570 must define this hook so that @var{opts} is used correctly.
9571 @end deftypefn
9572
9573 @deftypevr {Common Target Hook} bool TARGET_UNWIND_TABLES_DEFAULT
9574 This variable should be set to @code{true} if the target ABI requires unwinding
9575 tables even when exceptions are not used. It must not be modified by
9576 command-line option processing.
9577 @end deftypevr
9578
9579 @defmac DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP
9580 Define this macro to 1 if the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based scheme
9581 should use the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp} functions from the C library
9582 instead of the @code{__builtin_setjmp}/@code{__builtin_longjmp} machinery.
9583 @end defmac
9584
9585 @defmac JMP_BUF_SIZE
9586 This macro has no effect unless @code{DONT_USE_BUILTIN_SETJMP} is also
9587 defined. Define this macro if the default size of @code{jmp_buf} buffer
9588 for the @code{setjmp}/@code{longjmp}-based exception handling mechanism
9589 is not large enough, or if it is much too large.
9590 The default size is @code{FIRST_PSEUDO_REGISTER * sizeof(void *)}.
9591 @end defmac
9592
9593 @defmac DWARF_CIE_DATA_ALIGNMENT
9594 This macro need only be defined if the target might save registers in the
9595 function prologue at an offset to the stack pointer that is not aligned to
9596 @code{UNITS_PER_WORD}. The definition should be the negative minimum
9597 alignment if @code{STACK_GROWS_DOWNWARD} is true, and the positive
9598 minimum alignment otherwise. @xref{DWARF}. Only applicable if
9599 the target supports DWARF 2 frame unwind information.
9600 @end defmac
9601
9602 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_TERMINATE_DW2_EH_FRAME_INFO
9603 Contains the value true if the target should add a zero word onto the
9604 end of a Dwarf-2 frame info section when used for exception handling.
9605 Default value is false if @code{EH_FRAME_SECTION_NAME} is defined, and
9606 true otherwise.
9607 @end deftypevr
9608
9609 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_DWARF_REGISTER_SPAN (rtx @var{reg})
9610 Given a register, this hook should return a parallel of registers to
9611 represent where to find the register pieces. Define this hook if the
9612 register and its mode are represented in Dwarf in non-contiguous
9613 locations, or if the register should be represented in more than one
9614 register in Dwarf. Otherwise, this hook should return @code{NULL_RTX}.
9615 If not defined, the default is to return @code{NULL_RTX}.
9616 @end deftypefn
9617
9618 @deftypefn {Target Hook} machine_mode TARGET_DWARF_FRAME_REG_MODE (int @var{regno})
9619 Given a register, this hook should return the mode which the
9620 corresponding Dwarf frame register should have. This is normally
9621 used to return a smaller mode than the raw mode to prevent call
9622 clobbered parts of a register altering the frame register size
9623 @end deftypefn
9624
9625 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_DWARF_REG_SIZES_EXTRA (tree @var{address})
9626 If some registers are represented in Dwarf-2 unwind information in
9627 multiple pieces, define this hook to fill in information about the
9628 sizes of those pieces in the table used by the unwinder at runtime.
9629 It will be called by @code{expand_builtin_init_dwarf_reg_sizes} after
9630 filling in a single size corresponding to each hard register;
9631 @var{address} is the address of the table.
9632 @end deftypefn
9633
9634 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ASM_TTYPE (rtx @var{sym})
9635 This hook is used to output a reference from a frame unwinding table to
9636 the type_info object identified by @var{sym}. It should return @code{true}
9637 if the reference was output. Returning @code{false} will cause the
9638 reference to be output using the normal Dwarf2 routines.
9639 @end deftypefn
9640
9641 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ARM_EABI_UNWINDER
9642 This flag should be set to @code{true} on targets that use an ARM EABI
9643 based unwinding library, and @code{false} on other targets. This effects
9644 the format of unwinding tables, and how the unwinder in entered after
9645 running a cleanup. The default is @code{false}.
9646 @end deftypevr
9647
9648 @node Alignment Output
9649 @subsection Assembler Commands for Alignment
9650
9651 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9652 This describes commands for alignment.
9653
9654 @defmac JUMP_ALIGN (@var{label})
9655 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which is
9656 a common destination of jumps and has no fallthru incoming edge.
9657
9658 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9659 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9660 define the macro.
9661
9662 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9663 to set the variable @var{align_jumps} in the target's
9664 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9665 selection in @var{align_jumps} in a @code{JUMP_ALIGN} implementation.
9666 @end defmac
9667
9668 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER (@var{label})
9669 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}, which follows
9670 a @code{BARRIER}.
9671
9672 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9673 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9674 define the macro.
9675 @end defmac
9676
9677 @defmac LOOP_ALIGN (@var{label})
9678 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label} that heads
9679 a frequently executed basic block (usually the header of a loop).
9680
9681 This macro need not be defined if you don't want any special alignment
9682 to be done at such a time. Most machine descriptions do not currently
9683 define the macro.
9684
9685 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9686 to set the variable @code{align_loops} in the target's
9687 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9688 selection in @code{align_loops} in a @code{LOOP_ALIGN} implementation.
9689 @end defmac
9690
9691 @defmac LABEL_ALIGN (@var{label})
9692 The alignment (log base 2) to put in front of @var{label}.
9693 If @code{LABEL_ALIGN_AFTER_BARRIER} / @code{LOOP_ALIGN} specify a different alignment,
9694 the maximum of the specified values is used.
9695
9696 Unless it's necessary to inspect the @var{label} parameter, it is better
9697 to set the variable @code{align_labels} in the target's
9698 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}. Otherwise, you should try to honor the user's
9699 selection in @code{align_labels} in a @code{LABEL_ALIGN} implementation.
9700 @end defmac
9701
9702 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP (@var{stream}, @var{nbytes})
9703 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9704 instruction to advance the location counter by @var{nbytes} bytes.
9705 Those bytes should be zero when loaded. @var{nbytes} will be a C
9706 expression of type @code{unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT}.
9707 @end defmac
9708
9709 @defmac ASM_NO_SKIP_IN_TEXT
9710 Define this macro if @code{ASM_OUTPUT_SKIP} should not be used in the
9711 text section because it fails to put zeros in the bytes that are skipped.
9712 This is true on many Unix systems, where the pseudo--op to skip bytes
9713 produces no-op instructions rather than zeros when used in the text
9714 section.
9715 @end defmac
9716
9717 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9718 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9719 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9720 @var{power} bytes. @var{power} will be a C expression of type @code{int}.
9721 @end defmac
9722
9723 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN_WITH_NOP (@var{stream}, @var{power})
9724 Like @code{ASM_OUTPUT_ALIGN}, except that the ``nop'' instruction is used
9725 for padding, if necessary.
9726 @end defmac
9727
9728 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_MAX_SKIP_ALIGN (@var{stream}, @var{power}, @var{max_skip})
9729 A C statement to output to the stdio stream @var{stream} an assembler
9730 command to advance the location counter to a multiple of 2 to the
9731 @var{power} bytes, but only if @var{max_skip} or fewer bytes are needed to
9732 satisfy the alignment request. @var{power} and @var{max_skip} will be
9733 a C expression of type @code{int}.
9734 @end defmac
9735
9736 @need 3000
9737 @node Debugging Info
9738 @section Controlling Debugging Information Format
9739
9740 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9741 This describes how to specify debugging information.
9742
9743 @menu
9744 * All Debuggers:: Macros that affect all debugging formats uniformly.
9745 * DBX Options:: Macros enabling specific options in DBX format.
9746 * DBX Hooks:: Hook macros for varying DBX format.
9747 * File Names and DBX:: Macros controlling output of file names in DBX format.
9748 * DWARF:: Macros for DWARF format.
9749 * VMS Debug:: Macros for VMS debug format.
9750 @end menu
9751
9752 @node All Debuggers
9753 @subsection Macros Affecting All Debugging Formats
9754
9755 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9756 These macros affect all debugging formats.
9757
9758 @defmac DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER (@var{regno})
9759 A C expression that returns the DBX register number for the compiler
9760 register number @var{regno}. In the default macro provided, the value
9761 of this expression will be @var{regno} itself. But sometimes there are
9762 some registers that the compiler knows about and DBX does not, or vice
9763 versa. In such cases, some register may need to have one number in the
9764 compiler and another for DBX@.
9765
9766 If two registers have consecutive numbers inside GCC, and they can be
9767 used as a pair to hold a multiword value, then they @emph{must} have
9768 consecutive numbers after renumbering with @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER}.
9769 Otherwise, debuggers will be unable to access such a pair, because they
9770 expect register pairs to be consecutive in their own numbering scheme.
9771
9772 If you find yourself defining @code{DBX_REGISTER_NUMBER} in way that
9773 does not preserve register pairs, then what you must do instead is
9774 redefine the actual register numbering scheme.
9775 @end defmac
9776
9777 @defmac DEBUGGER_AUTO_OFFSET (@var{x})
9778 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an automatic
9779 variable having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The default
9780 computation assumes that @var{x} is based on the frame-pointer and
9781 gives the offset from the frame-pointer. This is required for targets
9782 that produce debugging output for DBX and allow the frame-pointer to be
9783 eliminated when the @option{-g} option is used.
9784 @end defmac
9785
9786 @defmac DEBUGGER_ARG_OFFSET (@var{offset}, @var{x})
9787 A C expression that returns the integer offset value for an argument
9788 having address @var{x} (an RTL expression). The nominal offset is
9789 @var{offset}.
9790 @end defmac
9791
9792 @defmac PREFERRED_DEBUGGING_TYPE
9793 A C expression that returns the type of debugging output GCC should
9794 produce when the user specifies just @option{-g}. Define
9795 this if you have arranged for GCC to support more than one format of
9796 debugging output. Currently, the allowable values are @code{DBX_DEBUG},
9797 @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}, @code{XCOFF_DEBUG}, @code{VMS_DEBUG},
9798 and @code{VMS_AND_DWARF2_DEBUG}.
9799
9800 When the user specifies @option{-ggdb}, GCC normally also uses the
9801 value of this macro to select the debugging output format, but with two
9802 exceptions. If @code{DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO} is defined, GCC uses the
9803 value @code{DWARF2_DEBUG}. Otherwise, if @code{DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO} is
9804 defined, GCC uses @code{DBX_DEBUG}.
9805
9806 The value of this macro only affects the default debugging output; the
9807 user can always get a specific type of output by using @option{-gstabs},
9808 @option{-gdwarf-2}, @option{-gxcoff}, or @option{-gvms}.
9809 @end defmac
9810
9811 @node DBX Options
9812 @subsection Specific Options for DBX Output
9813
9814 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9815 These are specific options for DBX output.
9816
9817 @defmac DBX_DEBUGGING_INFO
9818 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for DBX
9819 in response to the @option{-g} option.
9820 @end defmac
9821
9822 @defmac XCOFF_DEBUGGING_INFO
9823 Define this macro if GCC should produce XCOFF format debugging output
9824 in response to the @option{-g} option. This is a variant of DBX format.
9825 @end defmac
9826
9827 @defmac DEFAULT_GDB_EXTENSIONS
9828 Define this macro to control whether GCC should by default generate
9829 GDB's extended version of DBX debugging information (assuming DBX-format
9830 debugging information is enabled at all). If you don't define the
9831 macro, the default is 1: always generate the extended information
9832 if there is any occasion to.
9833 @end defmac
9834
9835 @defmac DEBUG_SYMS_TEXT
9836 Define this macro if all @code{.stabs} commands should be output while
9837 in the text section.
9838 @end defmac
9839
9840 @defmac ASM_STABS_OP
9841 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9842 use instead of @code{"\t.stabs\t"} to define an ordinary debugging symbol.
9843 If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabs\t"} is used. This macro
9844 applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9845 @end defmac
9846
9847 @defmac ASM_STABD_OP
9848 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9849 use instead of @code{"\t.stabd\t"} to define a debugging symbol whose
9850 value is the current location. If you don't define this macro,
9851 @code{"\t.stabd\t"} is used. This macro applies only to DBX debugging
9852 information format.
9853 @end defmac
9854
9855 @defmac ASM_STABN_OP
9856 A C string constant, including spacing, naming the assembler pseudo op to
9857 use instead of @code{"\t.stabn\t"} to define a debugging symbol with no
9858 name. If you don't define this macro, @code{"\t.stabn\t"} is used. This
9859 macro applies only to DBX debugging information format.
9860 @end defmac
9861
9862 @defmac DBX_NO_XREFS
9863 Define this macro if DBX on your system does not support the construct
9864 @samp{xs@var{tagname}}. On some systems, this construct is used to
9865 describe a forward reference to a structure named @var{tagname}.
9866 On other systems, this construct is not supported at all.
9867 @end defmac
9868
9869 @defmac DBX_CONTIN_LENGTH
9870 A symbol name in DBX-format debugging information is normally
9871 continued (split into two separate @code{.stabs} directives) when it
9872 exceeds a certain length (by default, 80 characters). On some
9873 operating systems, DBX requires this splitting; on others, splitting
9874 must not be done. You can inhibit splitting by defining this macro
9875 with the value zero. You can override the default splitting-length by
9876 defining this macro as an expression for the length you desire.
9877 @end defmac
9878
9879 @defmac DBX_CONTIN_CHAR
9880 Normally continuation is indicated by adding a @samp{\} character to
9881 the end of a @code{.stabs} string when a continuation follows. To use
9882 a different character instead, define this macro as a character
9883 constant for the character you want to use. Do not define this macro
9884 if backslash is correct for your system.
9885 @end defmac
9886
9887 @defmac DBX_STATIC_STAB_DATA_SECTION
9888 Define this macro if it is necessary to go to the data section before
9889 outputting the @samp{.stabs} pseudo-op for a non-global static
9890 variable.
9891 @end defmac
9892
9893 @defmac DBX_TYPE_DECL_STABS_CODE
9894 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9895 for a typedef. The default is @code{N_LSYM}.
9896 @end defmac
9897
9898 @defmac DBX_STATIC_CONST_VAR_CODE
9899 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9900 for a static variable located in the text section. DBX format does not
9901 provide any ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_FUN}.
9902 @end defmac
9903
9904 @defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_CODE
9905 The value to use in the ``code'' field of the @code{.stabs} directive
9906 for a parameter passed in registers. DBX format does not provide any
9907 ``right'' way to do this. The default is @code{N_RSYM}.
9908 @end defmac
9909
9910 @defmac DBX_REGPARM_STABS_LETTER
9911 The letter to use in DBX symbol data to identify a symbol as a parameter
9912 passed in registers. DBX format does not customarily provide any way to
9913 do this. The default is @code{'P'}.
9914 @end defmac
9915
9916 @defmac DBX_FUNCTION_FIRST
9917 Define this macro if the DBX information for a function and its
9918 arguments should precede the assembler code for the function. Normally,
9919 in DBX format, the debugging information entirely follows the assembler
9920 code.
9921 @end defmac
9922
9923 @defmac DBX_BLOCKS_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9924 Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol describing
9925 the scope of a block (@code{N_LBRAC} or @code{N_RBRAC}) should be
9926 relative to the start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses
9927 an absolute address.
9928 @end defmac
9929
9930 @defmac DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE
9931 Define this macro, with value 1, if the value of a symbol indicating
9932 the current line number (@code{N_SLINE}) should be relative to the
9933 start of the enclosing function. Normally, GCC uses an absolute address.
9934 @end defmac
9935
9936 @defmac DBX_USE_BINCL
9937 Define this macro if GCC should generate @code{N_BINCL} and
9938 @code{N_EINCL} stabs for included header files, as on Sun systems. This
9939 macro also directs GCC to output a type number as a pair of a file
9940 number and a type number within the file. Normally, GCC does not
9941 generate @code{N_BINCL} or @code{N_EINCL} stabs, and it outputs a single
9942 number for a type number.
9943 @end defmac
9944
9945 @node DBX Hooks
9946 @subsection Open-Ended Hooks for DBX Format
9947
9948 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9949 These are hooks for DBX format.
9950
9951 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_SOURCE_LINE (@var{stream}, @var{line}, @var{counter})
9952 A C statement to output DBX debugging information before code for line
9953 number @var{line} of the current source file to the stdio stream
9954 @var{stream}. @var{counter} is the number of time the macro was
9955 invoked, including the current invocation; it is intended to generate
9956 unique labels in the assembly output.
9957
9958 This macro should not be defined if the default output is correct, or
9959 if it can be made correct by defining @code{DBX_LINES_FUNCTION_RELATIVE}.
9960 @end defmac
9961
9962 @defmac NO_DBX_FUNCTION_END
9963 Some stabs encapsulation formats (in particular ECOFF), cannot handle the
9964 @code{.stabs "",N_FUN,,0,0,Lscope-function-1} gdb dbx extension construct.
9965 On those machines, define this macro to turn this feature off without
9966 disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9967 @end defmac
9968
9969 @defmac NO_DBX_BNSYM_ENSYM
9970 Some assemblers cannot handle the @code{.stabd BNSYM/ENSYM,0,0} gdb dbx
9971 extension construct. On those machines, define this macro to turn this
9972 feature off without disturbing the rest of the gdb extensions.
9973 @end defmac
9974
9975 @node File Names and DBX
9976 @subsection File Names in DBX Format
9977
9978 @c prevent bad page break with this line
9979 This describes file names in DBX format.
9980
9981 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILENAME (@var{stream}, @var{name})
9982 A C statement to output DBX debugging information to the stdio stream
9983 @var{stream}, which indicates that file @var{name} is the main source
9984 file---the file specified as the input file for compilation.
9985 This macro is called only once, at the beginning of compilation.
9986
9987 This macro need not be defined if the standard form of output
9988 for DBX debugging information is appropriate.
9989
9990 It may be necessary to refer to a label equal to the beginning of the
9991 text section. You can use @samp{assemble_name (stream, ltext_label_name)}
9992 to do so. If you do this, you must also set the variable
9993 @var{used_ltext_label_name} to @code{true}.
9994 @end defmac
9995
9996 @defmac NO_DBX_MAIN_SOURCE_DIRECTORY
9997 Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
9998 of the current directory for compilation and current source language at
9999 the beginning of the file.
10000 @end defmac
10001
10002 @defmac NO_DBX_GCC_MARKER
10003 Define this macro, with value 1, if GCC should not emit an indication
10004 that this object file was compiled by GCC@. The default is to emit
10005 an @code{N_OPT} stab at the beginning of every source file, with
10006 @samp{gcc2_compiled.} for the string and value 0.
10007 @end defmac
10008
10009 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END (@var{stream}, @var{name})
10010 A C statement to output DBX debugging information at the end of
10011 compilation of the main source file @var{name}. Output should be
10012 written to the stdio stream @var{stream}.
10013
10014 If you don't define this macro, nothing special is output at the end
10015 of compilation, which is correct for most machines.
10016 @end defmac
10017
10018 @defmac DBX_OUTPUT_NULL_N_SO_AT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END
10019 Define this macro @emph{instead of} defining
10020 @code{DBX_OUTPUT_MAIN_SOURCE_FILE_END}, if what needs to be output at
10021 the end of compilation is an @code{N_SO} stab with an empty string,
10022 whose value is the highest absolute text address in the file.
10023 @end defmac
10024
10025 @need 2000
10026 @node DWARF
10027 @subsection Macros for DWARF Output
10028
10029 @c prevent bad page break with this line
10030 Here are macros for DWARF output.
10031
10032 @defmac DWARF2_DEBUGGING_INFO
10033 Define this macro if GCC should produce dwarf version 2 format
10034 debugging output in response to the @option{-g} option.
10035
10036 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_DWARF_CALLING_CONVENTION (const_tree @var{function})
10037 Define this to enable the dwarf attribute @code{DW_AT_calling_convention} to
10038 be emitted for each function. Instead of an integer return the enum
10039 value for the @code{DW_CC_} tag.
10040 @end deftypefn
10041
10042 To support optional call frame debugging information, you must also
10043 define @code{INCOMING_RETURN_ADDR_RTX} and either set
10044 @code{RTX_FRAME_RELATED_P} on the prologue insns if you use RTL for the
10045 prologue, or call @code{dwarf2out_def_cfa} and @code{dwarf2out_reg_save}
10046 as appropriate from @code{TARGET_ASM_FUNCTION_PROLOGUE} if you don't.
10047 @end defmac
10048
10049 @defmac DWARF2_FRAME_INFO
10050 Define this macro to a nonzero value if GCC should always output
10051 Dwarf 2 frame information. If @code{TARGET_EXCEPT_UNWIND_INFO}
10052 (@pxref{Exception Region Output}) returns @code{UI_DWARF2}, and
10053 exceptions are enabled, GCC will output this information not matter
10054 how you define @code{DWARF2_FRAME_INFO}.
10055 @end defmac
10056
10057 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {enum unwind_info_type} TARGET_DEBUG_UNWIND_INFO (void)
10058 This hook defines the mechanism that will be used for describing frame
10059 unwind information to the debugger. Normally the hook will return
10060 @code{UI_DWARF2} if DWARF 2 debug information is enabled, and
10061 return @code{UI_NONE} otherwise.
10062
10063 A target may return @code{UI_DWARF2} even when DWARF 2 debug information
10064 is disabled in order to always output DWARF 2 frame information.
10065
10066 A target may return @code{UI_TARGET} if it has ABI specified unwind tables.
10067 This will suppress generation of the normal debug frame unwind information.
10068 @end deftypefn
10069
10070 @defmac DWARF2_ASM_LINE_DEBUG_INFO
10071 Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler can generate Dwarf 2
10072 line debug info sections. This will result in much more compact line number
10073 tables, and hence is desirable if it works.
10074 @end defmac
10075
10076 @defmac DWARF2_ASM_VIEW_DEBUG_INFO
10077 Define this macro to be a nonzero value if the assembler supports view
10078 assignment and verification in @code{.loc}. If it does not, but the
10079 user enables location views, the compiler may have to fallback to
10080 internal line number tables.
10081 @end defmac
10082
10083 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_RESET_LOCATION_VIEW (rtx_insn *@var{})
10084 This hook, if defined, enables -ginternal-reset-location-views, and
10085 uses its result to override cases in which the estimated min insn
10086 length might be nonzero even when a PC advance (i.e., a view reset)
10087 cannot be taken for granted.
10088
10089 If the hook is defined, it must return a positive value to indicate
10090 the insn definitely advances the PC, and so the view number can be
10091 safely assumed to be reset; a negative value to mean the insn
10092 definitely does not advance the PC, and os the view number must not
10093 be reset; or zero to decide based on the estimated insn length.
10094
10095 If insn length is to be regarded as reliable, set the hook to
10096 @code{hook_int_rtx_insn_0}.
10097 @end deftypefn
10098
10099 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_WANT_DEBUG_PUB_SECTIONS
10100 True if the @code{.debug_pubtypes} and @code{.debug_pubnames} sections should be emitted. These sections are not used on most platforms, and in particular GDB does not use them.
10101 @end deftypevr
10102
10103 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_SCHED2
10104 True if sched2 is not to be run at its normal place.
10105 This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.
10106 @end deftypevr
10107
10108 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_DELAY_VARTRACK
10109 True if vartrack is not to be run at its normal place.
10110 This usually means it will be run as part of machine-specific reorg.
10111 @end deftypevr
10112
10113 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_NO_REGISTER_ALLOCATION
10114 True if register allocation and the passes
10115 following it should not be run. Usually true only for virtual assembler
10116 targets.
10117 @end deftypevr
10118
10119 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
10120 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
10121 @var{lab1} minus @var{lab2}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
10122 @end defmac
10123
10124 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_VMS_DELTA (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label1}, @var{label2})
10125 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a difference
10126 between the two given labels in system defined units, e.g.@: instruction
10127 slots on IA64 VMS, using an integer of the given size.
10128 @end defmac
10129
10130 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_OFFSET (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label}, @var{offset}, @var{section})
10131 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a
10132 section-relative reference to the given @var{label} plus @var{offset}, using
10133 an integer of the given @var{size}. The label is known to be defined in the
10134 given @var{section}.
10135 @end defmac
10136
10137 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_PCREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
10138 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a self-relative
10139 reference to the given @var{label}, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
10140 @end defmac
10141
10142 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DATAREL (@var{stream}, @var{size}, @var{label})
10143 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to the
10144 given @var{label} relative to the dbase, using an integer of the given @var{size}.
10145 @end defmac
10146
10147 @defmac ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_TABLE_REF (@var{label})
10148 A C statement to issue assembly directives that create a reference to
10149 the DWARF table identifier @var{label} from the current section. This
10150 is used on some systems to avoid garbage collecting a DWARF table which
10151 is referenced by a function.
10152 @end defmac
10153
10154 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ASM_OUTPUT_DWARF_DTPREL (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{size}, rtx @var{x})
10155 If defined, this target hook is a function which outputs a DTP-relative
10156 reference to the given TLS symbol of the specified size.
10157 @end deftypefn
10158
10159 @need 2000
10160 @node VMS Debug
10161 @subsection Macros for VMS Debug Format
10162
10163 @c prevent bad page break with this line
10164 Here are macros for VMS debug format.
10165
10166 @defmac VMS_DEBUGGING_INFO
10167 Define this macro if GCC should produce debugging output for VMS
10168 in response to the @option{-g} option. The default behavior for VMS
10169 is to generate minimal debug info for a traceback in the absence of
10170 @option{-g} unless explicitly overridden with @option{-g0}. This
10171 behavior is controlled by @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} and
10172 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE}.
10173 @end defmac
10174
10175 @node Floating Point
10176 @section Cross Compilation and Floating Point
10177 @cindex cross compilation and floating point
10178 @cindex floating point and cross compilation
10179
10180 While all modern machines use twos-complement representation for integers,
10181 there are a variety of representations for floating point numbers. This
10182 means that in a cross-compiler the representation of floating point numbers
10183 in the compiled program may be different from that used in the machine
10184 doing the compilation.
10185
10186 Because different representation systems may offer different amounts of
10187 range and precision, all floating point constants must be represented in
10188 the target machine's format. Therefore, the cross compiler cannot
10189 safely use the host machine's floating point arithmetic; it must emulate
10190 the target's arithmetic. To ensure consistency, GCC always uses
10191 emulation to work with floating point values, even when the host and
10192 target floating point formats are identical.
10193
10194 The following macros are provided by @file{real.h} for the compiler to
10195 use. All parts of the compiler which generate or optimize
10196 floating-point calculations must use these macros. They may evaluate
10197 their operands more than once, so operands must not have side effects.
10198
10199 @defmac REAL_VALUE_TYPE
10200 The C data type to be used to hold a floating point value in the target
10201 machine's format. Typically this is a @code{struct} containing an
10202 array of @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}, but all code should treat it as an opaque
10203 quantity.
10204 @end defmac
10205
10206 @deftypefn Macro HOST_WIDE_INT REAL_VALUE_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
10207 Truncates @var{x} to a signed integer, rounding toward zero.
10208 @end deftypefn
10209
10210 @deftypefn Macro {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} REAL_VALUE_UNSIGNED_FIX (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
10211 Truncates @var{x} to an unsigned integer, rounding toward zero. If
10212 @var{x} is negative, returns zero.
10213 @end deftypefn
10214
10215 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ATOF (const char *@var{string}, machine_mode @var{mode})
10216 Converts @var{string} into a floating point number in the target machine's
10217 representation for mode @var{mode}. This routine can handle both
10218 decimal and hexadecimal floating point constants, using the syntax
10219 defined by the C language for both.
10220 @end deftypefn
10221
10222 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_NEGATIVE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
10223 Returns 1 if @var{x} is negative (including negative zero), 0 otherwise.
10224 @end deftypefn
10225
10226 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISINF (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
10227 Determines whether @var{x} represents infinity (positive or negative).
10228 @end deftypefn
10229
10230 @deftypefn Macro int REAL_VALUE_ISNAN (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
10231 Determines whether @var{x} represents a ``NaN'' (not-a-number).
10232 @end deftypefn
10233
10234 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_NEGATE (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
10235 Returns the negative of the floating point value @var{x}.
10236 @end deftypefn
10237
10238 @deftypefn Macro REAL_VALUE_TYPE REAL_VALUE_ABS (REAL_VALUE_TYPE @var{x})
10239 Returns the absolute value of @var{x}.
10240 @end deftypefn
10241
10242 @node Mode Switching
10243 @section Mode Switching Instructions
10244 @cindex mode switching
10245 The following macros control mode switching optimizations:
10246
10247 @defmac OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING (@var{entity})
10248 Define this macro if the port needs extra instructions inserted for mode
10249 switching in an optimizing compilation.
10250
10251 For an example, the SH4 can perform both single and double precision
10252 floating point operations, but to perform a single precision operation,
10253 the FPSCR PR bit has to be cleared, while for a double precision
10254 operation, this bit has to be set. Changing the PR bit requires a general
10255 purpose register as a scratch register, hence these FPSCR sets have to
10256 be inserted before reload, i.e.@: you cannot put this into instruction emitting
10257 or @code{TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG}.
10258
10259 You can have multiple entities that are mode-switched, and select at run time
10260 which entities actually need it. @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} should
10261 return nonzero for any @var{entity} that needs mode-switching.
10262 If you define this macro, you also have to define
10263 @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, @code{TARGET_MODE_NEEDED},
10264 @code{TARGET_MODE_PRIORITY} and @code{TARGET_MODE_EMIT}.
10265 @code{TARGET_MODE_AFTER}, @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY}, and @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT}
10266 are optional.
10267 @end defmac
10268
10269 @defmac NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING
10270 If you define @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING}, you have to define this as
10271 initializer for an array of integers. Each initializer element
10272 N refers to an entity that needs mode switching, and specifies the number
10273 of different modes that might need to be set for this entity.
10274 The position of the initializer in the initializer---starting counting at
10275 zero---determines the integer that is used to refer to the mode-switched
10276 entity in question.
10277 In macros that take mode arguments / yield a mode result, modes are
10278 represented as numbers 0 @dots{} N @minus{} 1. N is used to specify that no mode
10279 switch is needed / supplied.
10280 @end defmac
10281
10282 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_MODE_EMIT (int @var{entity}, int @var{mode}, int @var{prev_mode}, HARD_REG_SET @var{regs_live})
10283 Generate one or more insns to set @var{entity} to @var{mode}. @var{hard_reg_live} is the set of hard registers live at the point where the insn(s) are to be inserted. @var{prev_moxde} indicates the mode to switch from. Sets of a lower numbered entity will be emitted before sets of a higher numbered entity to a mode of the same or lower priority.
10284 @end deftypefn
10285
10286 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_NEEDED (int @var{entity}, rtx_insn *@var{insn})
10287 @var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If @code{OPTIMIZE_MODE_SWITCHING} is defined, you must define this macro to return an integer value not larger than the corresponding element in @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING}, to denote the mode that @var{entity} must be switched into prior to the execution of @var{insn}.
10288 @end deftypefn
10289
10290 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_AFTER (int @var{entity}, int @var{mode}, rtx_insn *@var{insn})
10291 @var{entity} is an integer specifying a mode-switched entity. If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{insn} during mode switching. It determines the mode that an insn results in (if different from the incoming mode).
10292 @end deftypefn
10293
10294 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_ENTRY (int @var{entity})
10295 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function entry. If @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY} is defined then @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT} must be defined.
10296 @end deftypefn
10297
10298 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_EXIT (int @var{entity})
10299 If this macro is defined, it is evaluated for every @var{entity} that needs mode switching. It should evaluate to an integer, which is a mode that @var{entity} is assumed to be switched to at function exit. If @code{TARGET_MODE_EXIT} is defined then @code{TARGET_MODE_ENTRY} must be defined.
10300 @end deftypefn
10301
10302 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_PRIORITY (int @var{entity}, int @var{n})
10303 This macro specifies the order in which modes for @var{entity} are processed. 0 is the highest priority, @code{NUM_MODES_FOR_MODE_SWITCHING[@var{entity}] - 1} the lowest. The value of the macro should be an integer designating a mode for @var{entity}. For any fixed @var{entity}, @code{mode_priority} (@var{entity}, @var{n}) shall be a bijection in 0 @dots{} @code{num_modes_for_mode_switching[@var{entity}] - 1}.
10304 @end deftypefn
10305
10306 @node Target Attributes
10307 @section Defining target-specific uses of @code{__attribute__}
10308 @cindex target attributes
10309 @cindex machine attributes
10310 @cindex attributes, target-specific
10311
10312 Target-specific attributes may be defined for functions, data and types.
10313 These are described using the following target hooks; they also need to
10314 be documented in @file{extend.texi}.
10315
10316 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const struct attribute_spec *} TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TABLE
10317 If defined, this target hook points to an array of @samp{struct
10318 attribute_spec} (defined in @file{tree-core.h}) specifying the machine
10319 specific attributes for this target and some of the restrictions on the
10320 entities to which these attributes are applied and the arguments they
10321 take.
10322 @end deftypevr
10323
10324 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ATTRIBUTE_TAKES_IDENTIFIER_P (const_tree @var{name})
10325 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns true if the
10326 machine-specific attribute named @var{name} expects an identifier
10327 given as its first argument to be passed on as a plain identifier, not
10328 subjected to name lookup. If this is not defined, the default is
10329 false for all machine-specific attributes.
10330 @end deftypefn
10331
10332 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMP_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
10333 If defined, this target hook is a function which returns zero if the attributes on
10334 @var{type1} and @var{type2} are incompatible, one if they are compatible,
10335 and two if they are nearly compatible (which causes a warning to be
10336 generated). If this is not defined, machine-specific attributes are
10337 supposed always to be compatible.
10338 @end deftypefn
10339
10340 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_DEFAULT_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type})
10341 If defined, this target hook is a function which assigns default attributes to
10342 the newly defined @var{type}.
10343 @end deftypefn
10344
10345 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_TYPE_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{type1}, tree @var{type2})
10346 Define this target hook if the merging of type attributes needs special
10347 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
10348 @code{TYPE_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{type1} and @var{type2}. It is assumed
10349 that @code{comptypes} has already been called and returned 1. This
10350 function may call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent
10351 merging.
10352 @end deftypefn
10353
10354 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{olddecl}, tree @var{newdecl})
10355 Define this target hook if the merging of decl attributes needs special
10356 handling. If defined, the result is a list of the combined
10357 @code{DECL_ATTRIBUTES} of @var{olddecl} and @var{newdecl}.
10358 @var{newdecl} is a duplicate declaration of @var{olddecl}. Examples of
10359 when this is needed are when one attribute overrides another, or when an
10360 attribute is nullified by a subsequent definition. This function may
10361 call @code{merge_attributes} to handle machine-independent merging.
10362
10363 @findex TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES
10364 If the only target-specific handling you require is @samp{dllimport}
10365 for Microsoft Windows targets, you should define the macro
10366 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES} to @code{1}. The compiler
10367 will then define a function called
10368 @code{merge_dllimport_decl_attributes} which can then be defined as
10369 the expansion of @code{TARGET_MERGE_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. You can also
10370 add @code{handle_dll_attribute} in the attribute table for your port
10371 to perform initial processing of the @samp{dllimport} and
10372 @samp{dllexport} attributes. This is done in @file{i386/cygwin.h} and
10373 @file{i386/i386.c}, for example.
10374 @end deftypefn
10375
10376 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_VALID_DLLIMPORT_ATTRIBUTE_P (const_tree @var{decl})
10377 @var{decl} is a variable or function with @code{__attribute__((dllimport))} specified. Use this hook if the target needs to add extra validation checks to @code{handle_dll_attribute}.
10378 @end deftypefn
10379
10380 @defmac TARGET_DECLSPEC
10381 Define this macro to a nonzero value if you want to treat
10382 @code{__declspec(X)} as equivalent to @code{__attribute((X))}. By
10383 default, this behavior is enabled only for targets that define
10384 @code{TARGET_DLLIMPORT_DECL_ATTRIBUTES}. The current implementation
10385 of @code{__declspec} is via a built-in macro, but you should not rely
10386 on this implementation detail.
10387 @end defmac
10388
10389 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES (tree @var{node}, tree *@var{attr_ptr})
10390 Define this target hook if you want to be able to add attributes to a decl
10391 when it is being created. This is normally useful for back ends which
10392 wish to implement a pragma by using the attributes which correspond to
10393 the pragma's effect. The @var{node} argument is the decl which is being
10394 created. The @var{attr_ptr} argument is a pointer to the attribute list
10395 for this decl. The list itself should not be modified, since it may be
10396 shared with other decls, but attributes may be chained on the head of
10397 the list and @code{*@var{attr_ptr}} modified to point to the new
10398 attributes, or a copy of the list may be made if further changes are
10399 needed.
10400 @end deftypefn
10401
10402 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_FUNCTION_ATTRIBUTE_INLINABLE_P (const_tree @var{fndecl})
10403 @cindex inlining
10404 This target hook returns @code{true} if it is OK to inline @var{fndecl}
10405 into the current function, despite its having target-specific
10406 attributes, @code{false} otherwise. By default, if a function has a
10407 target specific attribute attached to it, it will not be inlined.
10408 @end deftypefn
10409
10410 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P (tree @var{fndecl}, tree @var{name}, tree @var{args}, int @var{flags})
10411 This hook is called to parse @code{attribute(target("..."))}, which
10412 allows setting target-specific options on individual functions.
10413 These function-specific options may differ
10414 from the options specified on the command line. The hook should return
10415 @code{true} if the options are valid.
10416
10417 The hook should set the @code{DECL_FUNCTION_SPECIFIC_TARGET} field in
10418 the function declaration to hold a pointer to a target-specific
10419 @code{struct cl_target_option} structure.
10420 @end deftypefn
10421
10422 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_SAVE (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr}, struct gcc_options *@var{opts})
10423 This hook is called to save any additional target-specific information
10424 in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for function-specific
10425 options from the @code{struct gcc_options} structure.
10426 @xref{Option file format}.
10427 @end deftypefn
10428
10429 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_RESTORE (struct gcc_options *@var{opts}, struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
10430 This hook is called to restore any additional target-specific
10431 information in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for
10432 function-specific options to the @code{struct gcc_options} structure.
10433 @end deftypefn
10434
10435 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_POST_STREAM_IN (struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
10436 This hook is called to update target-specific information in the
10437 @code{struct cl_target_option} structure after it is streamed in from
10438 LTO bytecode.
10439 @end deftypefn
10440
10441 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_PRINT (FILE *@var{file}, int @var{indent}, struct cl_target_option *@var{ptr})
10442 This hook is called to print any additional target-specific
10443 information in the @code{struct cl_target_option} structure for
10444 function-specific options.
10445 @end deftypefn
10446
10447 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_PRAGMA_PARSE (tree @var{args}, tree @var{pop_target})
10448 This target hook parses the options for @code{#pragma GCC target}, which
10449 sets the target-specific options for functions that occur later in the
10450 input stream. The options accepted should be the same as those handled by the
10451 @code{TARGET_OPTION_VALID_ATTRIBUTE_P} hook.
10452 @end deftypefn
10453
10454 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE (void)
10455 Sometimes certain combinations of command options do not make sense on
10456 a particular target machine. You can override the hook
10457 @code{TARGET_OPTION_OVERRIDE} to take account of this. This hooks is called
10458 once just after all the command options have been parsed.
10459
10460 Don't use this hook to turn on various extra optimizations for
10461 @option{-O}. That is what @code{TARGET_OPTION_OPTIMIZATION} is for.
10462
10463 If you need to do something whenever the optimization level is
10464 changed via the optimize attribute or pragma, see
10465 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDE_OPTIONS_AFTER_CHANGE}
10466 @end deftypefn
10467
10468 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_OPTION_FUNCTION_VERSIONS (tree @var{decl1}, tree @var{decl2})
10469 This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{DECL1} and @var{DECL2} are
10470 versions of the same function. @var{DECL1} and @var{DECL2} are function
10471 versions if and only if they have the same function signature and
10472 different target specific attributes, that is, they are compiled for
10473 different target machines.
10474 @end deftypefn
10475
10476 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_INLINE_P (tree @var{caller}, tree @var{callee})
10477 This target hook returns @code{false} if the @var{caller} function
10478 cannot inline @var{callee}, based on target specific information. By
10479 default, inlining is not allowed if the callee function has function
10480 specific target options and the caller does not use the same options.
10481 @end deftypefn
10482
10483 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_RELAYOUT_FUNCTION (tree @var{fndecl})
10484 This target hook fixes function @var{fndecl} after attributes are processed. Default does nothing. On ARM, the default function's alignment is updated with the attribute target.
10485 @end deftypefn
10486
10487 @node Emulated TLS
10488 @section Emulating TLS
10489 @cindex Emulated TLS
10490
10491 For targets whose psABI does not provide Thread Local Storage via
10492 specific relocations and instruction sequences, an emulation layer is
10493 used. A set of target hooks allows this emulation layer to be
10494 configured for the requirements of a particular target. For instance
10495 the psABI may in fact specify TLS support in terms of an emulation
10496 layer.
10497
10498 The emulation layer works by creating a control object for every TLS
10499 object. To access the TLS object, a lookup function is provided
10500 which, when given the address of the control object, will return the
10501 address of the current thread's instance of the TLS object.
10502
10503 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_GET_ADDRESS
10504 Contains the name of the helper function that uses a TLS control
10505 object to locate a TLS instance. The default causes libgcc's
10506 emulated TLS helper function to be used.
10507 @end deftypevr
10508
10509 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_REGISTER_COMMON
10510 Contains the name of the helper function that should be used at
10511 program startup to register TLS objects that are implicitly
10512 initialized to zero. If this is @code{NULL}, all TLS objects will
10513 have explicit initializers. The default causes libgcc's emulated TLS
10514 registration function to be used.
10515 @end deftypevr
10516
10517 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_SECTION
10518 Contains the name of the section in which TLS control variables should
10519 be placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in
10520 any section.
10521 @end deftypevr
10522
10523 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_SECTION
10524 Contains the name of the section in which TLS initializers should be
10525 placed. The default of @code{NULL} allows these to be placed in any
10526 section.
10527 @end deftypevr
10528
10529 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_PREFIX
10530 Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS control variable names.
10531 The default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
10532 @end deftypevr
10533
10534 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_EMUTLS_TMPL_PREFIX
10535 Contains the prefix to be prepended to TLS initializer objects. The
10536 default of @code{NULL} uses a target-specific prefix.
10537 @end deftypevr
10538
10539 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_FIELDS (tree @var{type}, tree *@var{name})
10540 Specifies a function that generates the FIELD_DECLs for a TLS control
10541 object type. @var{type} is the RECORD_TYPE the fields are for and
10542 @var{name} should be filled with the structure tag, if the default of
10543 @code{__emutls_object} is unsuitable. The default creates a type suitable
10544 for libgcc's emulated TLS function.
10545 @end deftypefn
10546
10547 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_INIT (tree @var{var}, tree @var{decl}, tree @var{tmpl_addr})
10548 Specifies a function that generates the CONSTRUCTOR to initialize a
10549 TLS control object. @var{var} is the TLS control object, @var{decl}
10550 is the TLS object and @var{tmpl_addr} is the address of the
10551 initializer. The default initializes libgcc's emulated TLS control object.
10552 @end deftypefn
10553
10554 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_VAR_ALIGN_FIXED
10555 Specifies whether the alignment of TLS control variable objects is
10556 fixed and should not be increased as some backends may do to optimize
10557 single objects. The default is false.
10558 @end deftypevr
10559
10560 @deftypevr {Target Hook} bool TARGET_EMUTLS_DEBUG_FORM_TLS_ADDRESS
10561 Specifies whether a DWARF @code{DW_OP_form_tls_address} location descriptor
10562 may be used to describe emulated TLS control objects.
10563 @end deftypevr
10564
10565 @node MIPS Coprocessors
10566 @section Defining coprocessor specifics for MIPS targets.
10567 @cindex MIPS coprocessor-definition macros
10568
10569 The MIPS specification allows MIPS implementations to have as many as 4
10570 coprocessors, each with as many as 32 private registers. GCC supports
10571 accessing these registers and transferring values between the registers
10572 and memory using asm-ized variables. For example:
10573
10574 @smallexample
10575 register unsigned int cp0count asm ("c0r1");
10576 unsigned int d;
10577
10578 d = cp0count + 3;
10579 @end smallexample
10580
10581 (``c0r1'' is the default name of register 1 in coprocessor 0; alternate
10582 names may be added as described below, or the default names may be
10583 overridden entirely in @code{SUBTARGET_CONDITIONAL_REGISTER_USAGE}.)
10584
10585 Coprocessor registers are assumed to be epilogue-used; sets to them will
10586 be preserved even if it does not appear that the register is used again
10587 later in the function.
10588
10589 Another note: according to the MIPS spec, coprocessor 1 (if present) is
10590 the FPU@. One accesses COP1 registers through standard mips
10591 floating-point support; they are not included in this mechanism.
10592
10593 @node PCH Target
10594 @section Parameters for Precompiled Header Validity Checking
10595 @cindex parameters, precompiled headers
10596
10597 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {void *} TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY (size_t *@var{sz})
10598 This hook returns a pointer to the data needed by
10599 @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} and sets
10600 @samp{*@var{sz}} to the size of the data in bytes.
10601 @end deftypefn
10602
10603 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_PCH_VALID_P (const void *@var{data}, size_t @var{sz})
10604 This hook checks whether the options used to create a PCH file are
10605 compatible with the current settings. It returns @code{NULL}
10606 if so and a suitable error message if not. Error messages will
10607 be presented to the user and must be localized using @samp{_(@var{msg})}.
10608
10609 @var{data} is the data that was returned by @code{TARGET_GET_PCH_VALIDITY}
10610 when the PCH file was created and @var{sz} is the size of that data in bytes.
10611 It's safe to assume that the data was created by the same version of the
10612 compiler, so no format checking is needed.
10613
10614 The default definition of @code{default_pch_valid_p} should be
10615 suitable for most targets.
10616 @end deftypefn
10617
10618 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_CHECK_PCH_TARGET_FLAGS (int @var{pch_flags})
10619 If this hook is nonnull, the default implementation of
10620 @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P} will use it to check for compatible values
10621 of @code{target_flags}. @var{pch_flags} specifies the value that
10622 @code{target_flags} had when the PCH file was created. The return
10623 value is the same as for @code{TARGET_PCH_VALID_P}.
10624 @end deftypefn
10625
10626 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_PREPARE_PCH_SAVE (void)
10627 Called before writing out a PCH file. If the target has some
10628 garbage-collected data that needs to be in a particular state on PCH loads,
10629 it can use this hook to enforce that state. Very few targets need
10630 to do anything here.
10631 @end deftypefn
10632
10633 @node C++ ABI
10634 @section C++ ABI parameters
10635 @cindex parameters, c++ abi
10636
10637 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GUARD_TYPE (void)
10638 Define this hook to override the integer type used for guard variables.
10639 These are used to implement one-time construction of static objects. The
10640 default is long_long_integer_type_node.
10641 @end deftypefn
10642
10643 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_GUARD_MASK_BIT (void)
10644 This hook determines how guard variables are used. It should return
10645 @code{false} (the default) if the first byte should be used. A return value of
10646 @code{true} indicates that only the least significant bit should be used.
10647 @end deftypefn
10648
10649 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_GET_COOKIE_SIZE (tree @var{type})
10650 This hook returns the size of the cookie to use when allocating an array
10651 whose elements have the indicated @var{type}. Assumes that it is already
10652 known that a cookie is needed. The default is
10653 @code{max(sizeof (size_t), alignof(type))}, as defined in section 2.7 of the
10654 IA64/Generic C++ ABI@.
10655 @end deftypefn
10656
10657 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_COOKIE_HAS_SIZE (void)
10658 This hook should return @code{true} if the element size should be stored in
10659 array cookies. The default is to return @code{false}.
10660 @end deftypefn
10661
10662 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_CXX_IMPORT_EXPORT_CLASS (tree @var{type}, int @var{import_export})
10663 If defined by a backend this hook allows the decision made to export
10664 class @var{type} to be overruled. Upon entry @var{import_export}
10665 will contain 1 if the class is going to be exported, @minus{}1 if it is going
10666 to be imported and 0 otherwise. This function should return the
10667 modified value and perform any other actions necessary to support the
10668 backend's targeted operating system.
10669 @end deftypefn
10670
10671 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CDTOR_RETURNS_THIS (void)
10672 This hook should return @code{true} if constructors and destructors return
10673 the address of the object created/destroyed. The default is to return
10674 @code{false}.
10675 @end deftypefn
10676
10677 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_KEY_METHOD_MAY_BE_INLINE (void)
10678 This hook returns true if the key method for a class (i.e., the method
10679 which, if defined in the current translation unit, causes the virtual
10680 table to be emitted) may be an inline function. Under the standard
10681 Itanium C++ ABI the key method may be an inline function so long as
10682 the function is not declared inline in the class definition. Under
10683 some variants of the ABI, an inline function can never be the key
10684 method. The default is to return @code{true}.
10685 @end deftypefn
10686
10687 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_DETERMINE_CLASS_DATA_VISIBILITY (tree @var{decl})
10688 @var{decl} is a virtual table, virtual table table, typeinfo object, or other similar implicit class data object that will be emitted with external linkage in this translation unit. No ELF visibility has been explicitly specified. If the target needs to specify a visibility other than that of the containing class, use this hook to set @code{DECL_VISIBILITY} and @code{DECL_VISIBILITY_SPECIFIED}.
10689 @end deftypefn
10690
10691 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_CLASS_DATA_ALWAYS_COMDAT (void)
10692 This hook returns true (the default) if virtual tables and other
10693 similar implicit class data objects are always COMDAT if they have
10694 external linkage. If this hook returns false, then class data for
10695 classes whose virtual table will be emitted in only one translation
10696 unit will not be COMDAT.
10697 @end deftypefn
10698
10699 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_LIBRARY_RTTI_COMDAT (void)
10700 This hook returns true (the default) if the RTTI information for
10701 the basic types which is defined in the C++ runtime should always
10702 be COMDAT, false if it should not be COMDAT.
10703 @end deftypefn
10704
10705 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_AEABI_ATEXIT (void)
10706 This hook returns true if @code{__aeabi_atexit} (as defined by the ARM EABI)
10707 should be used to register static destructors when @option{-fuse-cxa-atexit}
10708 is in effect. The default is to return false to use @code{__cxa_atexit}.
10709 @end deftypefn
10710
10711 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_USE_ATEXIT_FOR_CXA_ATEXIT (void)
10712 This hook returns true if the target @code{atexit} function can be used
10713 in the same manner as @code{__cxa_atexit} to register C++ static
10714 destructors. This requires that @code{atexit}-registered functions in
10715 shared libraries are run in the correct order when the libraries are
10716 unloaded. The default is to return false.
10717 @end deftypefn
10718
10719 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_CXX_ADJUST_CLASS_AT_DEFINITION (tree @var{type})
10720 @var{type} is a C++ class (i.e., RECORD_TYPE or UNION_TYPE) that has just been defined. Use this hook to make adjustments to the class (eg, tweak visibility or perform any other required target modifications).
10721 @end deftypefn
10722
10723 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CXX_DECL_MANGLING_CONTEXT (const_tree @var{decl})
10724 Return target-specific mangling context of @var{decl} or @code{NULL_TREE}.
10725 @end deftypefn
10726
10727 @node D Language and ABI
10728 @section D ABI parameters
10729 @cindex parameters, d abi
10730
10731 @deftypefn {D Target Hook} void TARGET_D_CPU_VERSIONS (void)
10732 Declare all environmental version identifiers relating to the target CPU
10733 using the function @code{builtin_version}, which takes a string representing
10734 the name of the version. Version identifiers predefined by this hook apply
10735 to all modules that are being compiled and imported.
10736 @end deftypefn
10737
10738 @deftypefn {D Target Hook} void TARGET_D_OS_VERSIONS (void)
10739 Similarly to @code{TARGET_D_CPU_VERSIONS}, but is used for versions
10740 relating to the target operating system.
10741 @end deftypefn
10742
10743 @deftypefn {D Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_D_CRITSEC_SIZE (void)
10744 Returns the size of the data structure used by the target operating system
10745 for critical sections and monitors. For example, on Microsoft Windows this
10746 would return the @code{sizeof(CRITICAL_SECTION)}, while other platforms that
10747 implement pthreads would return @code{sizeof(pthread_mutex_t)}.
10748 @end deftypefn
10749
10750 @node Named Address Spaces
10751 @section Adding support for named address spaces
10752 @cindex named address spaces
10753
10754 The draft technical report of the ISO/IEC JTC1 S22 WG14 N1275
10755 standards committee, @cite{Programming Languages - C - Extensions to
10756 support embedded processors}, specifies a syntax for embedded
10757 processors to specify alternate address spaces. You can configure a
10758 GCC port to support section 5.1 of the draft report to add support for
10759 address spaces other than the default address space. These address
10760 spaces are new keywords that are similar to the @code{volatile} and
10761 @code{const} type attributes.
10762
10763 Pointers to named address spaces can have a different size than
10764 pointers to the generic address space.
10765
10766 For example, the SPU port uses the @code{__ea} address space to refer
10767 to memory in the host processor, rather than memory local to the SPU
10768 processor. Access to memory in the @code{__ea} address space involves
10769 issuing DMA operations to move data between the host processor and the
10770 local processor memory address space. Pointers in the @code{__ea}
10771 address space are either 32 bits or 64 bits based on the
10772 @option{-mea32} or @option{-mea64} switches (native SPU pointers are
10773 always 32 bits).
10774
10775 Internally, address spaces are represented as a small integer in the
10776 range 0 to 15 with address space 0 being reserved for the generic
10777 address space.
10778
10779 To register a named address space qualifier keyword with the C front end,
10780 the target may call the @code{c_register_addr_space} routine. For example,
10781 the SPU port uses the following to declare @code{__ea} as the keyword for
10782 named address space #1:
10783 @smallexample
10784 #define ADDR_SPACE_EA 1
10785 c_register_addr_space ("__ea", ADDR_SPACE_EA);
10786 @end smallexample
10787
10788 @deftypefn {Target Hook} scalar_int_mode TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
10789 Define this to return the machine mode to use for pointers to
10790 @var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10791 The default version of this hook returns @code{ptr_mode}.
10792 @end deftypefn
10793
10794 @deftypefn {Target Hook} scalar_int_mode TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE (addr_space_t @var{address_space})
10795 Define this to return the machine mode to use for addresses in
10796 @var{address_space} if the target supports named address spaces.
10797 The default version of this hook returns @code{Pmode}.
10798 @end deftypefn
10799
10800 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_VALID_POINTER_MODE (scalar_int_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10801 Define this to return nonzero if the port can handle pointers
10802 with machine mode @var{mode} to address space @var{as}. This target
10803 hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_VALID_POINTER_MODE} target hook,
10804 except that it includes explicit named address space support. The default
10805 version of this hook returns true for the modes returned by either the
10806 @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_POINTER_MODE} or @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ADDRESS_MODE}
10807 target hooks for the given address space.
10808 @end deftypefn
10809
10810 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{exp}, bool @var{strict}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10811 Define this to return true if @var{exp} is a valid address for mode
10812 @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. The @var{strict}
10813 parameter says whether strict addressing is in effect after reload has
10814 finished. This target hook is the same as the
10815 @code{TARGET_LEGITIMATE_ADDRESS_P} target hook, except that it includes
10816 explicit named address space support.
10817 @end deftypefn
10818
10819 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS (rtx @var{x}, rtx @var{oldx}, machine_mode @var{mode}, addr_space_t @var{as})
10820 Define this to modify an invalid address @var{x} to be a valid address
10821 with mode @var{mode} in the named address space @var{as}. This target
10822 hook is the same as the @code{TARGET_LEGITIMIZE_ADDRESS} target hook,
10823 except that it includes explicit named address space support.
10824 @end deftypefn
10825
10826 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P (addr_space_t @var{subset}, addr_space_t @var{superset})
10827 Define this to return whether the @var{subset} named address space is
10828 contained within the @var{superset} named address space. Pointers to
10829 a named address space that is a subset of another named address space
10830 will be converted automatically without a cast if used together in
10831 arithmetic operations. Pointers to a superset address space can be
10832 converted to pointers to a subset address space via explicit casts.
10833 @end deftypefn
10834
10835 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_ZERO_ADDRESS_VALID (addr_space_t @var{as})
10836 Define this to modify the default handling of address 0 for the
10837 address space. Return true if 0 should be considered a valid address.
10838 @end deftypefn
10839
10840 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_CONVERT (rtx @var{op}, tree @var{from_type}, tree @var{to_type})
10841 Define this to convert the pointer expression represented by the RTL
10842 @var{op} with type @var{from_type} that points to a named address
10843 space to a new pointer expression with type @var{to_type} that points
10844 to a different named address space. When this hook it called, it is
10845 guaranteed that one of the two address spaces is a subset of the other,
10846 as determined by the @code{TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_SUBSET_P} target hook.
10847 @end deftypefn
10848
10849 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_DEBUG (addr_space_t @var{as})
10850 Define this to define how the address space is encoded in dwarf.
10851 The result is the value to be used with @code{DW_AT_address_class}.
10852 @end deftypefn
10853
10854 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ADDR_SPACE_DIAGNOSE_USAGE (addr_space_t @var{as}, location_t @var{loc})
10855 Define this hook if the availability of an address space depends on
10856 command line options and some diagnostics should be printed when the
10857 address space is used. This hook is called during parsing and allows
10858 to emit a better diagnostic compared to the case where the address space
10859 was not registered with @code{c_register_addr_space}. @var{as} is
10860 the address space as registered with @code{c_register_addr_space}.
10861 @var{loc} is the location of the address space qualifier token.
10862 The default implementation does nothing.
10863 @end deftypefn
10864
10865 @node Misc
10866 @section Miscellaneous Parameters
10867 @cindex parameters, miscellaneous
10868
10869 @c prevent bad page break with this line
10870 Here are several miscellaneous parameters.
10871
10872 @defmac HAS_LONG_COND_BRANCH
10873 Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10874 has conditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10875 conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10876 blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10877 set to false, gcc will convert any conditional branches that attempt
10878 to cross between sections into unconditional branches or indirect jumps.
10879 @end defmac
10880
10881 @defmac HAS_LONG_UNCOND_BRANCH
10882 Define this boolean macro to indicate whether or not your architecture
10883 has unconditional branches that can span all of memory. It is used in
10884 conjunction with an optimization that partitions hot and cold basic
10885 blocks into separate sections of the executable. If this macro is
10886 set to false, gcc will convert any unconditional branches that attempt
10887 to cross between sections into indirect jumps.
10888 @end defmac
10889
10890 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_MODE
10891 An alias for a machine mode name. This is the machine mode that
10892 elements of a jump-table should have.
10893 @end defmac
10894
10895 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_SHORTEN_MODE (@var{min_offset}, @var{max_offset}, @var{body})
10896 Optional: return the preferred mode for an @code{addr_diff_vec}
10897 when the minimum and maximum offset are known. If you define this,
10898 it enables extra code in branch shortening to deal with @code{addr_diff_vec}.
10899 To make this work, you also have to define @code{INSN_ALIGN} and
10900 make the alignment for @code{addr_diff_vec} explicit.
10901 The @var{body} argument is provided so that the offset_unsigned and scale
10902 flags can be updated.
10903 @end defmac
10904
10905 @defmac CASE_VECTOR_PC_RELATIVE
10906 Define this macro to be a C expression to indicate when jump-tables
10907 should contain relative addresses. You need not define this macro if
10908 jump-tables never contain relative addresses, or jump-tables should
10909 contain relative addresses only when @option{-fPIC} or @option{-fPIC}
10910 is in effect.
10911 @end defmac
10912
10913 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_CASE_VALUES_THRESHOLD (void)
10914 This function return the smallest number of different values for which it
10915 is best to use a jump-table instead of a tree of conditional branches.
10916 The default is four for machines with a @code{casesi} instruction and
10917 five otherwise. This is best for most machines.
10918 @end deftypefn
10919
10920 @defmac WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS
10921 Define this macro to 1 if operations between registers with integral mode
10922 smaller than a word are always performed on the entire register. To be
10923 more explicit, if you start with a pair of @code{word_mode} registers with
10924 known values and you do a subword, for example @code{QImode}, addition on
10925 the low part of the registers, then the compiler may consider that the
10926 result has a known value in @code{word_mode} too if the macro is defined
10927 to 1. Most RISC machines have this property and most CISC machines do not.
10928 @end defmac
10929
10930 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_MIN_ARITHMETIC_PRECISION (void)
10931 On some RISC architectures with 64-bit registers, the processor also
10932 maintains 32-bit condition codes that make it possible to do real 32-bit
10933 arithmetic, although the operations are performed on the full registers.
10934
10935 On such architectures, defining this hook to 32 tells the compiler to try
10936 using 32-bit arithmetical operations setting the condition codes instead
10937 of doing full 64-bit arithmetic.
10938
10939 More generally, define this hook on RISC architectures if you want the
10940 compiler to try using arithmetical operations setting the condition codes
10941 with a precision lower than the word precision.
10942
10943 You need not define this hook if @code{WORD_REGISTER_OPERATIONS} is not
10944 defined to 1.
10945 @end deftypefn
10946
10947 @defmac LOAD_EXTEND_OP (@var{mem_mode})
10948 Define this macro to be a C expression indicating when insns that read
10949 memory in @var{mem_mode}, an integral mode narrower than a word, set the
10950 bits outside of @var{mem_mode} to be either the sign-extension or the
10951 zero-extension of the data read. Return @code{SIGN_EXTEND} for values
10952 of @var{mem_mode} for which the
10953 insn sign-extends, @code{ZERO_EXTEND} for which it zero-extends, and
10954 @code{UNKNOWN} for other modes.
10955
10956 This macro is not called with @var{mem_mode} non-integral or with a width
10957 greater than or equal to @code{BITS_PER_WORD}, so you may return any
10958 value in this case. Do not define this macro if it would always return
10959 @code{UNKNOWN}. On machines where this macro is defined, you will normally
10960 define it as the constant @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{ZERO_EXTEND}.
10961
10962 You may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN} value even if for some hard registers
10963 the sign extension is not performed, if for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS}
10964 of these hard registers @code{TARGET_CAN_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns false
10965 when the @var{from} mode is @var{mem_mode} and the @var{to} mode is any
10966 integral mode larger than this but not larger than @code{word_mode}.
10967
10968 You must return @code{UNKNOWN} if for some hard registers that allow this
10969 mode, @code{TARGET_CAN_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} says that they cannot change to
10970 @code{word_mode}, but that they can change to another integral mode that
10971 is larger then @var{mem_mode} but still smaller than @code{word_mode}.
10972 @end defmac
10973
10974 @defmac SHORT_IMMEDIATES_SIGN_EXTEND
10975 Define this macro to 1 if loading short immediate values into registers sign
10976 extends.
10977 @end defmac
10978
10979 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_MIN_DIVISIONS_FOR_RECIP_MUL (machine_mode @var{mode})
10980 When @option{-ffast-math} is in effect, GCC tries to optimize
10981 divisions by the same divisor, by turning them into multiplications by
10982 the reciprocal. This target hook specifies the minimum number of divisions
10983 that should be there for GCC to perform the optimization for a variable
10984 of mode @var{mode}. The default implementation returns 3 if the machine
10985 has an instruction for the division, and 2 if it does not.
10986 @end deftypefn
10987
10988 @defmac MOVE_MAX
10989 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10990 between memory and registers or between two memory locations.
10991 @end defmac
10992
10993 @defmac MAX_MOVE_MAX
10994 The maximum number of bytes that a single instruction can move quickly
10995 between memory and registers or between two memory locations. If this
10996 is undefined, the default is @code{MOVE_MAX}. Otherwise, it is the
10997 constant value that is the largest value that @code{MOVE_MAX} can have
10998 at run-time.
10999 @end defmac
11000
11001 @defmac SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED
11002 A C expression that is nonzero if on this machine the number of bits
11003 actually used for the count of a shift operation is equal to the number
11004 of bits needed to represent the size of the object being shifted. When
11005 this macro is nonzero, the compiler will assume that it is safe to omit
11006 a sign-extend, zero-extend, and certain bitwise `and' instructions that
11007 truncates the count of a shift operation. On machines that have
11008 instructions that act on bit-fields at variable positions, which may
11009 include `bit test' instructions, a nonzero @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
11010 also enables deletion of truncations of the values that serve as
11011 arguments to bit-field instructions.
11012
11013 If both types of instructions truncate the count (for shifts) and
11014 position (for bit-field operations), or if no variable-position bit-field
11015 instructions exist, you should define this macro.
11016
11017 However, on some machines, such as the 80386 and the 680x0, truncation
11018 only applies to shift operations and not the (real or pretended)
11019 bit-field operations. Define @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} to be zero on
11020 such machines. Instead, add patterns to the @file{md} file that include
11021 the implied truncation of the shift instructions.
11022
11023 You need not define this macro if it would always have the value of zero.
11024 @end defmac
11025
11026 @anchor{TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK}
11027 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_SHIFT_TRUNCATION_MASK (machine_mode @var{mode})
11028 This function describes how the standard shift patterns for @var{mode}
11029 deal with shifts by negative amounts or by more than the width of the mode.
11030 @xref{shift patterns}.
11031
11032 On many machines, the shift patterns will apply a mask @var{m} to the
11033 shift count, meaning that a fixed-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y} is
11034 equivalent to an arbitrary-width shift of @var{x} by @var{y & m}. If
11035 this is true for mode @var{mode}, the function should return @var{m},
11036 otherwise it should return 0. A return value of 0 indicates that no
11037 particular behavior is guaranteed.
11038
11039 Note that, unlike @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}, this function does
11040 @emph{not} apply to general shift rtxes; it applies only to instructions
11041 that are generated by the named shift patterns.
11042
11043 The default implementation of this function returns
11044 @code{GET_MODE_BITSIZE (@var{mode}) - 1} if @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED}
11045 and 0 otherwise. This definition is always safe, but if
11046 @code{SHIFT_COUNT_TRUNCATED} is false, and some shift patterns
11047 nevertheless truncate the shift count, you may get better code
11048 by overriding it.
11049 @end deftypefn
11050
11051 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION (poly_uint64 @var{outprec}, poly_uint64 @var{inprec})
11052 This hook returns true if it is safe to ``convert'' a value of
11053 @var{inprec} bits to one of @var{outprec} bits (where @var{outprec} is
11054 smaller than @var{inprec}) by merely operating on it as if it had only
11055 @var{outprec} bits. The default returns true unconditionally, which
11056 is correct for most machines.
11057
11058 If @code{TARGET_MODES_TIEABLE_P} returns false for a pair of modes,
11059 suboptimal code can result if this hook returns true for the corresponding
11060 mode sizes. Making this hook return false in such cases may improve things.
11061 @end deftypefn
11062
11063 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (scalar_int_mode @var{mode}, scalar_int_mode @var{rep_mode})
11064 The representation of an integral mode can be such that the values
11065 are always extended to a wider integral mode. Return
11066 @code{SIGN_EXTEND} if values of @var{mode} are represented in
11067 sign-extended form to @var{rep_mode}. Return @code{UNKNOWN}
11068 otherwise. (Currently, none of the targets use zero-extended
11069 representation this way so unlike @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP},
11070 @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} is expected to return either
11071 @code{SIGN_EXTEND} or @code{UNKNOWN}. Also no target extends
11072 @var{mode} to @var{rep_mode} so that @var{rep_mode} is not the next
11073 widest integral mode and currently we take advantage of this fact.)
11074
11075 Similarly to @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP} you may return a non-@code{UNKNOWN}
11076 value even if the extension is not performed on certain hard registers
11077 as long as for the @code{REGNO_REG_CLASS} of these hard registers
11078 @code{TARGET_CAN_CHANGE_MODE_CLASS} returns false.
11079
11080 Note that @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED} and @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP}
11081 describe two related properties. If you define
11082 @code{TARGET_MODE_REP_EXTENDED (mode, word_mode)} you probably also want
11083 to define @code{LOAD_EXTEND_OP (mode)} to return the same type of
11084 extension.
11085
11086 In order to enforce the representation of @code{mode},
11087 @code{TARGET_TRULY_NOOP_TRUNCATION} should return false when truncating to
11088 @code{mode}.
11089 @end deftypefn
11090
11091 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_SETJMP_PRESERVES_NONVOLATILE_REGS_P (void)
11092 On some targets, it is assumed that the compiler will spill all pseudos
11093 that are live across a call to @code{setjmp}, while other targets treat
11094 @code{setjmp} calls as normal function calls.
11095
11096 This hook returns false if @code{setjmp} calls do not preserve all
11097 non-volatile registers so that gcc that must spill all pseudos that are
11098 live across @code{setjmp} calls. Define this to return true if the
11099 target does not need to spill all pseudos live across @code{setjmp} calls.
11100 The default implementation conservatively assumes all pseudos must be
11101 spilled across @code{setjmp} calls.
11102 @end deftypefn
11103
11104 @defmac STORE_FLAG_VALUE
11105 A C expression describing the value returned by a comparison operator
11106 with an integral mode and stored by a store-flag instruction
11107 (@samp{cstore@var{mode}4}) when the condition is true. This description must
11108 apply to @emph{all} the @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} patterns and all the
11109 comparison operators whose results have a @code{MODE_INT} mode.
11110
11111 A value of 1 or @minus{}1 means that the instruction implementing the
11112 comparison operator returns exactly 1 or @minus{}1 when the comparison is true
11113 and 0 when the comparison is false. Otherwise, the value indicates
11114 which bits of the result are guaranteed to be 1 when the comparison is
11115 true. This value is interpreted in the mode of the comparison
11116 operation, which is given by the mode of the first operand in the
11117 @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} pattern. Either the low bit or the sign bit of
11118 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} be on. Presently, only those bits are used by
11119 the compiler.
11120
11121 If @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is neither 1 or @minus{}1, the compiler will
11122 generate code that depends only on the specified bits. It can also
11123 replace comparison operators with equivalent operations if they cause
11124 the required bits to be set, even if the remaining bits are undefined.
11125 For example, on a machine whose comparison operators return an
11126 @code{SImode} value and where @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} is defined as
11127 @samp{0x80000000}, saying that just the sign bit is relevant, the
11128 expression
11129
11130 @smallexample
11131 (ne:SI (and:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{power-of-2})) (const_int 0))
11132 @end smallexample
11133
11134 @noindent
11135 can be converted to
11136
11137 @smallexample
11138 (ashift:SI @var{x} (const_int @var{n}))
11139 @end smallexample
11140
11141 @noindent
11142 where @var{n} is the appropriate shift count to move the bit being
11143 tested into the sign bit.
11144
11145 There is no way to describe a machine that always sets the low-order bit
11146 for a true value, but does not guarantee the value of any other bits,
11147 but we do not know of any machine that has such an instruction. If you
11148 are trying to port GCC to such a machine, include an instruction to
11149 perform a logical-and of the result with 1 in the pattern for the
11150 comparison operators and let us know at @email{gcc@@gcc.gnu.org}.
11151
11152 Often, a machine will have multiple instructions that obtain a value
11153 from a comparison (or the condition codes). Here are rules to guide the
11154 choice of value for @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}, and hence the instructions
11155 to be used:
11156
11157 @itemize @bullet
11158 @item
11159 Use the shortest sequence that yields a valid definition for
11160 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE}. It is more efficient for the compiler to
11161 ``normalize'' the value (convert it to, e.g., 1 or 0) than for the
11162 comparison operators to do so because there may be opportunities to
11163 combine the normalization with other operations.
11164
11165 @item
11166 For equal-length sequences, use a value of 1 or @minus{}1, with @minus{}1 being
11167 slightly preferred on machines with expensive jumps and 1 preferred on
11168 other machines.
11169
11170 @item
11171 As a second choice, choose a value of @samp{0x80000001} if instructions
11172 exist that set both the sign and low-order bits but do not define the
11173 others.
11174
11175 @item
11176 Otherwise, use a value of @samp{0x80000000}.
11177 @end itemize
11178
11179 Many machines can produce both the value chosen for
11180 @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} and its negation in the same number of
11181 instructions. On those machines, you should also define a pattern for
11182 those cases, e.g., one matching
11183
11184 @smallexample
11185 (set @var{A} (neg:@var{m} (ne:@var{m} @var{B} @var{C})))
11186 @end smallexample
11187
11188 Some machines can also perform @code{and} or @code{plus} operations on
11189 condition code values with less instructions than the corresponding
11190 @samp{cstore@var{mode}4} insn followed by @code{and} or @code{plus}. On those
11191 machines, define the appropriate patterns. Use the names @code{incscc}
11192 and @code{decscc}, respectively, for the patterns which perform
11193 @code{plus} or @code{minus} operations on condition code values. See
11194 @file{rs6000.md} for some examples. The GNU Superoptimizer can be used to
11195 find such instruction sequences on other machines.
11196
11197 If this macro is not defined, the default value, 1, is used. You need
11198 not define @code{STORE_FLAG_VALUE} if the machine has no store-flag
11199 instructions, or if the value generated by these instructions is 1.
11200 @end defmac
11201
11202 @defmac FLOAT_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
11203 A C expression that gives a nonzero @code{REAL_VALUE_TYPE} value that is
11204 returned when comparison operators with floating-point results are true.
11205 Define this macro on machines that have comparison operations that return
11206 floating-point values. If there are no such operations, do not define
11207 this macro.
11208 @end defmac
11209
11210 @defmac VECTOR_STORE_FLAG_VALUE (@var{mode})
11211 A C expression that gives a rtx representing the nonzero true element
11212 for vector comparisons. The returned rtx should be valid for the inner
11213 mode of @var{mode} which is guaranteed to be a vector mode. Define
11214 this macro on machines that have vector comparison operations that
11215 return a vector result. If there are no such operations, do not define
11216 this macro. Typically, this macro is defined as @code{const1_rtx} or
11217 @code{constm1_rtx}. This macro may return @code{NULL_RTX} to prevent
11218 the compiler optimizing such vector comparison operations for the
11219 given mode.
11220 @end defmac
11221
11222 @defmac CLZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
11223 @defmacx CTZ_DEFINED_VALUE_AT_ZERO (@var{mode}, @var{value})
11224 A C expression that indicates whether the architecture defines a value
11225 for @code{clz} or @code{ctz} with a zero operand.
11226 A result of @code{0} indicates the value is undefined.
11227 If the value is defined for only the RTL expression, the macro should
11228 evaluate to @code{1}; if the value applies also to the corresponding optab
11229 entry (which is normally the case if it expands directly into
11230 the corresponding RTL), then the macro should evaluate to @code{2}.
11231 In the cases where the value is defined, @var{value} should be set to
11232 this value.
11233
11234 If this macro is not defined, the value of @code{clz} or
11235 @code{ctz} at zero is assumed to be undefined.
11236
11237 This macro must be defined if the target's expansion for @code{ffs}
11238 relies on a particular value to get correct results. Otherwise it
11239 is not necessary, though it may be used to optimize some corner cases, and
11240 to provide a default expansion for the @code{ffs} optab.
11241
11242 Note that regardless of this macro the ``definedness'' of @code{clz}
11243 and @code{ctz} at zero do @emph{not} extend to the builtin functions
11244 visible to the user. Thus one may be free to adjust the value at will
11245 to match the target expansion of these operations without fear of
11246 breaking the API@.
11247 @end defmac
11248
11249 @defmac Pmode
11250 An alias for the machine mode for pointers. On most machines, define
11251 this to be the integer mode corresponding to the width of a hardware
11252 pointer; @code{SImode} on 32-bit machine or @code{DImode} on 64-bit machines.
11253 On some machines you must define this to be one of the partial integer
11254 modes, such as @code{PSImode}.
11255
11256 The width of @code{Pmode} must be at least as large as the value of
11257 @code{POINTER_SIZE}. If it is not equal, you must define the macro
11258 @code{POINTERS_EXTEND_UNSIGNED} to specify how pointers are extended
11259 to @code{Pmode}.
11260 @end defmac
11261
11262 @defmac FUNCTION_MODE
11263 An alias for the machine mode used for memory references to functions
11264 being called, in @code{call} RTL expressions. On most CISC machines,
11265 where an instruction can begin at any byte address, this should be
11266 @code{QImode}. On most RISC machines, where all instructions have fixed
11267 size and alignment, this should be a mode with the same size and alignment
11268 as the machine instruction words - typically @code{SImode} or @code{HImode}.
11269 @end defmac
11270
11271 @defmac STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS
11272 In normal operation, the preprocessor expands @code{__STDC__} to the
11273 constant 1, to signify that GCC conforms to ISO Standard C@. On some
11274 hosts, like Solaris, the system compiler uses a different convention,
11275 where @code{__STDC__} is normally 0, but is 1 if the user specifies
11276 strict conformance to the C Standard.
11277
11278 Defining @code{STDC_0_IN_SYSTEM_HEADERS} makes GNU CPP follows the host
11279 convention when processing system header files, but when processing user
11280 files @code{__STDC__} will always expand to 1.
11281 @end defmac
11282
11283 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_C_PREINCLUDE (void)
11284 Define this hook to return the name of a header file to be included at the start of all compilations, as if it had been included with @code{#include <@var{file}>}. If this hook returns @code{NULL}, or is not defined, or the header is not found, or if the user specifies @option{-ffreestanding} or @option{-nostdinc}, no header is included.
11285
11286 This hook can be used together with a header provided by the system C library to implement ISO C requirements for certain macros to be predefined that describe properties of the whole implementation rather than just the compiler.
11287 @end deftypefn
11288
11289 @deftypefn {C Target Hook} bool TARGET_CXX_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C (const char*@var{})
11290 Define this hook to add target-specific C++ implicit extern C functions. If this function returns true for the name of a file-scope function, that function implicitly gets extern "C" linkage rather than whatever language linkage the declaration would normally have. An example of such function is WinMain on Win32 targets.
11291 @end deftypefn
11292
11293 @defmac SYSTEM_IMPLICIT_EXTERN_C
11294 Define this macro if the system header files do not support C++@.
11295 This macro handles system header files by pretending that system
11296 header files are enclosed in @samp{extern "C" @{@dots{}@}}.
11297 @end defmac
11298
11299 @findex #pragma
11300 @findex pragma
11301 @defmac REGISTER_TARGET_PRAGMAS ()
11302 Define this macro if you want to implement any target-specific pragmas.
11303 If defined, it is a C expression which makes a series of calls to
11304 @code{c_register_pragma} or @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion}
11305 for each pragma. The macro may also do any
11306 setup required for the pragmas.
11307
11308 The primary reason to define this macro is to provide compatibility with
11309 other compilers for the same target. In general, we discourage
11310 definition of target-specific pragmas for GCC@.
11311
11312 If the pragma can be implemented by attributes then you should consider
11313 defining the target hook @samp{TARGET_INSERT_ATTRIBUTES} as well.
11314
11315 Preprocessor macros that appear on pragma lines are not expanded. All
11316 @samp{#pragma} directives that do not match any registered pragma are
11317 silently ignored, unless the user specifies @option{-Wunknown-pragmas}.
11318 @end defmac
11319
11320 @deftypefun void c_register_pragma (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
11321 @deftypefunx void c_register_pragma_with_expansion (const char *@var{space}, const char *@var{name}, void (*@var{callback}) (struct cpp_reader *))
11322
11323 Each call to @code{c_register_pragma} or
11324 @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} establishes one pragma. The
11325 @var{callback} routine will be called when the preprocessor encounters a
11326 pragma of the form
11327
11328 @smallexample
11329 #pragma [@var{space}] @var{name} @dots{}
11330 @end smallexample
11331
11332 @var{space} is the case-sensitive namespace of the pragma, or
11333 @code{NULL} to put the pragma in the global namespace. The callback
11334 routine receives @var{pfile} as its first argument, which can be passed
11335 on to cpplib's functions if necessary. You can lex tokens after the
11336 @var{name} by calling @code{pragma_lex}. Tokens that are not read by the
11337 callback will be silently ignored. The end of the line is indicated by
11338 a token of type @code{CPP_EOF}. Macro expansion occurs on the
11339 arguments of pragmas registered with
11340 @code{c_register_pragma_with_expansion} but not on the arguments of
11341 pragmas registered with @code{c_register_pragma}.
11342
11343 Note that the use of @code{pragma_lex} is specific to the C and C++
11344 compilers. It will not work in the Java or Fortran compilers, or any
11345 other language compilers for that matter. Thus if @code{pragma_lex} is going
11346 to be called from target-specific code, it must only be done so when
11347 building the C and C++ compilers. This can be done by defining the
11348 variables @code{c_target_objs} and @code{cxx_target_objs} in the
11349 target entry in the @file{config.gcc} file. These variables should name
11350 the target-specific, language-specific object file which contains the
11351 code that uses @code{pragma_lex}. Note it will also be necessary to add a
11352 rule to the makefile fragment pointed to by @code{tmake_file} that shows
11353 how to build this object file.
11354 @end deftypefun
11355
11356 @defmac HANDLE_PRAGMA_PACK_WITH_EXPANSION
11357 Define this macro if macros should be expanded in the
11358 arguments of @samp{#pragma pack}.
11359 @end defmac
11360
11361 @defmac TARGET_DEFAULT_PACK_STRUCT
11362 If your target requires a structure packing default other than 0 (meaning
11363 the machine default), define this macro to the necessary value (in bytes).
11364 This must be a value that would also be valid to use with
11365 @samp{#pragma pack()} (that is, a small power of two).
11366 @end defmac
11367
11368 @defmac DOLLARS_IN_IDENTIFIERS
11369 Define this macro to control use of the character @samp{$} in
11370 identifier names for the C family of languages. 0 means @samp{$} is
11371 not allowed by default; 1 means it is allowed. 1 is the default;
11372 there is no need to define this macro in that case.
11373 @end defmac
11374
11375 @defmac INSN_SETS_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
11376 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
11377 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
11378 even if they appear to use a resource set or clobbered in @var{insn}.
11379 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}; GCC knows that
11380 every @code{call_insn} has this behavior. On machines where some @code{insn}
11381 or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and hence has this behavior,
11382 you should define this macro.
11383
11384 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
11385 @end defmac
11386
11387 @defmac INSN_REFERENCES_ARE_DELAYED (@var{insn})
11388 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if it is safe for the
11389 delay slot scheduler to place instructions in the delay slot of @var{insn},
11390 even if they appear to set or clobber a resource referenced in @var{insn}.
11391 @var{insn} is always a @code{jump_insn} or an @code{insn}. On machines where
11392 some @code{insn} or @code{jump_insn} is really a function call and its operands
11393 are registers whose use is actually in the subroutine it calls, you should
11394 define this macro. Doing so allows the delay slot scheduler to move
11395 instructions which copy arguments into the argument registers into the delay
11396 slot of @var{insn}.
11397
11398 You need not define this macro if it would always return zero.
11399 @end defmac
11400
11401 @defmac MULTIPLE_SYMBOL_SPACES
11402 Define this macro as a C expression that is nonzero if, in some cases,
11403 global symbols from one translation unit may not be bound to undefined
11404 symbols in another translation unit without user intervention. For
11405 instance, under Microsoft Windows symbols must be explicitly imported
11406 from shared libraries (DLLs).
11407
11408 You need not define this macro if it would always evaluate to zero.
11409 @end defmac
11410
11411 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {rtx_insn *} TARGET_MD_ASM_ADJUST (vec<rtx>& @var{outputs}, vec<rtx>& @var{inputs}, vec<const char *>& @var{constraints}, vec<rtx>& @var{clobbers}, HARD_REG_SET& @var{clobbered_regs})
11412 This target hook may add @dfn{clobbers} to @var{clobbers} and
11413 @var{clobbered_regs} for any hard regs the port wishes to automatically
11414 clobber for an asm. The @var{outputs} and @var{inputs} may be inspected
11415 to avoid clobbering a register that is already used by the asm.
11416
11417 It may modify the @var{outputs}, @var{inputs}, and @var{constraints}
11418 as necessary for other pre-processing. In this case the return value is
11419 a sequence of insns to emit after the asm.
11420 @end deftypefn
11421
11422 @defmac MATH_LIBRARY
11423 Define this macro as a C string constant for the linker argument to link
11424 in the system math library, minus the initial @samp{"-l"}, or
11425 @samp{""} if the target does not have a
11426 separate math library.
11427
11428 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"m"} is wrong.
11429 @end defmac
11430
11431 @defmac LIBRARY_PATH_ENV
11432 Define this macro as a C string constant for the environment variable that
11433 specifies where the linker should look for libraries.
11434
11435 You need only define this macro if the default of @samp{"LIBRARY_PATH"}
11436 is wrong.
11437 @end defmac
11438
11439 @defmac TARGET_POSIX_IO
11440 Define this macro if the target supports the following POSIX@ file
11441 functions, access, mkdir and file locking with fcntl / F_SETLKW@.
11442 Defining @code{TARGET_POSIX_IO} will enable the test coverage code
11443 to use file locking when exiting a program, which avoids race conditions
11444 if the program has forked. It will also create directories at run-time
11445 for cross-profiling.
11446 @end defmac
11447
11448 @defmac MAX_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTE
11449
11450 A C expression for the maximum number of instructions to execute via
11451 conditional execution instructions instead of a branch. A value of
11452 @code{BRANCH_COST}+1 is the default if the machine does not use cc0, and
11453 1 if it does use cc0.
11454 @end defmac
11455
11456 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
11457 Used if the target needs to perform machine-dependent modifications on the
11458 conditionals used for turning basic blocks into conditionally executed code.
11459 @var{ce_info} points to a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which
11460 contains information about the currently processed blocks. @var{true_expr}
11461 and @var{false_expr} are the tests that are used for converting the
11462 then-block and the else-block, respectively. Set either @var{true_expr} or
11463 @var{false_expr} to a null pointer if the tests cannot be converted.
11464 @end defmac
11465
11466 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_MULTIPLE_TESTS (@var{ce_info}, @var{bb}, @var{true_expr}, @var{false_expr})
11467 Like @code{IFCVT_MODIFY_TESTS}, but used when converting more complicated
11468 if-statements into conditions combined by @code{and} and @code{or} operations.
11469 @var{bb} contains the basic block that contains the test that is currently
11470 being processed and about to be turned into a condition.
11471 @end defmac
11472
11473 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_INSN (@var{ce_info}, @var{pattern}, @var{insn})
11474 A C expression to modify the @var{PATTERN} of an @var{INSN} that is to
11475 be converted to conditional execution format. @var{ce_info} points to
11476 a data structure, @code{struct ce_if_block}, which contains information
11477 about the currently processed blocks.
11478 @end defmac
11479
11480 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_FINAL (@var{ce_info})
11481 A C expression to perform any final machine dependent modifications in
11482 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
11483 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
11484 to by @var{ce_info}.
11485 @end defmac
11486
11487 @defmac IFCVT_MODIFY_CANCEL (@var{ce_info})
11488 A C expression to cancel any machine dependent modifications in
11489 converting code to conditional execution. The involved basic blocks
11490 can be found in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
11491 to by @var{ce_info}.
11492 @end defmac
11493
11494 @defmac IFCVT_MACHDEP_INIT (@var{ce_info})
11495 A C expression to initialize any machine specific data for if-conversion
11496 of the if-block in the @code{struct ce_if_block} structure that is pointed
11497 to by @var{ce_info}.
11498 @end defmac
11499
11500 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_MACHINE_DEPENDENT_REORG (void)
11501 If non-null, this hook performs a target-specific pass over the
11502 instruction stream. The compiler will run it at all optimization levels,
11503 just before the point at which it normally does delayed-branch scheduling.
11504
11505 The exact purpose of the hook varies from target to target. Some use
11506 it to do transformations that are necessary for correctness, such as
11507 laying out in-function constant pools or avoiding hardware hazards.
11508 Others use it as an opportunity to do some machine-dependent optimizations.
11509
11510 You need not implement the hook if it has nothing to do. The default
11511 definition is null.
11512 @end deftypefn
11513
11514 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS (void)
11515 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
11516 that need to be defined. It should be a function that performs the
11517 necessary setup.
11518
11519 Machine specific built-in functions can be useful to expand special machine
11520 instructions that would otherwise not normally be generated because
11521 they have no equivalent in the source language (for example, SIMD vector
11522 instructions or prefetch instructions).
11523
11524 To create a built-in function, call the function
11525 @code{lang_hooks.builtin_function}
11526 which is defined by the language front end. You can use any type nodes set
11527 up by @code{build_common_tree_nodes};
11528 only language front ends that use those two functions will call
11529 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}.
11530 @end deftypefn
11531
11532 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_BUILTIN_DECL (unsigned @var{code}, bool @var{initialize_p})
11533 Define this hook if you have any machine-specific built-in functions
11534 that need to be defined. It should be a function that returns the
11535 builtin function declaration for the builtin function code @var{code}.
11536 If there is no such builtin and it cannot be initialized at this time
11537 if @var{initialize_p} is true the function should return @code{NULL_TREE}.
11538 If @var{code} is out of range the function should return
11539 @code{error_mark_node}.
11540 @end deftypefn
11541
11542 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_EXPAND_BUILTIN (tree @var{exp}, rtx @var{target}, rtx @var{subtarget}, machine_mode @var{mode}, int @var{ignore})
11543
11544 Expand a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
11545 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{exp} is the expression for the
11546 function call; the result should go to @var{target} if that is
11547 convenient, and have mode @var{mode} if that is convenient.
11548 @var{subtarget} may be used as the target for computing one of
11549 @var{exp}'s operands. @var{ignore} is nonzero if the value is to be
11550 ignored. This function should return the result of the call to the
11551 built-in function.
11552 @end deftypefn
11553
11554 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_RESOLVE_OVERLOADED_BUILTIN (unsigned int @var{loc}, tree @var{fndecl}, void *@var{arglist})
11555 Select a replacement for a machine specific built-in function that
11556 was set up by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. This is done
11557 @emph{before} regular type checking, and so allows the target to
11558 implement a crude form of function overloading. @var{fndecl} is the
11559 declaration of the built-in function. @var{arglist} is the list of
11560 arguments passed to the built-in function. The result is a
11561 complete expression that implements the operation, usually
11562 another @code{CALL_EXPR}.
11563 @var{arglist} really has type @samp{VEC(tree,gc)*}
11564 @end deftypefn
11565
11566 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_FOLD_BUILTIN (tree @var{fndecl}, int @var{n_args}, tree *@var{argp}, bool @var{ignore})
11567 Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up by
11568 @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{fndecl} is the declaration of the
11569 built-in function. @var{n_args} is the number of arguments passed to
11570 the function; the arguments themselves are pointed to by @var{argp}.
11571 The result is another tree, valid for both GIMPLE and GENERIC,
11572 containing a simplified expression for the call's result. If
11573 @var{ignore} is true the value will be ignored.
11574 @end deftypefn
11575
11576 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_GIMPLE_FOLD_BUILTIN (gimple_stmt_iterator *@var{gsi})
11577 Fold a call to a machine specific built-in function that was set up
11578 by @samp{TARGET_INIT_BUILTINS}. @var{gsi} points to the gimple
11579 statement holding the function call. Returns true if any change
11580 was made to the GIMPLE stream.
11581 @end deftypefn
11582
11583 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_COMPARE_VERSION_PRIORITY (tree @var{decl1}, tree @var{decl2})
11584 This hook is used to compare the target attributes in two functions to
11585 determine which function's features get higher priority. This is used
11586 during function multi-versioning to figure out the order in which two
11587 versions must be dispatched. A function version with a higher priority
11588 is checked for dispatching earlier. @var{decl1} and @var{decl2} are
11589 the two function decls that will be compared.
11590 @end deftypefn
11591
11592 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GET_FUNCTION_VERSIONS_DISPATCHER (void *@var{decl})
11593 This hook is used to get the dispatcher function for a set of function
11594 versions. The dispatcher function is called to invoke the right function
11595 version at run-time. @var{decl} is one version from a set of semantically
11596 identical versions.
11597 @end deftypefn
11598
11599 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_GENERATE_VERSION_DISPATCHER_BODY (void *@var{arg})
11600 This hook is used to generate the dispatcher logic to invoke the right
11601 function version at run-time for a given set of function versions.
11602 @var{arg} points to the callgraph node of the dispatcher function whose
11603 body must be generated.
11604 @end deftypefn
11605
11606 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_USE_DOLOOP_P (const widest_int @var{&iterations}, const widest_int @var{&iterations_max}, unsigned int @var{loop_depth}, bool @var{entered_at_top})
11607 Return true if it is possible to use low-overhead loops (@code{doloop_end}
11608 and @code{doloop_begin}) for a particular loop. @var{iterations} gives the
11609 exact number of iterations, or 0 if not known. @var{iterations_max} gives
11610 the maximum number of iterations, or 0 if not known. @var{loop_depth} is
11611 the nesting depth of the loop, with 1 for innermost loops, 2 for loops that
11612 contain innermost loops, and so on. @var{entered_at_top} is true if the
11613 loop is only entered from the top.
11614
11615 This hook is only used if @code{doloop_end} is available. The default
11616 implementation returns true. You can use @code{can_use_doloop_if_innermost}
11617 if the loop must be the innermost, and if there are no other restrictions.
11618 @end deftypefn
11619
11620 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_WITHIN_DOLOOP (const rtx_insn *@var{insn})
11621
11622 Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return NULL if it is valid within a
11623 low-overhead loop, otherwise return a string explaining why doloop
11624 could not be applied.
11625
11626 Many targets use special registers for low-overhead looping. For any
11627 instruction that clobbers these this function should return a string indicating
11628 the reason why the doloop could not be applied.
11629 By default, the RTL loop optimizer does not use a present doloop pattern for
11630 loops containing function calls or branch on table instructions.
11631 @end deftypefn
11632
11633 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_LEGITIMATE_COMBINED_INSN (rtx_insn *@var{insn})
11634 Take an instruction in @var{insn} and return @code{false} if the instruction is not appropriate as a combination of two or more instructions. The default is to accept all instructions.
11635 @end deftypefn
11636
11637 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CAN_FOLLOW_JUMP (const rtx_insn *@var{follower}, const rtx_insn *@var{followee})
11638 FOLLOWER and FOLLOWEE are JUMP_INSN instructions; return true if FOLLOWER may be modified to follow FOLLOWEE; false, if it can't. For example, on some targets, certain kinds of branches can't be made to follow through a hot/cold partitioning.
11639 @end deftypefn
11640
11641 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_COMMUTATIVE_P (const_rtx @var{x}, int @var{outer_code})
11642 This target hook returns @code{true} if @var{x} is considered to be commutative.
11643 Usually, this is just COMMUTATIVE_P (@var{x}), but the HP PA doesn't consider
11644 PLUS to be commutative inside a MEM@. @var{outer_code} is the rtx code
11645 of the enclosing rtl, if known, otherwise it is UNKNOWN.
11646 @end deftypefn
11647
11648 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE (rtx @var{hard_reg})
11649
11650 When the initial value of a hard register has been copied in a pseudo
11651 register, it is often not necessary to actually allocate another register
11652 to this pseudo register, because the original hard register or a stack slot
11653 it has been saved into can be used. @code{TARGET_ALLOCATE_INITIAL_VALUE}
11654 is called at the start of register allocation once for each hard register
11655 that had its initial value copied by using
11656 @code{get_func_hard_reg_initial_val} or @code{get_hard_reg_initial_val}.
11657 Possible values are @code{NULL_RTX}, if you don't want
11658 to do any special allocation, a @code{REG} rtx---that would typically be
11659 the hard register itself, if it is known not to be clobbered---or a
11660 @code{MEM}.
11661 If you are returning a @code{MEM}, this is only a hint for the allocator;
11662 it might decide to use another register anyways.
11663 You may use @code{current_function_is_leaf} or
11664 @code{REG_N_SETS} in the hook to determine if the hard
11665 register in question will not be clobbered.
11666 The default value of this hook is @code{NULL}, which disables any special
11667 allocation.
11668 @end deftypefn
11669
11670 @deftypefn {Target Hook} int TARGET_UNSPEC_MAY_TRAP_P (const_rtx @var{x}, unsigned @var{flags})
11671 This target hook returns nonzero if @var{x}, an @code{unspec} or
11672 @code{unspec_volatile} operation, might cause a trap. Targets can use
11673 this hook to enhance precision of analysis for @code{unspec} and
11674 @code{unspec_volatile} operations. You may call @code{may_trap_p_1}
11675 to analyze inner elements of @var{x} in which case @var{flags} should be
11676 passed along.
11677 @end deftypefn
11678
11679 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_SET_CURRENT_FUNCTION (tree @var{decl})
11680 The compiler invokes this hook whenever it changes its current function
11681 context (@code{cfun}). You can define this function if
11682 the back end needs to perform any initialization or reset actions on a
11683 per-function basis. For example, it may be used to implement function
11684 attributes that affect register usage or code generation patterns.
11685 The argument @var{decl} is the declaration for the new function context,
11686 and may be null to indicate that the compiler has left a function context
11687 and is returning to processing at the top level.
11688 The default hook function does nothing.
11689
11690 GCC sets @code{cfun} to a dummy function context during initialization of
11691 some parts of the back end. The hook function is not invoked in this
11692 situation; you need not worry about the hook being invoked recursively,
11693 or when the back end is in a partially-initialized state.
11694 @code{cfun} might be @code{NULL} to indicate processing at top level,
11695 outside of any function scope.
11696 @end deftypefn
11697
11698 @defmac TARGET_OBJECT_SUFFIX
11699 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix for object
11700 files on your target machine. If you do not define this macro, GCC will
11701 use @samp{.o} as the suffix for object files.
11702 @end defmac
11703
11704 @defmac TARGET_EXECUTABLE_SUFFIX
11705 Define this macro to be a C string representing the suffix to be
11706 automatically added to executable files on your target machine. If you
11707 do not define this macro, GCC will use the null string as the suffix for
11708 executable files.
11709 @end defmac
11710
11711 @defmac COLLECT_EXPORT_LIST
11712 If defined, @code{collect2} will scan the individual object files
11713 specified on its command line and create an export list for the linker.
11714 Define this macro for systems like AIX, where the linker discards
11715 object files that are not referenced from @code{main} and uses export
11716 lists.
11717 @end defmac
11718
11719 @defmac MODIFY_JNI_METHOD_CALL (@var{mdecl})
11720 Define this macro to a C expression representing a variant of the
11721 method call @var{mdecl}, if Java Native Interface (JNI) methods
11722 must be invoked differently from other methods on your target.
11723 For example, on 32-bit Microsoft Windows, JNI methods must be invoked using
11724 the @code{stdcall} calling convention and this macro is then
11725 defined as this expression:
11726
11727 @smallexample
11728 build_type_attribute_variant (@var{mdecl},
11729 build_tree_list
11730 (get_identifier ("stdcall"),
11731 NULL))
11732 @end smallexample
11733 @end defmac
11734
11735 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_CANNOT_MODIFY_JUMPS_P (void)
11736 This target hook returns @code{true} past the point in which new jump
11737 instructions could be created. On machines that require a register for
11738 every jump such as the SHmedia ISA of SH5, this point would typically be
11739 reload, so this target hook should be defined to a function such as:
11740
11741 @smallexample
11742 static bool
11743 cannot_modify_jumps_past_reload_p ()
11744 @{
11745 return (reload_completed || reload_in_progress);
11746 @}
11747 @end smallexample
11748 @end deftypefn
11749
11750 @deftypefn {Target Hook} reg_class_t TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS (void)
11751 This target hook returns a register class for which branch target register
11752 optimizations should be applied. All registers in this class should be
11753 usable interchangeably. After reload, registers in this class will be
11754 re-allocated and loads will be hoisted out of loops and be subjected
11755 to inter-block scheduling.
11756 @end deftypefn
11757
11758 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CALLEE_SAVED (bool @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen})
11759 Branch target register optimization will by default exclude callee-saved
11760 registers
11761 that are not already live during the current function; if this target hook
11762 returns true, they will be included. The target code must than make sure
11763 that all target registers in the class returned by
11764 @samp{TARGET_BRANCH_TARGET_REGISTER_CLASS} that might need saving are
11765 saved. @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} indicates if prologues and
11766 epilogues have already been generated. Note, even if you only return
11767 true when @var{after_prologue_epilogue_gen} is false, you still are likely
11768 to have to make special provisions in @code{INITIAL_ELIMINATION_OFFSET}
11769 to reserve space for caller-saved target registers.
11770 @end deftypefn
11771
11772 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_CONDITIONAL_EXECUTION (void)
11773 This target hook returns true if the target supports conditional execution.
11774 This target hook is required only when the target has several different
11775 modes and they have different conditional execution capability, such as ARM.
11776 @end deftypefn
11777
11778 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GEN_CCMP_FIRST (rtx_insn **@var{prep_seq}, rtx_insn **@var{gen_seq}, int @var{code}, tree @var{op0}, tree @var{op1})
11779 This function prepares to emit a comparison insn for the first compare in a
11780 sequence of conditional comparisions. It returns an appropriate comparison
11781 with @code{CC} for passing to @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}.
11782 The insns to prepare the compare are saved in @var{prep_seq} and the compare
11783 insns are saved in @var{gen_seq}. They will be emitted when all the
11784 compares in the the conditional comparision are generated without error.
11785 @var{code} is the @code{rtx_code} of the compare for @var{op0} and @var{op1}.
11786 @end deftypefn
11787
11788 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GEN_CCMP_NEXT (rtx_insn **@var{prep_seq}, rtx_insn **@var{gen_seq}, rtx @var{prev}, int @var{cmp_code}, tree @var{op0}, tree @var{op1}, int @var{bit_code})
11789 This function prepares to emit a conditional comparison within a sequence
11790 of conditional comparisons. It returns an appropriate comparison with
11791 @code{CC} for passing to @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}.
11792 The insns to prepare the compare are saved in @var{prep_seq} and the compare
11793 insns are saved in @var{gen_seq}. They will be emitted when all the
11794 compares in the conditional comparision are generated without error. The
11795 @var{prev} expression is the result of a prior call to @code{gen_ccmp_first}
11796 or @code{gen_ccmp_next}. It may return @code{NULL} if the combination of
11797 @var{prev} and this comparison is not supported, otherwise the result must
11798 be appropriate for passing to @code{gen_ccmp_next} or @code{cbranch_optab}.
11799 @var{code} is the @code{rtx_code} of the compare for @var{op0} and @var{op1}.
11800 @var{bit_code} is @code{AND} or @code{IOR}, which is the op on the compares.
11801 @end deftypefn
11802
11803 @deftypefn {Target Hook} unsigned TARGET_LOOP_UNROLL_ADJUST (unsigned @var{nunroll}, struct loop *@var{loop})
11804 This target hook returns a new value for the number of times @var{loop}
11805 should be unrolled. The parameter @var{nunroll} is the number of times
11806 the loop is to be unrolled. The parameter @var{loop} is a pointer to
11807 the loop, which is going to be checked for unrolling. This target hook
11808 is required only when the target has special constraints like maximum
11809 number of memory accesses.
11810 @end deftypefn
11811
11812 @defmac POWI_MAX_MULTS
11813 If defined, this macro is interpreted as a signed integer C expression
11814 that specifies the maximum number of floating point multiplications
11815 that should be emitted when expanding exponentiation by an integer
11816 constant inline. When this value is defined, exponentiation requiring
11817 more than this number of multiplications is implemented by calling the
11818 system library's @code{pow}, @code{powf} or @code{powl} routines.
11819 The default value places no upper bound on the multiplication count.
11820 @end defmac
11821
11822 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11823 This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11824 target. The parameter @var{stdinc} indicates if normal include files
11825 are present. The parameter @var{sysroot} is the system root directory.
11826 The parameter @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11827 @end deftypefn
11828
11829 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_EXTRA_PRE_INCLUDES (const char *@var{sysroot}, const char *@var{iprefix}, int @var{stdinc})
11830 This target hook should register any extra include files for the
11831 target before any standard headers. The parameter @var{stdinc}
11832 indicates if normal include files are present. The parameter
11833 @var{sysroot} is the system root directory. The parameter
11834 @var{iprefix} is the prefix for the gcc directory.
11835 @end deftypefn
11836
11837 @deftypefn Macro void TARGET_OPTF (char *@var{path})
11838 This target hook should register special include paths for the target.
11839 The parameter @var{path} is the include to register. On Darwin
11840 systems, this is used for Framework includes, which have semantics
11841 that are different from @option{-I}.
11842 @end deftypefn
11843
11844 @defmac bool TARGET_USE_LOCAL_THUNK_ALIAS_P (tree @var{fndecl})
11845 This target macro returns @code{true} if it is safe to use a local alias
11846 for a virtual function @var{fndecl} when constructing thunks,
11847 @code{false} otherwise. By default, the macro returns @code{true} for all
11848 functions, if a target supports aliases (i.e.@: defines
11849 @code{ASM_OUTPUT_DEF}), @code{false} otherwise,
11850 @end defmac
11851
11852 @defmac TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES
11853 If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11854 target-specific format checking information for the @option{-Wformat}
11855 option. The default is to have no target-specific format checks.
11856 @end defmac
11857
11858 @defmac TARGET_N_FORMAT_TYPES
11859 If defined, this macro is the number of entries in
11860 @code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES}.
11861 @end defmac
11862
11863 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES
11864 If defined, this macro is the name of a global variable containing
11865 target-specific format overrides for the @option{-Wformat} option. The
11866 default is to have no target-specific format overrides. If defined,
11867 @code{TARGET_FORMAT_TYPES} must be defined, too.
11868 @end defmac
11869
11870 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES_COUNT
11871 If defined, this macro specifies the number of entries in
11872 @code{TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_ATTRIBUTES}.
11873 @end defmac
11874
11875 @defmac TARGET_OVERRIDES_FORMAT_INIT
11876 If defined, this macro specifies the optional initialization
11877 routine for target specific customizations of the system printf
11878 and scanf formatter settings.
11879 @end defmac
11880
11881 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_ARG_FOR_UNPROTOTYPED_FN (const_tree @var{typelist}, const_tree @var{funcdecl}, const_tree @var{val})
11882 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11883 illegal to pass argument @var{val} to function @var{funcdecl}
11884 with prototype @var{typelist}.
11885 @end deftypefn
11886
11887 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_CONVERSION (const_tree @var{fromtype}, const_tree @var{totype})
11888 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11889 invalid to convert from @var{fromtype} to @var{totype}, or @code{NULL}
11890 if validity should be determined by the front end.
11891 @end deftypefn
11892
11893 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_UNARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type})
11894 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11895 invalid to apply operation @var{op} (where unary plus is denoted by
11896 @code{CONVERT_EXPR}) to an operand of type @var{type}, or @code{NULL}
11897 if validity should be determined by the front end.
11898 @end deftypefn
11899
11900 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {const char *} TARGET_INVALID_BINARY_OP (int @var{op}, const_tree @var{type1}, const_tree @var{type2})
11901 If defined, this macro returns the diagnostic message when it is
11902 invalid to apply operation @var{op} to operands of types @var{type1}
11903 and @var{type2}, or @code{NULL} if validity should be determined by
11904 the front end.
11905 @end deftypefn
11906
11907 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_PROMOTED_TYPE (const_tree @var{type})
11908 If defined, this target hook returns the type to which values of
11909 @var{type} should be promoted when they appear in expressions,
11910 analogous to the integer promotions, or @code{NULL_TREE} to use the
11911 front end's normal promotion rules. This hook is useful when there are
11912 target-specific types with special promotion rules.
11913 This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11914 @end deftypefn
11915
11916 @deftypefn {Target Hook} tree TARGET_CONVERT_TO_TYPE (tree @var{type}, tree @var{expr})
11917 If defined, this hook returns the result of converting @var{expr} to
11918 @var{type}. It should return the converted expression,
11919 or @code{NULL_TREE} to apply the front end's normal conversion rules.
11920 This hook is useful when there are target-specific types with special
11921 conversion rules.
11922 This is currently used only by the C and C++ front ends.
11923 @end deftypefn
11924
11925 @defmac OBJC_JBLEN
11926 This macro determines the size of the objective C jump buffer for the
11927 NeXT runtime. By default, OBJC_JBLEN is defined to an innocuous value.
11928 @end defmac
11929
11930 @defmac LIBGCC2_UNWIND_ATTRIBUTE
11931 Define this macro if any target-specific attributes need to be attached
11932 to the functions in @file{libgcc} that provide low-level support for
11933 call stack unwinding. It is used in declarations in @file{unwind-generic.h}
11934 and the associated definitions of those functions.
11935 @end defmac
11936
11937 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_UPDATE_STACK_BOUNDARY (void)
11938 Define this macro to update the current function stack boundary if
11939 necessary.
11940 @end deftypefn
11941
11942 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_GET_DRAP_RTX (void)
11943 This hook should return an rtx for Dynamic Realign Argument Pointer (DRAP) if a
11944 different argument pointer register is needed to access the function's
11945 argument list due to stack realignment. Return @code{NULL} if no DRAP
11946 is needed.
11947 @end deftypefn
11948
11949 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_ALLOCATE_STACK_SLOTS_FOR_ARGS (void)
11950 When optimization is disabled, this hook indicates whether or not
11951 arguments should be allocated to stack slots. Normally, GCC allocates
11952 stacks slots for arguments when not optimizing in order to make
11953 debugging easier. However, when a function is declared with
11954 @code{__attribute__((naked))}, there is no stack frame, and the compiler
11955 cannot safely move arguments from the registers in which they are passed
11956 to the stack. Therefore, this hook should return true in general, but
11957 false for naked functions. The default implementation always returns true.
11958 @end deftypefn
11959
11960 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR
11961 On some architectures it can take multiple instructions to synthesize
11962 a constant. If there is another constant already in a register that
11963 is close enough in value then it is preferable that the new constant
11964 is computed from this register using immediate addition or
11965 subtraction. We accomplish this through CSE. Besides the value of
11966 the constant we also add a lower and an upper constant anchor to the
11967 available expressions. These are then queried when encountering new
11968 constants. The anchors are computed by rounding the constant up and
11969 down to a multiple of the value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR}.
11970 @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} should be the maximum positive value
11971 accepted by immediate-add plus one. We currently assume that the
11972 value of @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is a power of 2. For example, on
11973 MIPS, where add-immediate takes a 16-bit signed value,
11974 @code{TARGET_CONST_ANCHOR} is set to @samp{0x8000}. The default value
11975 is zero, which disables this optimization.
11976 @end deftypevr
11977
11978 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_ASAN_SHADOW_OFFSET (void)
11979 Return the offset bitwise ored into shifted address to get corresponding
11980 Address Sanitizer shadow memory address. NULL if Address Sanitizer is not
11981 supported by the target.
11982 @end deftypefn
11983
11984 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT} TARGET_MEMMODEL_CHECK (unsigned HOST_WIDE_INT @var{val})
11985 Validate target specific memory model mask bits. When NULL no target specific
11986 memory model bits are allowed.
11987 @end deftypefn
11988
11989 @deftypevr {Target Hook} {unsigned char} TARGET_ATOMIC_TEST_AND_SET_TRUEVAL
11990 This value should be set if the result written by @code{atomic_test_and_set} is not exactly 1, i.e.@: the @code{bool} @code{true}.
11991 @end deftypevr
11992
11993 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAS_IFUNC_P (void)
11994 It returns true if the target supports GNU indirect functions.
11995 The support includes the assembler, linker and dynamic linker.
11996 The default value of this hook is based on target's libc.
11997 @end deftypefn
11998
11999 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {unsigned int} TARGET_ATOMIC_ALIGN_FOR_MODE (machine_mode @var{mode})
12000 If defined, this function returns an appropriate alignment in bits for an atomic object of machine_mode @var{mode}. If 0 is returned then the default alignment for the specified mode is used.
12001 @end deftypefn
12002
12003 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_ATOMIC_ASSIGN_EXPAND_FENV (tree *@var{hold}, tree *@var{clear}, tree *@var{update})
12004 ISO C11 requires atomic compound assignments that may raise floating-point exceptions to raise exceptions corresponding to the arithmetic operation whose result was successfully stored in a compare-and-exchange sequence. This requires code equivalent to calls to @code{feholdexcept}, @code{feclearexcept} and @code{feupdateenv} to be generated at appropriate points in the compare-and-exchange sequence. This hook should set @code{*@var{hold}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feholdexcept}, @code{*@var{clear}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feclearexcept} and @code{*@var{update}} to an expression equivalent to the call to @code{feupdateenv}. The three expressions are @code{NULL_TREE} on entry to the hook and may be left as @code{NULL_TREE} if no code is required in a particular place. The default implementation leaves all three expressions as @code{NULL_TREE}. The @code{__atomic_feraiseexcept} function from @code{libatomic} may be of use as part of the code generated in @code{*@var{update}}.
12005 @end deftypefn
12006
12007 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_RECORD_OFFLOAD_SYMBOL (tree)
12008 Used when offloaded functions are seen in the compilation unit and no named
12009 sections are available. It is called once for each symbol that must be
12010 recorded in the offload function and variable table.
12011 @end deftypefn
12012
12013 @deftypefn {Target Hook} {char *} TARGET_OFFLOAD_OPTIONS (void)
12014 Used when writing out the list of options into an LTO file. It should
12015 translate any relevant target-specific options (such as the ABI in use)
12016 into one of the @option{-foffload} options that exist as a common interface
12017 to express such options. It should return a string containing these options,
12018 separated by spaces, which the caller will free.
12019
12020 @end deftypefn
12021
12022 @defmac TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT
12023
12024 On older ports, large integers are stored in @code{CONST_DOUBLE} rtl
12025 objects. Newer ports define @code{TARGET_SUPPORTS_WIDE_INT} to be nonzero
12026 to indicate that large integers are stored in
12027 @code{CONST_WIDE_INT} rtl objects. The @code{CONST_WIDE_INT} allows
12028 very large integer constants to be represented. @code{CONST_DOUBLE}
12029 is limited to twice the size of the host's @code{HOST_WIDE_INT}
12030 representation.
12031
12032 Converting a port mostly requires looking for the places where
12033 @code{CONST_DOUBLE}s are used with @code{VOIDmode} and replacing that
12034 code with code that accesses @code{CONST_WIDE_INT}s. @samp{"grep -i
12035 const_double"} at the port level gets you to 95% of the changes that
12036 need to be made. There are a few places that require a deeper look.
12037
12038 @itemize @bullet
12039 @item
12040 There is no equivalent to @code{hval} and @code{lval} for
12041 @code{CONST_WIDE_INT}s. This would be difficult to express in the md
12042 language since there are a variable number of elements.
12043
12044 Most ports only check that @code{hval} is either 0 or -1 to see if the
12045 value is small. As mentioned above, this will no longer be necessary
12046 since small constants are always @code{CONST_INT}. Of course there
12047 are still a few exceptions, the alpha's constraint used by the zap
12048 instruction certainly requires careful examination by C code.
12049 However, all the current code does is pass the hval and lval to C
12050 code, so evolving the c code to look at the @code{CONST_WIDE_INT} is
12051 not really a large change.
12052
12053 @item
12054 Because there is no standard template that ports use to materialize
12055 constants, there is likely to be some futzing that is unique to each
12056 port in this code.
12057
12058 @item
12059 The rtx costs may have to be adjusted to properly account for larger
12060 constants that are represented as @code{CONST_WIDE_INT}.
12061 @end itemize
12062
12063 All and all it does not take long to convert ports that the
12064 maintainer is familiar with.
12065
12066 @end defmac
12067
12068 @deftypefn {Target Hook} bool TARGET_HAVE_SPECULATION_SAFE_VALUE (bool @var{active})
12069 This hook is used to determine the level of target support for
12070 @code{__builtin_speculation_safe_value}. If called with an argument
12071 of false, it returns true if the target has been modified to support
12072 this builtin. If called with an argument of true, it returns true
12073 if the target requires active mitigation execution might be speculative.
12074
12075 The default implementation returns false if the target does not define
12076 a pattern named @code{speculation_barrier}. Else it returns true
12077 for the first case and whether the pattern is enabled for the current
12078 compilation for the second case.
12079
12080 For targets that have no processors that can execute instructions
12081 speculatively an alternative implemenation of this hook is available:
12082 simply redefine this hook to @code{speculation_safe_value_not_needed}
12083 along with your other target hooks.
12084 @end deftypefn
12085
12086 @deftypefn {Target Hook} rtx TARGET_SPECULATION_SAFE_VALUE (machine_mode @var{mode}, rtx @var{result}, rtx @var{val}, rtx @var{failval})
12087 This target hook can be used to generate a target-specific code
12088 sequence that implements the @code{__builtin_speculation_safe_value}
12089 built-in function. The function must always return @var{val} in
12090 @var{result} in mode @var{mode} when the cpu is not executing
12091 speculatively, but must never return that when speculating until it
12092 is known that the speculation will not be unwound. The hook supports
12093 two primary mechanisms for implementing the requirements. The first
12094 is to emit a speculation barrier which forces the processor to wait
12095 until all prior speculative operations have been resolved; the second
12096 is to use a target-specific mechanism that can track the speculation
12097 state and to return @var{failval} if it can determine that
12098 speculation must be unwound at a later time.
12099
12100 The default implementation simply copies @var{val} to @var{result} and
12101 emits a @code{speculation_barrier} instruction if that is defined.
12102 @end deftypefn
12103
12104 @deftypefn {Target Hook} void TARGET_RUN_TARGET_SELFTESTS (void)
12105 If selftests are enabled, run any selftests for this target.
12106 @end deftypefn